Produced by Henry Flower and the Online Distributed
Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
produced from images generously made available by The
Internet Archive/American Libraries.)









  HOURS OF EXERCISE.

[Illustration: THE JUNGFRAU FROM INTERLAKEN.]




  HOURS OF EXERCISE

  IN

  THE ALPS.

  BY

  JOHN TYNDALL, LL.D., F.R.S.,

  AUTHOR OF “FRAGMENTS OF SCIENCE FOR UNSCIENTIFIC PEOPLE,” “HEAT
  AS A MODE OF MOTION,” ETC., ETC.

  NEW YORK:
  D. APPLETON AND COMPANY,
  72 FIFTH AVENUE.
  1896.

  _Authorized Edition._




PREFACE.


A short time ago I published a book of ‘Fragments,’ which might have
been called ‘Hours of Exercise in the Attic and the Laboratory’; while
this one bears the title of ‘Hours of Exercise in the Alps.’ The two
volumes supplement each other, and, taken together, illustrate the mode
in which a lover of natural knowledge and of natural scenery chooses to
spend his life.

Much as I enjoy the work, I do not think that I could have filled my
days and hours in the Alps with clambering alone. The climbing in
many cases was the peg on which a thousand other ‘exercises’ were
hung. The present volume, however, is for the most part a record of
bodily action, written partly to preserve to myself the memory of
strong and joyous hours, and partly for the pleasure of those who find
exhilaration in descriptions associated with mountain life.

The papers, written during the last ten years, are printed in the order
of the incidents to which they relate; and, to render the history more
complete, I have, with the permission of their authors, introduced
nearly the whole of two articles by Mr. Vaughan Hawkins and Mr. Philip
Gossett. The former describes the first assault ever made upon the
Matterhorn, the latter an expedition which ended in the death of a
renowned and beloved guide.

The ‘Glaciers of the Alps’ being out of print, I can no longer refer to
it. Towards the end of the volume, therefore, I have thrown together
a few ‘Notes and Comments’ which may be useful to those who desire to
possess some knowledge of the phenomena of the ice-world, and of the
properties of ice itself. To these are added one or two minor articles,
which relate more or less to our British hills and lakes: the volume is
closed by an account of a recent voyage to Oran.

I refrain from giving advice, further than to say that the perils of
wandering in the High Alps are terribly real, and are only to be met by
knowledge, caution, skill, and strength. ‘For rashness, ignorance, or
carelessness the mountains leave no margin; and to rashness, ignorance,
or carelessness three-fourths of the catastrophes which shock us are
to be traced.’ Those who wish to know something of the precautions to
be taken upon the peaks and glaciers cannot do better than consult the
excellent little volume lately published by Leslie Stephen, where,
under the head of ‘Dangers of Mountaineering,’ this question is
discussed.

I would willingly have published this volume without illustrations,
and should the reader like those here introduced--two of which were
published ten years ago, and the remainder recently executed under
the able superintendence of Mr. Whymper--he will have to ascribe his
gratification to the initiative of Mr. William Longman, not to me.

I have sometimes tried to trace the genesis of the interest which
I take in fine scenery. It cannot be wholly due to my own early
associations; for as a boy I loved nature, and hence, to account for
that love, I must fall back upon something earlier than my own birth.
The forgotten associations of a far-gone ancestry are probably the
most potent elements in the feeling. With characteristic penetration,
Mr. Herbert Spencer has written of the growth of our appreciation of
natural scenery with growing years. But to the associations of the
individual himself he adds ‘certain deeper, but now vague, combinations
of states, that were organised in the race during barbarous times,
when its pleasurable activities were among the mountains, woods, and
waters. Out of these excitations,’ he adds, ‘some of them actual, but
most of them nascent, is composed the emotion which a fine landscape
produces in us.’ I think this an exceedingly likely proximate
hypothesis, and hence infer that those ‘vague and deep combinations
organised in barbarous times,’ not to go further back, have come down
with considerable force to me. Adding to these inherited feelings the
pleasurable present exercise of Mr. Bain’s ‘muscular sense,’ I obtain a
somewhat intelligible, though, doubtless, still secondary theory of my
delight in the mountains.

The name of a friend whom I taught in his boyhood to handle a
theodolite and lay a chain, and who afterwards turned his knowledge to
account on the glaciers of the Alps, occurs frequently in the following
pages. Of the firmness of a friendship, uninterrupted for an hour, and
only strengthened by the weathering of six-and-twenty years, he needs
no assurance. Still, for the pleasure it gives myself, I connect this
volume with the name of THOMAS ARCHER HIRST.

  J. TYNDALL.

_May 1871._




CONTENTS.


  CHAPTER                                                            PAGE

      I. THE LAUWINEN-THOR                                              1
     II. DISASTER ON THE COL DU GÉANT                                  18
    III. THE MATTERHORN--FIRST ASSAULT, WITH J. J. BENNEN AS GUIDE     27
     IV. THERMOMETRIC STATIONS ON MONT BLANC                           53
      V. A LETTER FROM BÂLE                                            59
           NOTE ON THE SOUND OF AGITATED WATER                         65
     VI. THE URBACHTHAL AND GAULI GLACIER                              66
    VII. THE GRIMSEL AND THE ÆGGISCHHORN                               75
           NOTE ON CLOUDS                                              82
   VIII. THE BEL ALP                                                   86
     IX. THE WEISSHORN                                                 91
      X. INSPECTION OF THE MATTERHORN WITH BENNEN                     114
     XI. OVER THE MORO                                                125
    XII. THE OLD WEISSTHOR                                            130
   XIII. RESCUE FROM A CREVASSE                                       141
    XIV. THE MATTERHORN--SECOND ASSAULT, IN COMPANY WITH BENNEN       153
     XV. FROM STEIN TO THE GRIMSEL                                    166
    XVI. THE OBERAARJOCH.--ADVENTURE AT THE ÆGGISCHHORN               174
   XVII. ASCENT OF THE JUNGFRAU                                       180
  XVIII. DEATH OF BENNEN ON THE HAUT DE CRY                           192
    XIX. ACCIDENT ON THE PIZ MORTERATSCH                              206
     XX. ALPINE SCULPTURE                                             219
    XXI. SEARCH ON THE MATTERHORN: A PROJECT                          252
   XXII. THE TITLIS, FINSTERAARSCHLUCHT, PETERSGRAT, AND
            ITALIAN LAKES                                             255
  XXIII. ASCENT OF THE EIGER AND PASSAGE OF THE TRIFT                 265
   XXIV. THE MATTERHORN--THIRD AND LAST ASSAULT                       271
    XXV. ASCENT OF THE ALETSCHHORN                                    295
   XXVI. A DAY AMONG THE SÉRACS OF THE GLACIER DU GÉANT
            FOURTEEN YEARS AGO                                        318


          _NOTES ON ICE AND GLACIERS, ETC._

      I. OBSERVATIONS ON THE MER DE GLACE                             339
     II. STRUCTURE AND PROPERTIES OF ICE                              360
    III. STRUCTURE OF GLACIERS                                        367
     IV. HELMHOLTZ ON ICE AND GLACIERS                                377
      V. CLOUDS                                                       405
     VI. KILLARNEY                                                    413
    VII. SNOWDON IN WINTER                                            421
   VIII. VOYAGE TO ALGERIA TO OBSERVE THE ECLIPSE                     429




ILLUSTRATIONS.


         THE JUNGFRAU FROM INTERLAKEN                      _Frontispiece_
         ASCENT OF THE LAUWINEN-THOR                    _to face page_ 11
         THE WEISSHORN FROM THE RIFFEL                           „     91
         THE MATTERHORN (from a drawing by E. W. Cooke, R. A.)   „    117
         RECOVERY OF OUR PORTER                                  „    149
         JOHANN JOSEPH BENNEN                                    „    201
         THE GORGE OF PFEFFERS (showing Erosive Action)          „    219




    Nature, thou earliest gospel of the wise,
      Thou never-silent hymner unto God;
    Thou angel-ladder lost amidst the skies,
      Though at the foot we dream upon the sod;
    To thee the priesthood of the lyre belong--
    They hear religion and reply in song.

    If he hath held thy worship undefiled
      Through all the sins and sorrows of his youth,
    Let the man echo what he heard as child
      From the far hill-tops of melodious Truth,
    Leaving in troubled hearts some lingering tone
    Sweet with the solace thou hast given his own.

    LORD LYTTON’S _King Arthur_.

                        ‘The brain,
    That forages all climes to hue its cells,
    Will not distil the juices it has sucked
    To the sweet substance of pellucid thought,
    Except for him who hath the secret learned
    To mix his blood with sunshine, and to take
    The winds into his pulses.’

    JAMES RUSSELL LOWELL.




HOURS OF EXERCISE IN THE ALPS.


I.

_THE LAUWINEN-THOR._

In June 1860 I completed ‘The Glaciers of the Alps,’ which constituted
but a fraction of the work executed during the previous autumn and
spring. These labours and other matters had wearied and weakened me
beyond measure, and to gain a little strength I went to Killarney. The
trip was beneficial, but not of permanent benefit. The air of those
most lovely lakes was too moist and warm for my temperament, and I
longed for that keener air which derives its tone from contact with
the Alpine snows. In 1859 I had bidden the Alps farewell, purposing in
future to steep my thoughts in the tranquillity of English valleys,
and confine my mountain work to occasional excursions in the Scotch
Highlands, or amid the Welsh and Cumbrian hills. But in my weariness
the mere thought of the snow-peaks and glaciers was an exhilaration;
and to the Alps, therefore, I resolved once more to go. I wrote to my
former guide, Christian Lauener, desiring him to meet me at Thun on
Saturday the 4th of August; and on my way thither I fortunately fell
in with Mr. Vaughan Hawkins. He told me of his plans and wishes, which
embraced an attack upon the Matterhorn. Infected by his ardour, I
gladly closed with the proposition that we should climb together for a
time.

Lauener was not to be found at Thun, but in driving from Neuhaus to
Interlaken a chaise met us, and swiftly passed; within it I could
discern the brown visage of my guide. We pulled up and shouted, the
other vehicle stopped, Lauener leaped from it, and came bounding
towards me with admirable energy, through the deep and splashing mud.
‘Gott! wie der Kerl springt!’ was the admiring exclamation of my
coachman. Lauener is more than six feet high, and mainly a mass of
bone; his legs are out of proportion, longer than his trunk; and he
wears a short-tail coat, which augments the apparent discrepancy. Those
massive levers were now plied with extraordinary vigour to project his
body through space; and it was gratifying to be thus assured that the
man was in first-rate condition, and fully up to the hardest work.

On Sunday the 5th of August, for the sake of a little training, I
ascended the Faulhorn alone. The morning was splendid, but as the day
advanced heavy cloud-wreaths swathed the heights. They attained a
maximum about two P.M., and afterwards the overladen air cleared itself
by intermittent jerks--revealing at times the blue of heaven and the
peaks of the mountains; then closing up again, and hiding in their
dismal folds the very posts which stood at a distance of ten paces
from the hotel door. The effects soon became exceedingly striking,
the mutations were so quick and so forcibly antithetical. I lay down
upon a seat, and watched the intermittent extinction and generation
of the clouds, and the alternate appearance and disappearance of the
mountains. More and more the sun swept off the sweltering haze, and
the blue sky bent over me in domes of ampler span. At four P.M. no
trace of cloud was visible, and a panorama of the Oberland, such I had
no idea that the Faulhorn could command, unfolded itself. There was
the grand barrier which separated us from the Valais; there were the
Jungfrau, Monk and Eiger, the Finsteraarhorn, the Schreckhorn, and the
Wetterhorn, lifting their snowy and cloudless crests to heaven, and all
so sharp and wildly precipitous that the bare thought of standing on
any one of them made me shudder. London was still in my brain, and the
vice of Primrose Hill in my muscles.

I disliked the ascent of the Faulhorn exceedingly, and the monotonous
pony track which led to the top of it. Once, indeed, I deviated from
the road out of pure disgust, and, taking a jumping torrent for my
guide and colloquist, was led astray. I now resolved to return to
Grindelwald by another route. My host at first threw cold water on the
notion, but he afterwards relaxed and admitted that the village might
be attained by a more direct way than the ordinary one. He pointed to
some rocks, eminences, and trees, which were to serve as landmarks;
and stretching his arm in the direction of Grindelwald, I took the
bearing of the place, and scampered over slopes of snow to the sunny
Alp beyond them. To my left was a mountain stream making soft music
by the explosion of its bubbles. I was once tempted aside to climb
a rounded eminence, where I lay for an hour watching the augmenting
glory of the mountains. The scene at hand was perfectly pastoral; green
pastures, dotted with chalets, and covered with cows, which filled the
air with the incessant tinkle of their bells. Beyond was the majestic
architecture of the Alps, with its capitals and western bastions
flushed with the warm light of the lowering sun.

I mightily enjoyed the hour. There was health in the air and hope
in the mountains, and with the consciousness of augmenting vigour I
quitted my station, and galloped down the Alp. I was soon amid the
pinewoods which overhang the valley of Grindelwald, with no guidance
save the slope of the mountain, which, at times, was quite precipitous;
but the roots of the pines grasping the rocks afforded hand and foot
such hold as to render the steepest places the pleasantest of all.
I often emerged from the gloom of the trees upon lovely bits of
pasture--bright emerald gems set in the bosom of the woods. It appeared
to me surprising that nobody had constructed a resting-place on this
fine slope. With a fraction of the time necessary to reach the top of
the Faulhorn, a position might be secured from which the prospect would
vie in point of grandeur with almost any in the Alps; while the ascent
from Grindelwald, amid the shade of the festooned trees, would itself
be delightful.

Hawkins, who had halted for a day at Thun, had arrived; our guide had
prepared a number of stakes, and on Monday morning we mounted our
theodolite and proceeded to the Lower Glacier. With some difficulty we
established the instrument upon a site whence the glacier could be seen
from edge to edge; and across it was fixed in a straight line a series
of twelve stakes. We afterwards ascended the glacier till we touched
the avalanche-débris of the Heisse Platte. We wandered amid the moulins
and crevasses until evening approached, and thus gradually prepared our
muscles for more arduous work. On Tuesday a sleety rain filled the
entire air, and the glacier was so laden with fog that there was no
possibility of our being able to see across it. On Wednesday, happily,
the weather brightened, and we executed our measurements; finding,
as in all other cases, that the glacier was retarded by its bounding
walls, its motion varying from a minimum of thirteen and a half inches
to a maximum of twenty-two inches a day. To Mr. Hawkins I am indebted
both for the fixing of the stakes and the reduction of the measurements
to their diurnal rate.

Previous to leaving England I had agreed to join a party of friends at
the Æggischhorn, on Thursday the 9th of August. My plan was, first to
measure the motion of the Grindelwald glacier, and afterwards to cross
the mountain-wall which separates the canton of Berne from that of
Valais, so as to pass from Lauterbrunnen to the Æggischhorn in a single
day. How this formidable barrier was to be crossed was a problem, but
I did not doubt being able to get over it somehow. On mentioning my
wish to Lauener, he agreed to try, and proposed attacking it through
the Roththal. In company with his brother Ulrich, he had already spent
some time in the Roththal, seeking to scale the Jungfrau from that
side. Hawkins had previously, I believe, entertained the thought of
assailing the same barrier at the very same place. Having completed
our measurements on the Wednesday, we descended to Grindelwald and
discharged our bill. We desired to obtain the services of Christian
Kaufmann, a guide well acquainted with both the Wetterhorn and the
Jungfrau; but on learning our intentions he expressed fears regarding
his lungs, and recommended to us his brother, a powerful young man, who
had also undergone the discipline of the Wetterhorn. Him we accordingly
engaged. We arranged with the landlord of the Bear to have the main
mass of our luggage sent to the Æggischhorn by a more easy route. I
was loth to part with the theodolite, but Lauener at first grumbled
hard against taking it. It was proposed, however, to confine his load
to the head of the instrument, while Kaufmann should carry the legs,
and I should bear my own knapsack. He yielded. Ulrich Lauener was
at Grindelwald when we started for Lauterbrunnen, and on bidding us
good-bye he remarked that we were going to attempt an impossibility. He
had examined the place which we proposed to assail, and emphatically
affirmed that it could not be surmounted. We were both a little
chagrined by this gratuitous announcement, and answered him somewhat
warmly; for we knew the moral, or rather immoral, effect of such an
opinion upon the spirits of our men.

The weather became more serene as we approached Lauterbrunnen. We
had a brief evening stroll, but retired to bed before day had quite
forsaken the mountains. At two A.M. the candle of Lauener gleamed
into our bedrooms, and he pronounced the weather fair. We got up at
once, dressed, despatched our hasty breakfast, strapped our things into
the smallest possible volume, and between three and four A.M. were on
our way. The hidden sun crimsoned faintly the eastern sky, but the
valleys were all in peaceful shadow. To our right the Staubbach dangled
its hazy veil, while other _Bachs_ of minor note also hung from the
beetling rocks, but fell to earth too lightly to produce the faintest
murmur. After an hour’s march we deviated to the left, and wound upward
through the woods which here cover the slope of the hill.

The dawn cheerfully unlocked the recesses of the mountains, and we
soon quitted the gloom of the woods for the bright green Alp. This we
breasted, regardless of the path, until we reached the chalets of the
Roththal. We did not yet see the particular staircase up which Lauener
proposed to lead us, but we inspected minutely the battlements to our
right, marking places for future attack in case our present attempt
should not be successful. The elastic grass disappeared, and we passed
over rough crag and shingle alternately. We reached the base of a
ridge of _débris_, and mounted it. At our right was the glacier of the
Roththal, along the lateral moraine of which our route lay.

Just as we touched the snow a spring bubbled from the rocks at our
left, spurting its water over stalagmites of ice. We turned towards
it, and had each a refreshing draught. Lauener pointed out to us the
remains of the hut erected by him and his brother when they attempted
the Jungfrau, and from which they were driven by adverse weather. We
entered an amphitheatre, grand and beautiful this splendid morning,
but doubtless in times of tempest a fit residence for the devils whom
popular belief has banished to its crags. The snow for a space was as
level as a prairie, but in front of us rose the mighty bulwarks which
separated us from the neighbouring canton. To our right were the crags
of the Breithorn, to our left the buttresses of the Jungfrau, while
between both was an indentation in the mountain-wall, on which all eyes
were fixed. From it downwards hung a thread of snow, which was to be
our leading-string to the top.

Though very steep, the aspect of the place was by no means terrible:
comparing with it my memory of other gulleys in the Chamouni mountains,
I imagined that three hours would place us at the top. We not only
expected an easy conquest of the barrier, but it was proposed that
on reaching the top we should turn to the left, and walk straight to
the summit of the Jungfrau. Lauener was hopeful, but not sanguine. We
were soon at the foot of the barrier, clambering over mounds of snow.
Huge consolidated lumps emerged from the general mass; the snow was
evidently that of avalanches which had been shot down the couloir,
kneading themselves into vast balls, and piling themselves in heaps
upon the plain. The gradient steepened, the snow was hard, and the axe
was invoked. Straight up the couloir seemed the most promising route,
and we pursued it for an hour, the impression gradually gaining ground
that the work would prove heavier than we had anticipated.

We then turned our eyes on the rocks to our right, which seemed
practicable, though very steep; we swerved towards them, and worked
laboriously upwards for three-quarters of an hour. Mr. Hawkins and the
two guides then turned to the left, and regained the snow, leaving
me among the crags. They had steps to cut, while I had none, and,
consequently, I got rapidly above them. The work becomes ever harder,
and rest is unattainable, for there is no resting-place. At every brow
I pause; legs and breast are laid against the rough rock, so as to
lessen by their friction the strain upon the arms, which are stretched
to grasp some protuberance above. Thus I rest, and thus I learn that
three days’ training is not sufficient to dislodge London from one’s
lungs. Meanwhile my companions are mounting monotonously along the
snow. Lauener looks up at me at intervals, and I can clearly mark
the expression of his countenance; it is quite spiritless, while that
of his companion bears the print of absolute dismay. Three hours
have passed and the summit is not sensibly nearer. The men halt and
converse together. Lauener at length calls out to me, ‘I think it is
impossible.’ The effect of Ulrich’s prediction appears to be cropping
out; we expostulate, however, and they move on. After some time they
halt again, and reiterate their opinion that the thing cannot be done.
They direct our attention to the top of the barrier; light clouds scud
swiftly over it, and snow-dust is scattered in the air. There is storm
on the heights, which our guides affirm has turned the day against us.
I cast about in my mind to meet the difficulty, and enquire whether
we might not send one of them back with the theodolite, and thus so
lighten our burdens as to be able to proceed. Kaufmann volunteers to
take back the theodolite; but this does not seem to please Lauener.
There is a pause and hesitation. I remonstrate, while Hawkins calls out
‘Forward!’ Lauener once more doggedly strikes his axe into the snow,
and resumes the ascent.

I continued among the rocks, though with less and less confidence
in the wisdom of my choice. My knapsack annoyed me excessively; the
straps frayed my shoulders, and tied up my muscles. Once or twice I
had to get round a protruding face of rock, and then found my bonds
very grievous. At length I came to a peculiar piece of cliff, near the
base of which was a sharp ridge of snow, and at a height of about five
feet above it the rock bulged out, so that a stone dropped from its
protuberance would fall beyond the ridge. I had to work along the snow
cautiously, squatting down so as to prevent the rock from pushing me
too far out. Had I a fair ledge underneath I should have felt perfectly
at ease, but on the stability of the snow-wedge I dared not calculate.
To retreat was dangerous, to advance useless; for right in front of me
was a sheer smooth precipice, which completely extinguished the thought
of further rock-work. I examined the place below me, and saw that a
slip would be attended with the very worst consequences. To loose
myself from the crag and attach myself to the snow was so perilous an
operation that I did not attempt it; and at length I ignobly called to
Lauener to lend me a hand. A gleam of satisfaction crossed his features
as he eyed me on my perch. He manifestly enjoyed being called to the
rescue, and exhorted me to keep quite still. He worked up towards me,
and in less than half an hour had hold of one of my legs. ‘The place is
not so bad after all,’ he remarked, evidently glad to take me down, in
more senses than one. I descended in his steps, and rejoined Hawkins
upon the snow. From that moment Lauener was a regenerate man; the
despair of his visage vanished, and I firmly believe that the triumph
he enjoyed, by augmenting his self-respect, was the proximate cause of
our subsequent success.

[Illustration: ASCENT OF THE LAUWINEN THOR.]

The couloir was a most singular one; it was excessively steep, and
along it were two great scars, resembling the deep-cut channels of a
mountain stream. They were, indeed, channels cut by the snow-torrents
from the heights. We scanned those heights. The view was bounded by
a massive cornice, from which the avalanches are periodically let
loose.[1] The cornice seemed firm; still we cast about for some piece
of rock which might shelter us from the destroyer should he leap
from his lair. Apart from the labour of the ascent, which is great,
the frequency of avalanches will always render this pass a dangerous
one. At 2 P.M. the air became intensely cold. My companion had wisely
pocketed a pair of socks, which he drew over his gloves, and found very
comforting. My leather gloves, being saturated with wet, were very much
the reverse.

[1] Hence the name ‘Lauwinen-Thor,’ which, with the consent of Mr.
Hawkins, if not at his suggestion, I have given to the pass. [The name
has since been adopted in all the maps. March 1871.]

The wind was high, and as it passed the crest of the Breithorn its
moisture was precipitated and afterwards carried away. The clouds
thus generated shone for a time with the lustre of pearls; but as they
approached the sun they became suddenly flooded with the most splendid
iridescences.[2] At our right now was a vertical wall of brown rock,
along the base of which we advanced. At times we were sheltered by it,
but not always; for the wind was as fitful as a maniac, and eddying
round the corners sometimes shook us forcibly, chilled us to the
marrow, and spit frozen dust in our faces. The snow, moreover, adjacent
to the rock had been melted and refrozen to a steep slope of compact
ice. The men were very weary, the hewing of the steps exhausting, and
the footing, particularly on some glazed rocks over which we had to
pass, exceedingly insecure. Once on trying to fix my alpenstock I found
that it was coated with an enamel of ice, and slipped through my wet
gloves. This startled me, for the staff is my sole trust under such
circumstances. The crossing of those rocks was a most awkward piece of
work; a slip was imminent, and the effects of the consequent glissade
not to be calculated. We cleared them, however, and now observed the
grey haze creeping down from the peak of the Breithorn to the point at
which we were aiming. This, however, was visibly nearer; and, for the
first time since we began to climb, Lauener declared that he had good
hopes--‘Jetzt habe ich gute Hoffnung.’ Another hour brought us to a
place where the gradient slackened suddenly. The real work was done,
and ten minutes further wading through the deep snow placed us fairly
on the summit of the col.

[2] See ‘Note on Clouds,’ p. 82.

Looked at from the top the pass will seem very formidable to the best
of climbers; to an ordinary eye it would appear simply terrific. We
reached the base of the barrier at nine A.M.; we had surmounted it at
four; seven hours consequently had been spent upon that tremendous
wall. Our view was limited above; clouds were on all the mountains, and
the Great Aletsch glacier was hidden by dense fog. With long swinging
strides we went down the slope. Several times during our descent the
snow coating was perforated, and hidden crevasses revealed. At length
we reached the glacier, and plodded along it through the dreary fog. We
cleared the ice just at nightfall, passed the Märjelin See, and soon
found ourselves in utter darkness on the spurs of the Æggischhorn. We
lost the track and wandered for a time bewildered. We sat down to rest,
and then learned that Lauener was extremely ill. To quell the pangs of
toothache he had chewed a cigar, which after his day’s exertion was too
much for him. He soon recovered, however, and we endeavoured to regain
the track. In vain. The guides shouted, and after many repetitions we
heard a shout in reply. A herdsman approached, and conducted us to some
neighbouring chalets, whence he undertook the office of guide. After a
time he also found himself in difficulty. We saw distant lights, and
Lauener once more pierced the air with his tremendous whoop. We were
heard. Lights were sent towards us, and an additional half-hour placed
us under the roof of Herr Wellig, the active and intelligent proprietor
of the Jungfrau hotel.

After this day’s journey, which was a very hard one, the tide of health
set steadily in. I have no remembrance of any further exhibition of
the symptoms which had driven me to Switzerland. Each day’s subsequent
exercise made both brain and muscles firmer. We remained at the
Æggischhorn for several days, occupying ourselves principally with
observations and measurements on the Aletsch glacier, and joining
together afterwards in that day’s excursion--unparalleled in my
experience--which has found in my companion a narrator worthy of its
glories. And as we stood upon the savage ledges of the Matterhorn,
with the utmost penalty which the laws of falling bodies could inflict
at hand, I felt that there were perils at home for intellectual men
greater even than those which then surrounded us--foes, moreover, which
inspire no manhood by their attacks, but shatter alike the architect
and his house by the same slow process of disintegration.[3] After
the discipline of the Matterhorn, the fatal slope of the Col du
Géant, which I visited a few days afterwards, looked less formidable
than it otherwise might have done. From Courmayeur I worked round to
Chamouni by Chapieu and the Col de Bonhomme. I attempted to get up
Mont Blanc to visit the thermometers which I had planted on the summit
a year previously; and succeeded during a brief interval of fair
weather in reaching the Grands Mulets. But the gleam which tempted me
thus far proved but a temporary truce to the war of elements, and,
after remaining twenty hours at the Mulets, I was obliged to beat an
inglorious retreat.--_Vacation Tourists, 1860._

[3] This, I believe, was in allusion to the death of Sir Charles
Barry.--J. T., 1871.




II.

_DISASTER ON THE COL DU GÉANT._


On the 18th of August, while Mr. Hawkins and I were staying at Breuil,
rumours reached us of a grievous disaster which had occurred on the Col
du Géant. At first, however, the accounts were so contradictory as to
inspire the hope that they might be grossly exaggerated or altogether
false. But more definite intelligence soon arrived, and before we
quitted Breuil it had been placed beyond a doubt that three Englishmen,
with a guide named Tairraz, had perished on the col. On the 21st I
saw the brother of Tairraz at Aosta, and learned from the saddened
man all that he knew. What I then heard only strengthened my desire
to visit the scene of the catastrophe, and obtain by actual contact
with the facts truer information than could possibly be conveyed to
me by description. On the afternoon of the 22nd I accordingly reached
Courmayeur, and being informed that M. Curie, the resident French
pastor, had visited the place and made an accurate sketch of it, I
immediately called upon him. With the most obliging promptness he
placed his sketches in my hands, gave me a written account of the
occurrence, and volunteered to accompany me. I gladly accepted this
offer, and early on the morning of Thursday the 21st of August we
walked up to the pavilion which it had been the aim of the travellers
to reach on the day of their death. Wishing to make myself acquainted
with the entire line of the fatal glissade, I walked directly from the
pavilion to the base of the rocky couloir along which the travellers
had been precipitated, and which had been described to me as so
dangerous that a chamois-hunter had declined ascending it some days
before. At Courmayeur, however, I secured the services of a most
intrepid man, who had once made the ascent, and who now expressed his
willingness to be my guide. We began our climb at the very bottom of
the couloir, while M. Curie, after making a circuit, joined us on the
spot where the body of the guide Tairraz had been arrested, and where
we found sad evidences of his fate. From this point onward M. Curie
shared the dangers of the ascent, until we reached the place where the
rocks ended and the fatal snow-slope began. Among the rocks we had
frequent and melancholy occasion to assure ourselves that we were on
the exact track. We found there a penknife, a small magnetic compass,
and many other remnants of the fall.

At the bottom of the snow-slope M. Curie quitted me, urging me not to
enter upon the slope, but to take to a stony ridge on the right. No
mere inspection, however, could have given me the desired information.
I asked my guide whether he feared the snow, and, his reply being
negative, we entered upon it together, and ascended it along the furrow
which still marked the line of fall. Under the snow, at some distance
up the slope, we found a fine new ice-axe, the property of one of the
guides. We held on to the track up to the very summit of the col,
and as I stood there and scanned the line of my ascent a feeling of
augmented sadness took possession of me. There seemed no sufficient
reason for this terrible catastrophe. With ordinary care the slip might
in the first instance have been avoided, and with a moderate amount of
skill and vigour the motion, I am persuaded, might have been arrested
soon after it had begun.

Bounding the snow-slope to the left was the ridge along which
travellers to Courmayeur usually descend. It is rough, but absolutely
without danger. The party were, however, tired when they reached
this place, and to avoid the roughness of the ridge they took to the
snow. The inclination of the slope above was moderate; it steepened
considerably lower down, but its steepest portion did not much
exceed forty-five degrees of inclination. At all events, a skilful
mountaineer might throw himself prostrate on the slope with perfect
reliance on his power to arrest his downward motion.

It is alleged that when the party entered the summit of the col on
the Chamouni side the guides proposed to return, but the Englishmen
persisted in going forward. One thing alone could justify the
proposition thus ascribed to the guides by their friends--a fog so
thick as to prevent them from striking the summit of the col at the
proper point, and to compel them to pursue their own traces backwards.
The only part of the col hitherto regarded as dangerous had been
passed, and, unless for the reason assumed, it would have been simply
absurd to recross this portion instead of proceeding to Courmayeur. It
is alleged that a fog existed; but the summit had been reached, and
the weather cleared afterwards. Whether, therefore, the Englishmen
refused to return or not on the Montanvert side, it ought in no way
to influence our judgment of what occurred on the Courmayeur side,
where the weather which prompted the proposal to go back ceased to be
blameable.

A statement is also current to the effect that the travellers were
carried down by an avalanche. In connection with this point M. Curie
writes to me thus: ‘Il paraît qu’à Chamounix on répand le bruit que
c’est une _avalanche_ qui a fait périr les voyageurs. C’est là
une fausseté que le premier vous saurez démentir sur les lieux.’
I subscribe without hesitation to this opinion of M. Curie. That
a considerable quantity of snow was brought down by the rush was
probable, but an avalanche properly so called there was not, and it
simply leads to misconception to introduce the term at all.

We are now prepared to discuss the accident. The travellers, it is
alleged, reached the summit of the col in a state of great exhaustion,
and it is certain that such a state would deprive them of the caution
and firmness of tread necessary in perilous places. But a knowledge
of this ought to have prevented the guides from entering upon the
snow-slope at all. We are, moreover, informed that even on the gentler
portion of the slope one of the travellers slipped repeatedly. On being
thus warned of danger, why did not the guides quit the snow and resort
to the ridge? They must have had full confidence in their power to
stop the glissade which seemed so imminent, or else they were reckless
of the lives they had in charge. At length the fatal slip occurred,
where the fallen man, before he could be arrested, gathered sufficient
momentum to jerk the man behind him off his feet, the other men were
carried away in succession, and in a moment the whole of them were
rushing downwards. What efforts were made to check this fearful rush,
at what point of the descent the two guides relinquished the rope,
which of them gave way first, the public do not know, though this ought
to be known. All that is known to the public is that the two men who
led and followed the party let go the rope and escaped, while the three
Englishmen and Tairraz went to destruction. Tairraz screamed, but, like
Englishmen, the others met their doom without a word of exclamation.

At the bottom of the slope a rocky ridge, forming the summit of a
precipice, rose slightly above the level of the snow, and over it they
were tilted. I do not think a single second’s suffering could have
been endured. During the wild rush downwards the bewilderment was too
great to permit even of fear, and at the base of the precipice life and
feeling ended suddenly together. A steep slope of rocks connected the
base of this precipice with the brow of a second one, at the bottom of
which the first body was found. Another slope ran from this point to
the summit of another ledge, where the second body was arrested, while
attached to it by a rope, and quite overhanging the ledge, was the body
of the third traveller. The body of the guide Tairraz was precipitated
much further, and was much more broken.

The question has been raised whether it was right under the
circumstances to tie the men together. I believe it was perfectly
right, if only properly done. But the actual arrangement was this:
The three Englishmen were connected by a rope tied firmly round
the waist of each of them; one end of the rope was held in the hand
of the guide who led the party; the other end was similarly held by
the hindmost guide, while Tairraz grasped the rope near its middle.
Against this mode of attachment I would enter an emphatic protest. It,
in all probability, caused the destruction of the unfortunate Russian
traveller on the Findelen Glacier last year, and to it I believe is to
be ascribed the disastrous issue of the slip on the Col du Géant. Let
me show cause for this protest. At a little depth below the surface
the snow upon the fatal slope was firm and consolidated, but upon it
rested a superficial layer, about ten inches or a foot in depth, partly
fresh, and partly disintegrated by the weather. By the proper action
of the feet upon such loose snow, its granules are made to unite so as
to afford a secure footing; but when a man’s body, presenting a large
surface, is thrown prostrate upon a slope covered with such snow, the
granules act like friction wheels, offering hardly any resistance to
the downward motion.

A homely illustration will render intelligible the course of action
necessary under such conditions. Suppose a boy placed upon an oilcloth
which covers a polished table, and the table tilted to an angle of
forty-five degrees. The oilcloth would evidently slide down, carrying
the boy along with it, as the loose snow slid over the firm snow on
the Col du Géant. But suppose the boy provided with a stick spiked with
iron, what ought he to do to check his motion? Evidently drive his
spike through the oilcloth and anchor it firmly in the wood underneath.
A precisely similar action ought to have been resorted to on the Col
du Géant. Each man as he fell ought to have turned promptly on his
face, pierced with his armed staff the superficial layer of soft snow,
and pressed with both hands the spike into the consolidated mass
underneath. He would thus have applied a break, sufficient not only
to bring himself to rest, but, if well done, sufficient, I believe,
to stop a second person. I do not lightly express this opinion: it is
founded on varied experience upon slopes at least as steep as that
under consideration.

Consider now the bearing of the mode of attachment above described upon
the question of rescue. When the rope is fastened round the guide’s
waist, both his arms are free, to drive, in case of necessity, his
spiked staff into the snow. But in the case before us, one arm of
each guide was virtually powerless; on it was thrown the strain of
the falling man in advance, by which it was effectually fettered. But
this was not all. When the attached arm receives the jerk, the guide
instinctively grasps the rope with the other hand; in doing so, he
relinquishes his staff, and thus loses the sheet-anchor of salvation.
Such was the case with the two guides who escaped on the day now in
question. The one lost his bâton, the other his axe, and they probably
had to make an expert use of their legs to save even themselves from
destruction. Tairraz was in the midst of the party. Whether it was in
his power to rescue himself or not, whether he was caught in the coil
of the rope or laid hold of by one of his companions, we can never
know. Let us believe that he clung to them loyally, and went with them
to death sooner than desert the post of duty.




III.

THE MATTERHORN--FIRST ASSAULT.

BY F. VAUGHAN HAWKINS, M.A.[4]

[4] Instead of attempting to write one myself, I requested the
permission of my friend Mr. Hawkins to republish his admirable account
of our first assault upon the Matterhorn. I have to thank both him and
Mr. Macmillan for the obliging promptness with which my request was
granted.


The summer and autumn of 1860 will long be remembered in Switzerland as
the most ungenial and disastrous season, perhaps, on record; certainly
without a parallel since 1834. The local papers were filled with
lamentations over ‘der ewige Südwind,’ which overspread the skies with
perpetual cloud, and from time to time brought up tremendous storms,
the fiercest of which, in the three first days of September, carried
away or blocked up for a time, I believe, every pass into Italy except
the Bernina. At Andermatt, on the St. Gothard, we were cut off for two
days from all communications whatever by water on every side. The whole
of the lower Rhone valley was under water. A few weeks later, I found
the Splügen, in the gorge above Chiavenna, altogether gone, remains
of the old road being just visible here and there, but no more. In the
Valteline, I found the Stelvio road in most imminent danger, gangs of
men being posted in the courses of the torrents to divert the boulders,
which every moment threatened to overwhelm the bridges on the route. A
more unlucky year for glacier expeditions, therefore, could hardly be
experienced; and the following pages present in consequence only the
narrative of an unfinished campaign, which it is the hope of Tyndall
and myself to be able to prosecute to a successful conclusion early
next August.

I had fallen in with Professor Tyndall on the Basle Railway, and a
joint plan of operations had been partly sketched out between us, to
combine to some extent the more especial objects of each--scientific
observations on his part; on mine, the exploration of new passes and
mountain topography; but the weather sadly interfered with these
designs. After some glacier measurements had been accomplished at
Grindelwald, a short spell of fair weather enabled us to effect a
passage I had long desired to try, from Lauterbrunnen direct to the
Æggischhorn by the Roththal, a small and unknown but most striking
glacier valley, known to Swiss mythology as the supposed resort of
condemned spirits. We scaled, by a seven hours’ perpendicular climb,
the vast amphitheatre of rock which bounds the Aletsch basin on this
side, and had the satisfaction of falsifying the predictions of Ulrich
Lauener, who bade us farewell at Grindelwald with the discouraging
assertion that he should see us back again, as it was quite impossible
to get over where we were going. As we descended the long reaches of
the Aletsch glacier, rain and mist again gathered over us, giving to
the scene the appearance of a vast Polar sea, over the surface of which
we were travelling, with no horizon visible anywhere except the distant
line of level ice. Arrived at the Æggischhorn, the weather became
worse than ever; a week elapsed before the measurement of the Aletsch
glacier could be completed; and we reluctantly determined to dismiss
Bennen, who was in waiting, considering the season too bad for high
ascents, and to push on with Christian Lauener to the glaciers about
Zinal. Bennen was in great distress. He and I had the previous summer
reconnoitred the Matterhorn from various quarters, and he had arrived
at the conclusion that we could in all probability (‘ich beinahe
behaupte’) reach the top. That year, being only just convalescent from
a fever, I had been unable to make the attempt, and thus an opportunity
had been lost which may not speedily recur, for the mountain was then
(September 1859) almost free from snow. Bennen had set his heart on our
making the attempt in 1860, and great was his disappointment at our
proposed departure for Zinal. At the last moment, however, a change of
plans occurred. Lauener was unwilling to proceed with us to Zinal: we
resolved to give Bennen his chance: the theodolite was packed up and
despatched to Geneva, and we set off for Breuil, to try the Matterhorn.

Accessible or not, however, the Mont Cervin is assuredly a different
sort of affair from Mont Blanc or Monte Rosa, or any other of the
thousand and one summits which nature has kindly opened to man, by
leaving one side of them a sloping plain of snow, easy of ascent, till
the brink of the precipice is reached which descends on the other side.
The square massive lines of terraced crags which fence the Matterhorn,
stand up on all sides nearly destitute of snow, and where the snow lies
thinly on the rocks it soon melts and is hardened again into smooth
glassy ice, which covers the granite slabs like a coat of varnish,
and bids defiance to the axe. Every step of the way lies between
two precipices, and under toppling crags, which may at any moment
bring down on the climber the most formidable of Alpine dangers--a
fire of falling stones. The mountain too has a sort of _prestige_ of
invincibility which is not without its influence on the mind, and
almost leads one to expect to encounter some new and unheard-of source
of peril upon it: hence I suppose it is that the dwellers at Zermatt
and in Val Tournanche have scarcely been willing to attempt to set foot
upon the mountain, and have left the honour of doing so to a native of
another district, who, as he has been the first mortal to plant foot on
the hitherto untrodden peak, so he will, I hope, have the honour, which
he deserves, of being the first to reach the top.

John Joseph Bennen, of Laax, in the Upper Rhine Valley, is a man so
remarkable that I cannot resist the desire (especially as he cannot
read English) to say a few words about his character. Born within
the limits of the German tongue, and living amidst the mountains and
glaciers of the Oberland, he belongs by race and character to a class
of men of whom the Laueners, Melchior Anderegg, Bortis, Christian
Almer, Peter Bohren, are also examples--a type of mountain race,
having many of the simple heroic qualities which we associate, whether
justly or unjustly, with Teutonic blood, and essentially different
from--to my mind, infinitely superior to--the French-speaking,
versatile, wily Chamouniard. The names I have mentioned are all
those of first-rate men; but Bennen, as (I believe) he surpasses all
the rest in the qualities which fit a man for a leader in hazardous
expeditions, combining boldness and prudence with an ease and power
peculiar to himself, so he has a faculty of conceiving and planning
his achievements, a way of concentrating his mind upon an idea, and
working out his idea with clearness and decision, which I never
observed in any man of the kind, and which makes him, in his way,
a sort of Garibaldi. Tyndall, on the day of our expedition, said
to him, ‘Sie sind der Garibaldi der Führer, Bennen;’ to which he
answered in his simple way, ‘Nicht wahr?’ (‘Am I not?’), an amusing
touch of simple vanity, a dash of pardonable bounce, being one of his
not least amiable characteristics. Thoroughly sincere and ‘einfach’
in thought and speech, devoted to his friends, without a trace of
underhand self-seeking in his relations to his employers, there is
an independence about him, a superiority to most of his own class,
which makes him, I always fancy, rather an isolated man; though no
one can make more friends wherever he goes, or be more pleasant and
thoroughly cheerful under all circumstances. But he left his native
place, Steinen, he told me, the people there not suiting him; and in
Laax, where he now dwells, I guess him to be not perhaps altogether
at home. Unmarried, he works quietly most of the year at his trade of
a carpenter, unless when he is out alone, or with his friend Bortis
(a man seemingly of reserved and uncommunicative disposition, but a
splendid mountaineer), in the chase after chamois, of which he is
passionately fond, and will tell stories, in his simple and emphatic
way, with the greatest enthusiasm. Pious he is, and observant of
religious duties, but without a particle of the ‘mountain gloom,’
respecting the prevalence of which among the dwellers in the High Alps
Mr. Ruskin discourses poetically, but I am myself rather incredulous.
A perfect nature’s gentleman, he is to me the most delightful of
companions; and though no ‘theory’ defines our reciprocal obligations
as guide and employer, I am sure that no precipice will ever engulf
me so long as Bennen is within reach, unless he goes into it also--an
event which seems impossible--and I think I can say I would, according
to the measure of my capacity, do the same by him. But any one who has
watched Bennen skimming along through the mazes of a crevassed glacier,
or running like a chamois along the side of slippery ice-covered crags,
axe and foot keeping time together, will think that--as Lauener said
of his brother Johann, who perished on the Jungfrau, _he_ could never
fall--nothing could bring him to grief but an avalanche.[5]

[5] As Bennen and Tyndall were going up the Finsteraarhorn once upon a
time, the work being severe, Bennen turned round and said to Tyndall,
‘Ich fühle mich jetzt ganz wie der Tyroler einmal,’ and went on to
relate a story of the conversation between a priest and an honest
Tyrolese, who complained to his father confessor that religion and an
extreme passion for the fair sex struggled within him, and neither
could expel the other. ‘Mein Sohn,’ said the priest, ‘Frauen zu lieben
und im Himmel zu kommen, das geht nicht.’ ‘Herr Pfarrer,’ sagte der
Tyroler, ‘_es muss gehen_.’ ‘Und so sag’ ich jetzt,’ cried Bennen. ‘Es
muss gehen’ is always his motto.

Delayed in our walk from the Æggischhorn by the usual severity of the
weather, Tyndall, Bennen, and myself reached Breuil on Saturday, August
18, to make our attempt on the Monday. As we approached the mountain,
Bennen’s countenance fell visibly, and he became somewhat gloomy; the
mountain was almost white with fresh-fallen snow. ‘Nur der Schnee
furcht mich,’ he replied to our enquiries. The change was indeed great
from my recollection of the year before; the well-marked, terrace-like
lines along the south face, which are so well given in Mr. George
Barnard’s picture, were now almost covered up; through the telescope
could be seen distinctly huge icicles depending from the crags, the
lines of melting snow, and the dark patches which we hoped might spread
a great deal faster than they were likely to, during the space of
twenty-four hours. There was nothing for it, although our prospects of
success were materially diminished by the snow, but to do the best we
could. As far as I was concerned, I felt that I should be perfectly
satisfied with getting part of the way up on a first trial, which would
make one acquainted with the nature of the rocks, dispel the prestige
which seemed to hang over the untrodden mountain, and probably suggest
ways of shortening the route on another occasion.

We wanted some one to carry the knapsack containing our provisions;
and on the recommendation of the landlord at Breuil, we sent for
a man, named Carrel, who, we were told, was the best mountaineer
in Val Tournanche, and the nephew of M. le Chanoine Carrel, whose
acquaintance I once had the honour of making at Aosta. From the latter
description I rather expected a young, and perhaps aristocratic-looking
personage, and was amused at the entrance of a rough, good-humoured,
shaggy-breasted man, between forty and fifty, an ordinary specimen of
the peasant class. However, he did his work well, and with great good
temper, and seemed ready to go on as long as we chose; though he told
me he expected we should end by passing the night somewhere on the
mountain, and I don’t think his ideas of our success were ever very
sanguine.

We were to start before 3 A.M. on Monday morning, August 20; and the
short period for sleep thus left us was somewhat abridged in my own
case, not so much by thoughts of the coming expedition, as by the
news which had just reached us in a vague, but, unfortunately, only
too credible form, of the terrible accident on the Col du Géant a few
days before. The account thus reaching us was naturally magnified,
and we were as yet ignorant of the names. I could not at night shake
off the (totally groundless) idea that a certain dear friend of mine
was among them, and that I ought at that moment to be hurrying off to
Courmayeur, to mourn and to bury him. In the morning, however, these
things are forgotten; we are off, and Carrel pilots us with a lantern
across the little stream which runs by Breuil, and up the hills to the
left, where in the darkness we seem from the sound to be in the midst
of innumerable rills of water, the effects of the late rains. The
dark outline of the Matterhorn is just visible against the sky, and
measuring with the eye the distance subtended by the height we have
to climb, it seems as if success _must_ be possible: so hard is it to
imagine all the ups and downs which lie in that short sky-line.

Day soon dawns, and the morning rose-light touches the first peak
westward of us; the air is wonderfully calm and still, and for to-day,
at all events, we have good weather, without that bitter enemy the
north wind; but a certain opaque look in the sky, long streaks of
cloud radiating from the south-west horizon up towards the zenith,
and the too dark purple of the hills south of Aosta, are signs that
the good weather will not be lasting. By five we are crossing the
first snow-beds, and now Carrel falls back, and the leader of the day
comes to the front: all the day he will be cutting steps, but those
compact and powerful limbs of his will show no signs of extra exertion,
and to-day he is in particularly good spirits. Carpentering, by the
way--not fine turning and planing, but rough out-of-doors work, like
Bennen’s--must be no bad practice to keep hand and eye in training
during the dead season. We ascend a narrow edge of snow, a cliff some
way to the right: the snow is frozen and hard as rock, and arms and
legs are worked vigorously. Tyndall calls out to me, to know whether I
recollect the ‘conditions:’ _i.e._ if your feet slip from the steps,
turn in a moment on your face, and dig in hard with alpenstock in both
hands under your body; by this means you will stop yourself if it is
possible. Once on your back, it is all over, unless others can save
you: you have lost all chance of helping yourself. In a few minutes
we stop, and rope all together, in which state we continued the whole
day. The prudence of this some may possibly doubt, as there were
certainly places where the chances were greater that if one fell, he
would drag down the rest, than that they could assist him; but we were
only four, all tolerably sure-footed, and in point of fact I do not
recollect a slip or stumble of consequence made by any one of us. Soon
the slope lessens for a while, but in front a wall of snow stretches
steeply upwards to a gap, which we have to reach, in a kind of recess,
flanked by crags of formidable appearance. We turn to the rocks on
the left hand. As, to one walking along miry ways, the opposite side
of the path seems ever the most inviting, and he continually shifting
his course from side to side lengthens his journey with small profit,
so in ascending a mountain one is always tempted to diverge from snow
to rocks, or _vice versâ_. Bennen had intended to mount straight up
towards the gap, and it is best not to interfere with him; he yields,
however, to our suggestions, and we assail the rocks. These, however,
are ice-bound, steep, and slippery: hands and knees are at work,
and progress is slow. At length we stop upon a ledge where all can
stand together, and Carrel proposes to us (for Bennen and he can only
communicate by signs, the one knowing only French, the other German)
to go on and see whether an easier way can be found still further to
the left. Bennen gives an approving nod: he looks with indulgent pity
on Carrel, but snubs all remarks of his as to the route. ‘Er weiss gar
nichts,’ he says. Carrel takes his axe, and mounts warily, but with
good courage; presently he returns, shaking his head. The event is
fortunate, for had we gone further to the left, we should have reached
the top of the ridge from which, as we afterwards found, there is no
passage to the gap, and our day’s work would probably have ended then
and there. Bennen now leads to the right, and moves swiftly up from
ledge to ledge. Time is getting on, but at length we emerge over the
rocks just in face of the gap, and separated from it by a sort of large
snow-crater, overhung on the left by the end of the ridge, from which
stones fall which have scarred the sides of the crater. The sides are
steep, but we curve quickly and silently round them: no stones fall
upon us; and now we have reached the narrow neck of snow which forms
the actual gap; it is half-past eight, and the first part of our work
is done.

By no means the hardest part, however. We stand upon a broad red
granite slab, the lowest step of the actual peak of the Matterhorn: no
one has stood there before us. The slab forms one end of the edge of
snow, surmounted at the other end by some fifty feet of overhanging
rock, the end of the ridge. On one side of us is the snow-crater, round
which we had been winding; on the other side a scarped and seamed
face of snow drops sheer on the north, to what we know is the Zmutt
glacier. Some hopes I had entertained of making a pass by this gap,
from Breuil to Zermatt, vanish immediately. Above us rise the towers
and pinnacles of the Matterhorn, certainly a tremendous array. Actual
contact immensely increases one’s impressions of this, the hardest and
strongest of all the mountain masses of the Alps; its form is more
remarkable than that of other mountains, not by chance, but because
it is built of more massive and durable materials, and more solidly
put together: nowhere have I seen such astonishing masonry. The broad
gneiss blocks are generally smooth and compact, with little appearance
of splintering or weathering. Tons of rock, in the shape of boulders,
must fall almost daily down its sides, but the amount of these, even
in the course of centuries, is as nothing compared with the mass of
the mountain; the ordinary processes of disintegration can have little
or no effect on it. If one were to follow Mr. Ruskin, in speculating
on the manner in which the Alpine peaks can have assumed their present
shape, it seems as if such a mass as this can have been blocked out
only while rising from the sea, under the action of waves such as beat
against the granite headlands of the Land’s End. Once on dry land, it
must stand as it does now, apparently for ever.

Two lines of ascent offer, between which we have to choose: one along
the middle or dividing ridge, the back-bone of the mountain, at the
end of which we stand; the other by an edge some little way to the
right: a couloir lies between them. We choose the former, or back-bone
ridge; but the other proves to be less serrated, and we shall probably
try it on another occasion. As we step from our halting-place, Bennen
turns round and addresses us in a few words of exhortation, like the
generals in Thucydides. He knows us well enough to be sure that we
shall not feel afraid, but every footstep must be planted with the
utmost precaution: no fear, ‘wohl immer Achtung.’ Soon our difficulties
begin; but I despair of relating the incidents of this part of our
route, so numerous and bewildering were the obstacles along it; and the
details of each have somewhat faded from the memory. We are immersed
in a wilderness of blocks, roofed and festooned with huge plates and
stalactites of ice, so large that one is half disposed to seize hold
and clamber up them. Round, over, and under them we go: often progress
seems impossible; but Bennen, ever in advance, and perched like a bird
on some projecting crag, contrives to find a way. Now we crawl singly
along a narrow ledge of rock, with a wall on one side, and nothing on
the other: there is no hold for hands or alpenstock, and the ledge
slopes a little, so that if the nails in our boots hold not, down
we shall go: in the middle of it a piece of rock juts out, which we
ingeniously duck under, and emerge just under a shower of water, which
there is no room to escape from. Presently comes a more extraordinary
place: a perfect chimney of rock, cased all over with hard black ice,
about an inch thick. The bottom leads out into space, and the top is
somewhere in the upper regions: there is absolutely nothing to grasp
at, and to this day I cannot understand how a human being could get up
or down it unassisted. Bennen, however, rolls up it somehow, like a
cat; he is at the top, and beckons Tyndall to advance; my turn comes
next; I endeavour to mount by squeezing myself against the sides, but
near the top friction suddenly gives way, and down comes my weight
upon the rope:--a stout haul from above, and now one knee is upon the
edge, and I am safe: Carrel is pulled up after me. After a time, we
get off the rocks, and mount a slope of ice, which curves rapidly over
for about three yards to our left, and then (apparently) drops at once
to the Zmutt glacier. We reach the top of this, and proceed along it,
till at last a sort of pinnacle is reached, from which we can survey
the line of towers and crags before us up to a point just below the
actual top, and we halt to rest a while. Bennen goes on to see whether
it be possible to cross over to the other ridge, which seems an easier
one. Left to himself, he treads lightly and almost carelessly along.
‘Geb’ Acht, Bennen!’ (Take care of yourself) we shout after him, but
needlessly; he stops and moves alternately, peering wistfully about,
exactly like a chamois; but soon he returns, and says there is no
passage, and we must keep to the ridge we are on.

Three hours had not yet elapsed since we left the gap, and from
our present station we could survey the route as far as a point
which concealed from us the actual summit, and could see that the
difficulties before us were not greater than we had already passed
through, and such as time and perseverance would surely conquer.
Nevertheless, there is a tide in the affairs of such expeditions, and
the impression had been for some time gaining ground with me that
the tide on the present occasion had turned against us, and that the
time we could prudently allow was not sufficient for us to reach the
top that day. Before trial, I had thought it not improbable that the
ascent might turn out either impossible or comparatively easy; it was
now tolerably clear that it was neither the one nor the other, but
an exceedingly long and hard piece of work, which the unparalleled
amount of ice made longer and harder than usual. I asked Bennen if he
thought there was time enough to reach the top of all: he was evidently
unwilling, however, to give up hopes; and Tyndall said he would give no
opinion either way; so we again moved on.

At length we came to the base of a mighty knob, huger and uglier than
its fellows, to which a little _arête_ of snow served as a sort of
drawbridge. I began to fear lest in the ardour of pursuit we might be
carried on too long, and Bennen might forget the paramount object of
securing our safe retreat. I called out to him that I thought I should
stop somewhere here, that if he could go faster alone he might do so,
but he must turn in good time. Bennen, however, was already climbing
with desperate energy up the sides of the kerb; Tyndall would not be
behind him; so I loosed the rope and let them go on. Carrel moved back
across the little _arête_, and sat down, and began to smoke: I remained
for a while standing with my back against the knob, and gazed by myself
upon the scene around.

As my blood cooled, and the sounds of human footsteps and voices grew
fainter, I began to realise the height and the wonderful isolation of
our position. The air was preternaturally still; an occasional gust
came eddying round the corner of the mountain, but all else seemed
strangely rigid and motionless, and out of keeping with the beating
heart and moving limbs, the life and activity of man. Those stones
and ice have no mercy in them, no sympathy with human adventure; they
submit passively to what man can do; but let him go a step too far,
let heart or hand fail, mist gather or sun go down, and they will
exact the penalty to the uttermost. The feeling of ‘the sublime’ in
such cases depends very much, I think, on a certain balance between
the forces of nature and man’s ability to cope with them: if they are
too weak, the scene fails to impress; if they are too strong for him,
what was sublime becomes only terrible. Looking at the Dôme du Goûté
or the Zumstein Spitze full in the evening sun, when they glow with an
absolutely unearthly loveliness, like a city in the heavens, I have
sometimes thought that, place but the spectator alone just now upon
those shining heights, with escape before night all but impossible, and
he will see no glory in the scene--only the angry eye of the setting
sun fixed on dark rocks and dead-white snow.

We had risen seemingly to an immense height above the gap, and the
ridge which stretches from the Matterhorn to the Dent d’Érin lay
flat below; but the peak still towered behind me, and, measuring our
position by the eye along the side of our neighbour of equal height,
the Weisshorn, I saw that we must be yet a long way beneath the top.
The gap itself, and all traces of the way by which we had ascended,
were invisible; I could see only the stone where Carrel sat, and the
tops of one or two crags rising from below. The view was, of course,
magnificent, and on three sides wholly unimpeded: with one hand I could
drop a stone which would descend to Zmutt, with the other to Breuil.
In front lay, as in a map, the as yet unexplored peaks to south and
west of the Dent d’Érin, the range which separates Val Tournanche from
the Valpelline, and the glacier region beyond, called in Ziegler’s
map Zardezan, over which a pass, perchance, exists to Zermatt. An
illimitable range of blue hills spread far away into Italy.

I walked along the little _arête_, and sat down; it was only broad
enough for the foot, and in perfectly cold blood even this perhaps
might have appeared uncomfortable. Turning to look at Tyndall and
Bennen, I could not help laughing at the picture of our progress under
difficulties. They seemed to have advanced only a few yards. ‘Have
you got no further than that yet?’ I called out, for we were all the
time within hearing. Their efforts appeared prodigious: scrambling and
sprawling among the huge blocks, one fancied they must be moving along
some unseen bale of heavy goods instead of only the weight of their own
bodies. As I looked, an ominous visitant appeared: down came a fragment
of rock, the size of a man’s body, and dashed past me on the couloir,
sending the snow flying. For a moment I thought they might have
dislodged it; but looking again I saw it had passed over their heads,
and come from the crags above. Neither of them, I believe, observed
the monster; but Tyndall told me afterwards that a stone, possibly a
splinter from it, had hit him in the neck, and nearly choked him. I
looked anxiously again, but no more followed. A single shot, as it
were, had been fired across our bows; but the ship’s course was already
on the point of being put about.

Expecting fully that they would not persevere beyond a few minutes
longer, I called out to Tyndall to know how soon they meant to be
back. ‘In an hour and a half,’ he replied, whether in jest or earnest,
and they disappeared round a projecting corner. A sudden qualm seized
me, and for a few minutes I felt extremely uncomfortable: what if the
ascent should suddenly become easier, and they should go on, and reach
the top without me? I thought of summoning Carrel, and pursuing them;
but the worthy man sat quietly, and seemed to have had enough of it.
My suspense, however, was not long: after two or three minutes the
clatter, which had never entirely ceased, became louder, and their
forms again appeared: they were evidently descending. In fact, Bennen
had at length turned, and said to Tyndall, ‘Ich denke die Zeit ist zu
kurz.’ I was glad that he had gone on as long as he chose, and not been
turned back on my responsibility. They had found one part of this last
ascent the worst of any, but the way was open thenceforward to the
farthest visible point, which can be no long way below the actual top.

It was now just about mid-day, and ample time for the descent, in all
probability, was before us; but we resolved not to halt for any length
of time till we should reach the gap. Descending, unlike ascending,
is generally not so bad as it seems; but in some places here only one
can advance at a time, the other carefully holding the rope. ‘Tenez
fortement, Carrel, tenez,’ is constantly impressed on the man who
brings up the rear. ‘Splendid practice for us, this,’ exclaims Tyndall
exultingly, as each successive difficulty is overcome. At length we
reach a place whence no egress is possible; we look in vain for traces
of the way we had come: it is our friend the ice-coated chimney.
Bennen gets down first, in the same mysterious fashion as he got up,
and assists us down; presently a shout is heard behind; Carrel is
attempting to get down by himself, and has stuck fast; Bennen has to
extricate him. We are now getting rapidly lower; soon the difficulties
diminish; our gap appears in sight, and once more we reach the broad
granite slab beside the narrow col, and breathe more freely.

Two hours have brought us down thus far; but if we are to return by
the way we came, three or four hours of hard work are still needed
before we arrive at anything like ordinary snow-walking. We hold a
consultation. Bennen thinks the rocks, now that the ice is melting in
the afternoon sun, will be difficult, and ‘withal somewhat dangerous’
(etwa gefährlich auch). The reader will remark that Bennen uses
the word ‘dangerous’ in its legitimate sense. A place is dangerous
where a good climber cannot be secure of his footing; a place is
_not_ dangerous where a good climber is in no danger of slipping,
although to slip may be fatal. We determine to see if it be possible
to descend the sides of the snow-crater, on the brink of which we
now stand. The crater is portentously steep, deeply lined with fresh
snow, which glistens and melts in the powerful sun. The experiment
is slightly hazardous, but we resolve to try. The crater appears to
narrow gradually to a sort of funnel far down below, through which we
expect to issue into the glacier beneath. At the sides of the funnel
are rocks, which some one suggests might serve to break our fall,
should the snow go down with us, but their tender mercies seem to me
doubtful. Cautiously, with steady, balanced tread, we commit ourselves
to the slope, distributing the weight of the body over as large a space
of snow as possible, by fixing in the pole high up, and the feet far
apart, for a slip or stumble now will probably dissolve the adhesion of
the fresh, not yet compacted mass, and we shall go down to the bottom
in an avalanche. Six paces to the right, then again to the left; we
are at the mercy of those overhanging rocks just now, and the recent
tracks of stones look rather suspicious; but all is silent, and soon we
gain confidence, and congratulate ourselves on an expedient which has
saved us hours of time and toil. Just to our right the snow is sliding
by, first slowly, then faster; keep well out of the track of it, for
underneath is a hard polished surface, and if your foot chance to
light there, off you will probably shoot. The snow travels much faster
than we do, or have any desire to do; we are like a coach travelling
alongside of an express train; in popular phrase, we are going side
by side with a small avalanche, though a real avalanche is a very
different matter. Soon we come somewhat under the lee of the rocks,
and now all risk is over, we are through the funnel, and floundering
waist-deep, heedless of crevasses in the comparatively level slopes
beyond. We plunge securely down now in the deep snow, where care and
caution had been requisite in crossing the frozen surface in the
morning; at length we cast off the rope, and are on terra firma.

We shall be at Breuil in unexpectedly good time, before five o’clock;
but it is well we are off the mountain early, for clouds and mist are
already gathering round the peak, and the weather is about to break.
Tyndall rushes rapidly down the slopes, and is lost to view; Bennen
and I walk slowly, discussing the results of the day. I am glad to see
that he is in high spirits, and confident of our future success. He
agrees with me to reach the top will be an exceedingly long day’s work,
and that we must allow ten hours at least for the actual peak, six
to ascend, four to descend; we must start next time, he says, ‘ganz,
ganz früh,’ and manage to reach the gap by seven o’clock. Presently we
deviate a little from our downward course; the same thought occupies
our minds; we perceive a long low line of roof on the mountain-side,
and are not mistaken in supposing that our favourite food will at this
hour be found there in abundance. The shepherds on the Italian hills
are more hospitable and courteous, I think, than their Swiss brethren:
twenty cows are moving their tails contentedly in line under the
shed, for Breuil is a rich pasture valley, and in an autumn evening I
have counted six herds of from ninety to a hundred each, in separate
clusters, like ants, along the stream in the distance. The friendly
man, in hoarse but hearty tones, urges us on as we drink; Bennen puts
into his hand forty centimes for us both (for we have disposed of no
small quantity): but he is with difficulty persuaded to accept so
large a sum, and calls after us, ‘C’est trop, c’est trop, messieurs.’
Long may civilisation and half-francs fail of reaching his simple
abode; for, alas! the great tourist-world is corrupting the primitive
chalet-life of the Alps, and the Alpine man returning to his old
haunts, finds a rise in the price even of ‘niedl’ and ‘mascarpa.’

The day after our expedition Bennen and myself recrossed the Théodule
in a heavy snow-storm. Tyndall started for Chamouni, for the weather
was too bad to justify an indefinite delay at Breuil in the hope of
making another attempt that year, and by waiting till another season
we were sure of obtaining less unfavourable conditions of snow and ice
upon the mountain.--We had enjoyed an exciting and adventurous day,
and I myself was not sorry to have something still left to do, while
we had the satisfaction of being the first to set foot on this, the
most imposing and mightiest giant of the Alps--the ‘inaccessible’ Mont
Cervin.--_Vacation Tourists, 1860._




IV.

_THERMOMETRIC STATION ON MONT BLANC._


The thermometers referred to at p. 17 were placed on Mont Blanc in
1859. I had proposed to the Royal Society some time previously to
establish a series of stations between the top and bottom of the
mountain, and the council of the society was kind enough to give me
its countenance and aid in the undertaking. At Chamouni I had a number
of wooden piles shod with iron. The one intended for the summit was
twelve feet long and three inches square; the others, each ten feet
long, were intended for five stations between the top of the mountain
and the bottom of the Glacier de Bossons. Each post was furnished with
a small cross-piece, to which a horizontal minimum thermometer might
be attached. Six-and-twenty porters were found necessary to carry
all the apparatus to the Grands Mulets, whence fourteen of them were
immediately sent back. The other twelve, with one exception, reached
the summit, whence six of them were sent back. Six therefore remained.
In addition to these we had three guides, Auguste Balmat being the
principal one; these, with Dr. Frankland and myself, made up eleven
persons in all. Though the main object of the expedition was to plant
the posts and fix the thermometers, I was very anxious to make some
observations on the transparency of the lower strata of the atmosphere
to the solar heat-rays. I therefore arranged a series of observations
with the Abbé Veuillet, of Chamouni; he was to operate in the valley,
while I observed at the top. Our instruments were of the same kind;
in this way I hoped to determine the influence of the stratum of air
interposed between the top and bottom of the mountain upon the solar
radiation.

Wishing to commence the observations at daybreak, I had a tent carried
to the summit, where I proposed to spend the night. The tent was ten
feet in diameter, and into it the whole eleven of us were packed. The
north wind blew rather fiercely over the summit, but we dropped down
a few yards to leeward, and thus found shelter. Throughout the night
we did not suffer at all from cold, though we had no fire, and the
adjacent snow was 15° Cent., or 27° Fahr., below the freezing point of
water. We were all however indisposed. I was indeed very unwell when I
quitted Chamouni; but had I faltered my party would have melted away. I
had frequently cast off illness on previous occasions, and hoped to do
so now. But in this I was unsuccessful; my illness was more deep-rooted
than ordinary, and it augmented during the entire period of the ascent.
Towards morning, however, I became stronger, while with some of my
companions the reverse was the case. At daybreak the wind increased in
force, and as the fine snow was perfectly dry, it was driven over us
in clouds. Had no other obstacle existed, this alone would have been
sufficient to render the observations on solar radiation impossible.
We were therefore obliged to limit ourselves to the principal object
of the expedition--the erection of the post for the thermometers.
It was sunk six feet in the snow, while the remaining six feet were
exposed to the air. A minimum thermometer was screwed firmly on to the
cross-piece of the post; a maximum thermometer was screwed on beneath
this, and under this again a wet and dry bulb thermometer. Two minimum
thermometers were also placed in the snow--one at a depth of six,
and the other at a depth of four feet below the surface--these being
intended to give some information as to the depth to which the winter
cold penetrates. At each of the other stations we placed a minimum
thermometer in the ice or snow, and a maximum and a minimum in the air.

The stations were as follows:--The summit, the Corridor, the Grand
Plateau, the glacier near the Grands Mulets, and two additional ones
between the Grands Mulets and the end of the Glacier de Bossons. We
took up some rockets, to see whether the ascensional power, or the
combustion, was affected by the rarity of the air. During the night,
however, we were enveloped in a dense mist, which defeated our purpose.
One rocket was sent up which (though we did not know it) penetrated the
mist, and was seen at Chamouni. Lecomte’s experiments on the alleged
influence of light and rarefaction in retarding combustion caused me to
resolve on making a series of experiments on Mont Blanc. Dr. Frankland
was kind enough to undertake their execution. Six candles were chosen
at Chamouni, and carefully weighed. All of them were permitted to
burn for one hour at the top, and were again weighed when we returned
to Chamouni. They were afterwards permitted to burn an hour below.
Rejecting one candle, which gave a somewhat anomalous result, we found
that the quantity consumed above was, within the limits of error, the
same as that consumed at the bottom. This result surprised us all
the more, inasmuch as the _light_ of the candles appeared to be much
feebler at the top than at the bottom of the mountain.

The explosion of a pistol was sensibly weaker at the top than at a
low level. The _shortness_ of the sound was remarkable; but it bore no
resemblance to the sound of a cracker, to which in acoustic treatises
it is usually compared. It resembled more the sound produced by the
expulsion of a cork from a champagne-bottle, but it was much louder.
The sunrise from the summit was singularly magnificent. The snow on the
shaded flanks of the mountain was of a pure blue, being illuminated
solely by the _reflected_ light of the sky; the summit of the mountain,
on the contrary, was crimson, being illuminated by _transmitted_ light.
The contrast of both was finer than I can describe.

About twenty hours were spent upon the top of Mont Blanc on this
occasion. Had I been better satisfied with the conduct of the guides,
it would have given me pleasure at the time to dwell upon this
out-of-the-way episode in mountain life. But a temper, new to me, and
which I thought looked very like mutiny, showed itself on the part
of some of my men. Its manifestation was slight, I must say, in most
cases, and conspicuous only in one. Regrets and apologies followed,
and due allowance ought to be made for the perfectly novel position in
which the men found themselves. The awe of entire strangeness is very
powerful in some minds; and to my companions the notion of spending
a night at the top of Mont Blanc was passing strange. The thing had
never been attempted previously, nor has the experiment been repeated
since.

As stated at p. 17, I made an attempt during the execrable weather
of 1860 to reach the top, but was driven down after a delay of
twenty hours at the Grands Mulets. The same weather destroyed the
lower stations. In 1861, though the cross still remained at the top,
the thermometers exhibited broken columns and were worthless for
observation.

I may add, in conclusion, that the lowest temperature at the summit of
the Jardin during the winter of 1858 was 21° Cent. below zero. In 1859
I vainly endeavoured to find a thermometer which had been placed in the
snow upon the summit of Mont Blanc a year previously.




V.


From a little book called ‘Mountaineering in 1861,’ published nine
years ago, but long since out of print, I will now make a few
selections. The mountain work of that year embraced the ascent of the
Weisshorn, and the passage of the barrier between the Cima di Jazzi and
Monte Rosa by an untried and dangerous route. Both these expeditions
are described. But, besides these narratives of outward action, I
notice in the book a subjective element, consisting of the musings
and reflections to which I often abandon myself when sauntering over
easy ground, and without which even Switzerland would sometimes be
monotonous to me. It is only from the reader accustomed to similar
reflective moods that I expect acceptance, or even tolerance, of these
musings: the man of action will pass them impatiently by. I begin with


_A LETTER FROM BÂLE._

‘I reached Bâle last night, and now sit on the balcony of the “Three
Kings” with the Rhine flashing below me. It is silent here, but higher
up, in passing the props of a bridge, it breaks into foam; its
compressed air-bubbles burst like elastic springs, and shake the air
into sonorous vibrations.[6] Thus the rude mechanical motion of the
river is converted into music. The hammer of the boat-builder rings
on his plank, the leaves of the poplars rustle in the breeze, the
watchdog’s honest bark is heard in the distance; while from the windows
of the houses along the banks gleam a series of reflected suns, each
surrounded by a coloured glory.

[6] See note at the end of this chapter.

‘Yesterday I travelled from Paris, and the day previous from London,
when the trail of a spent storm swept across the sea and kept its
anger awake. The stern of our boat went up and down, the distant craft
were equally pendulous, and the usual results followed. Men’s faces
waxed green, roses faded from ladies’ cheeks; while puzzled children
yelled intermittently in the grasp of the demon which had newly taken
possession of them. One rare pale maiden sat right in the line of the
spray, and bore the violence of the ocean with the resignation of an
angel. A white arm could be seen shining through translucent muslin,
but even against it the brine beat as if it were a mere seaweed. I sat
at rest, hovering fearfully on the verge of that doleful region, whose
bourne most of those on board had already passed, thinking how directly
materialistic is the tendency of sea-sickness, through its remorseless
demonstration of the helplessness of the human soul and will.

‘The morning of the 1st of August found me on my way from Paris
to Bâle. The sun was strong, and, in addition to this source of
temperature, eight human beings, each burning the slow fire which
we call life, were cooped within the limits of our compartment. We
slept, first singly, then by groups, and finally as a whole. Vainly
we endeavoured to ward off the coming lethargy. Thought gradually
slips away from its object, or the object glides out of the nerveless
grasp of thought, and we are conquered by the heat. But what _is_
heat, that it should work such changes in moral and intellectual
nature? Why are we unable to read “Mill’s Logic” or study the “Kritik
der reinen Vernunft” with any profit in a Turkish bath? Heat,
defined without reference to our sensations, is a kind of motion,
as strictly mechanical as the waves of the sea, or as the aërial
vibrations which produce sound. The communication of this motion to
the molecules of the brain produces the moral and intellectual effects
just referred to. Human action is only possible within a narrow zone
of temperature. Transgress the limit on one side, and we are torpid
by excess; transgress it on the other, and we are torpid by defect.
The intellect is in some sense a function of temperature. Thus at
noon we were drained of intellectual energy; eight hours later the
mind was awake and active, and through her operations was shed that
feeling of earnestness and awe which the mystery of the starry heavens
ever inspires. Physically considered, however, the intellect of noon
differed from that of 8 P.M. simply in the amount of motion possessed
by the molecules of the brain.

‘It is not levity which prompts me to write thus. Matter, in relation
to vital phenomena, has yet to be studied, and the command of Canute to
the waves would be wisdom itself compared with any attempt to stop such
enquiries. Let the tide rise, and let knowledge advance; the limits
of the one are not more rigidly fixed than those of the other; and no
worse infidelity could seize upon the mind than the belief that a man’s
earnest search after truth should culminate in his perdition.’

The sun was high in heaven as we rolled away from Bâle on the morning
of the 2nd. Sooner or later every intellectual canker disappears before
earnest work, the influence of which, moreover, fills a wide margin
beyond the time of its actual performance. Thus, to-day, I sang as I
rolled along--not with boisterous glee, but with serene and deep-lying
gladness of heart. This happiness, however, had its roots in the past,
and had I not been a worker previous to my release from London, I
could not now have been so glad an idler. In any other country than
Switzerland the valley through which we sped would have called forth
admiration and delight. Noble fells, proudly grouped, flanked us right
and left. Cloud-like woods of pines overspread them in broad patches,
with between them spaces of the tenderest green, while among the
meadows at their feet gleamed the rushing Rhine.

The zenith was blue, but the thick stratum of horizontal air invested
the snowy peaks with a veil of translucent haze, through which their
vast and spectral outlines were clearly seen. As we rolled on towards
Thun the haze thickened, while dense and rounded clouds burst upwards,
as if let loose from a prison behind the mountains. Soon afterwards the
black haze and blacker clouds resolved themselves into a thunderstorm.
The air was cut repeatedly by zigzag bars of solid light. Then came the
cannonade, and then the heavy rain-pellets rattling with fury against
the carriages. It afterwards cleared, but not wholly. Stormy cumuli
swept round the mountains, between which, however, the illuminated
ridges seemed to swim in the opalescent air.

At Thun I found my faithful and favourite guide, Johann Bennen, of
Laax, in the valley of the Rhone, the strongest limb and stoutest heart
of my acquaintance in the Alps. We took the steamer to Interlaken,
and while we were on the lake the heavens again darkened, and the deck
was flooded by the gushing rain. The dusky cloud-curtain was rent at
intervals, and through the apertures thus formed parallel bars of
extraordinary radiance escaped across the lake. On reaching Interlaken
I drove to the steamer on the lake of Brientz. We started at 6 P.M.,
with a purified atmosphere, and passed through scenes of serene beauty
in the tranquil evening light. The bridge of Brientz had been carried
away by the floods, the mail was intercepted, and I joined a young
Oxford man in a vehicle to Meyringen. The west wind again filled the
atmosphere with gloom, and after supper I spent an hour watching the
lightning thrilling behind the clouds. The darkness was intense, and
the intermittent glare correspondingly impressive. Sometimes the
lightning seemed to burst, like a fireball, midway between the horizon
and the zenith, spreading a vast glory behind the clouds and revealing
all their outlines. In front of me was a craggy summit, which indulged
in intermittent shots of thunder; sharp, dry, and sudden, with scarcely
an echo to soften them off.


NOTE ON THE SOUND OF AGITATED WATER.

A liquid vein descending through a round hole in the bottom of a tin
vessel exhibits two distinct portions, the one steady and limpid, the
other unsteady and apparently turbid. The flash of an electric spark in
a dark room instantly resolves the turbid portion into isolated drops.
Experiments made in 1849 with such a jet directed my attention to the
origin of the sound of agitated water. When the smoke is projected
from the lips of a tobacco-smoker, a little explosion usually occurs,
which is chiefly due to the sudden bursting of the film of saliva
connecting both lips. An inflated bladder bursts with an explosion as
loud as a pistol-shot. Sound to some extent always accompanies the
sudden liberation of compressed air, and this fact is also exhibited in
the deportment of a water-jet. If the surface of water into which the
jet falls intersect its limpid portion, the jet enters _silently_, and
no bubbles are produced. If the surface cut the turbid portion of the
jet, bubbles make their appearance with an accompaniment of sound. The
very nature of the sound pronounces its origin to be the bursting of
the bubbles; and to the same cause the murmur of streams and the sound
of breakers appear to be almost exclusively due. The impact of water
against water is a comparatively subordinate cause of the sound, and
could never of itself occasion the ‘babble’ of a brook or the musical
roar of the ocean.--_Philosophical Magazine_, February 1857.




VI.

_THE URBACHTHAL AND GAULI GLACIER._


Our bivouac at Meyringen was _le Sauvage_, who discharged his duty as a
host with credit to himself and with satisfaction to us. Forster (the
statesman) arrived, and in the afternoon of the 3rd we walked up the
valley, with the view of spending the night at Hof. Between Meyringen
and Hof, the vale of Hasli is crossed by a transverse ridge called the
Kirchet, and the barrier is at one place split through, forming a deep
chasm with vertical sides through which plunges the river Aar. The
chasm is called the Finsteraarschlucht, and by the ready hypothesis of
an earthquake its formation has been explained. Man longs for causes,
and the weaker minds, unable to restrain their longing, often barter,
for the most sorry theoretic pottage, the truth which patient enquiry
would make their own. This proneness of the human mind to jump to
conclusions, and thus shirk the labour of real investigation, is a most
mischievous tendency. We complain of the contempt with which practical
men regard theory, and, to confound them, triumphantly exhibit the
speculative achievements of master minds. But the practical man, though
puzzled, remains unconvinced; and why? Simply because nine out of ten
of the theories with which he is acquainted are deserving of nothing
better than contempt. Our master minds built their theoretic edifices
upon the rock of fact, the quantity of fact necessary to enable them to
divine the _law_ being a measure of individual genius, and not a test
of philosophic system.[7]

[7] This was written soon after Mr. Buckle’s Royal Institution lecture,
which I thought a piece of astonishing rhetoric, but of very unsound
science.

The level plain of Hof lies above the mound of the Kirchet; how was
this flat formed? Is it not composed of the sediment of a lake? Did
not the Kirchet form the dam of this lake, a stream issuing from the
latter and falling over the dam? And as the sea-waves find a weak point
in the cliffs against which they dash, and gradually eat their way so
as to form caverns with high vertical sides, as at the Land’s End, a
joint or fault or some other accidental weakness determining their line
of action; so also a mountain torrent rushing for ages over the same
dam would be sure to cut itself a channel. The lake after its drainage
left the basis of green meadows as sediment behind; and through these
meadows now flows the stream of the Aar. Imagination is essential to
the natural philosopher, but its matter must be facts; and its function
the discernment of their connection.

We were called at 4 A.M., an hour later than we intended, and the sight
of the cloudless mountains was an inspiration to us all. At 5.30 A.M.
we were off, crossing the valley of Hof, which was hugged round its
margin by a light and silky mist. We ascended a spur which separated
us from the Urbachthal, through which our route lay. The Aar for a
time babbled in the distance, until, on turning a corner, its voice
was suddenly quenched by the louder music of the Urbach, rendered
mellow and voluminous by the resonance of the chasm into which the
torrent leaped. The sun was already strong. His yellow light glimmered
from the fresh green leaves; it smote with glory the boles and the
plumes of the pines; soft shadows fell from shrub and rock upon the
pastures; snow-peaks were in sight, cliffy summits also, without snow
or verdure, but in many cases buttressed by slopes of soil which bore
a shaggy growth of trees. To the right of us rose the bare cliffs of
the Engelhörner, broken at the top into claw-shaped masses which were
turned, as if in spite, against the serene heaven. Bennen walked on
in front, a mass of organised force, silent, but emitting at times a
whistle which sounded like the piping of a lost chamois. In a hollow
of the Engelhörner a mass of snow had found a lodgment; melted by the
warm rock, its foundation was sapped, and down it came in a thundering
cascade. The thick pinewoods to our right were furrowed by the tracks
of these destroyers, the very wind of which, it is affirmed, tears up
distant trees by the roots.

For a time our route lay through a spacious valley, which at length
turned to the left, and narrowed to a gorge. Along its bottom the
hissing river rushed; this we crossed, climbed the wall of a _cul de
sac_, and from its rim enjoyed a glorious view. The Urbachthal has been
the scene of vast glacier action. Looking at these charactered cliffs,
one’s thoughts involuntarily revert to the ancient days, and we restore
in idea a state of things which had disappeared from the world before
the development of man. Whence this wondrous power of reconstruction?
Was it locked like latent heat in ancient inorganic nature, and
developed as the ages rolled? Are other and grander powers still
latent in nature, destined to blossom in another age? Let us question
fearlessly, but, having done so, let us avow frankly that at bottom we
know nothing; that we are imbedded in a mystery, towards the solution
of which no whisper has been yet conceded to the listening intellect of
man.

The world of life and beauty is now retreating, and the world of death
and beauty is at hand. We were soon at the end of the Gauli glacier,
from which the impetuous Urbach rushes, and turned into a chalet for
a draught of milk. The Senner within proved an extortioner--‘_Ein
unverschämter Hund_;’ but let him pass. We worked along the flank of
the glacier to a point which commands a view of the cliffy barrier
which it is the main object of our journey to pass. From a range of
snow-peaks linked together by ridges of black rock, the Gauli glacier
falls, at first steeply as snow, then more gently as ice. We scan the
mountain barrier to ascertain where it ought to be attacked. No one
of us has ever been here before, and the scanty scraps of information
which we have received tell us that at one place only is the barrier
passable. We may reach the summit at several points from this side,
but all save one, we are informed, lead to the brink of intractable
precipices, which fall sheer to the Lauteraar glacier. We observe,
discuss, and finally decide. We enter upon the glacier; black chasms
yawn here and there through the superincumbent snow, but there is no
real difficulty. We cross the glacier and reach the opposite slopes;
our way first lies up a moraine, and afterwards through the snow; a
laborious ascent brings us close to the ridge, and here we pause once
more in consultation. There is a gentle indentation to our left, and a
cleft in the rocks to our right; our information points to the cleft,
but we decide in favour of the saddle.

The winter snows were here thickly laid against the precipitous crags;
the lower part of the buttress thus formed had broken away from the
upper, which still clung to the rocks, the whole ridge being thus
defended by a profound chasm, called in Switzerland a Bergschrund.
At some places portions of snow had fallen away from the upper slope
and partially choked the schrund, closing, however, its mouth only,
and on this snow we were now to seek a footing. Bennen and myself
were loose coming up; Forster and his guide were tied together; but
now my friend declares that we must all be attached. We accordingly
rope ourselves, and advance along the edge of the fissure to a place
where it is partially stopped. A vertical wall of snow faces us. Our
leader carefully treads down the covering of the chasm; and having
thus rendered it sufficiently rigid to stand upon, he cuts a deep gap
with his ice-axe in the opposing wall. Into the gap he tries to force
himself, but the mass yields, and he falls back, sinking deeply in the
snow of the schrund. He stands right over the fissure, which is merely
bridged by the snow. I call out, ‘Take care!’ he responds, ‘All right!’
and returns to the charge. He hews a deeper and more ample gap; strikes
his axe into the slope above him, and leaves it there; buries his
hands in the yielding mass, and raises his body on his two arms, as on
a pair of pillars. He thus clears the schrund and anchors his limbs in
the snow above. I am speedily at his side, and we both tighten the rope
as our friend Forster advances. With perfect courage and a faultless
head, he has but one disadvantage, and that is an excess of weight of
at least two stone. In his first attempt the snow-ledge breaks, and
he falls back; but two men are now at the rope, the tension of which,
aided by his own activity, prevents him from sinking far. By a second
effort he clears the difficulty, is followed by his guide, and all four
of us reach the slope above the chasm. Its steepness was greater than
that of a cathedral roof, while below us, and within a few yards of us,
was a chasm into which it would be certain death to fall. Education
enables us to regard a position of this kind almost with indifference;
still the work was by no means unexciting. In this early stage of our
summer performances, it required perfect trust in our leader to keep
our minds at ease. We reached the saddle, and a cheer at the summit
announced that our escape was secured.

The indentation formed the top of a kind of chimney or funnel in the
rocks, which led right down to the Lauteraar glacier. Elated with our
success, I released myself from the rope and sprang down the chimney,
preventing the descent from quickening to an absolute fall by seizing
at intervals the projecting rocks. Once an effort of this kind shook
the alpenstock from my hand: it slid along the rubbish, reached a
snow-slope, shot down it, and was caught on some shingle at the bottom
of the slope. Quickly skirting the snow, which, without a staff,
cannot be trusted, I reached a ridge, from which a jump landed me on
the _débris_: it yielded and carried me down; passing the alpenstock
I seized it, and in an instant was master of all my motions. Another
snow-slope was reached, down which I shot to the rocks at the bottom,
and there awaited the arrival of my guide.

We diverged from the deep cut of the chimney, Bennen adhering to the
rough rocks, while I, hoping to make an easier descent through the
funnel itself, resorted to it. It was partially filled with indurated
snow, but underneath was a stream, and my ignorance of the thickness
of the roof rendered caution necessary. At one place the snow was
broken quite across, and a dark tunnel, through which the stream
rushed, opened immediately below me. My descent being thus cut off,
I crossed the couloir to the opposite rocks, climbed them, and found
myself upon the summit of a ledged precipice, below which Bennen stood,
watching me as I descended. On one of the ledges my foot slipped; a
most melancholy whine issued from my guide, as he suddenly moved
towards me; but the slip in no way compromised me; I reached the next
ledge, and in a moment was clear of the difficulty. We dropped down
the mountain together, quitted the rocks, and reached the glacier,
where we were soon joined by Forster and his companion. Turning round,
we espied a herd of seven chamois on one of the distant slopes of
snow. The telescope reduced them to five full-grown animals and two
pretty little kids. The day was fading and the deeper glacier pools
were shaded by their icy banks. Through the shadowed water needles of
ice were darting: all day long the molecules had been kept asunder
by the antagonistic heat; their enemy is now withdrawn, and they
lock themselves together in a crystalline embrace. Through a reach
of merciless shingle, which covers the lower part of the glacier, we
worked our way; then over green pastures and rounded rocks, to the
Grimsel Hotel, which, uncomfortable as it is, was reached with pleasure
by us all.




VII.

_THE GRIMSEL AND THE ÆGGISCHHORN._


This Grimsel is a weird region--a monument carved with hieroglyphics
more ancient and more grand than those of Nineveh or the Nile. It is a
world disinterred by the sun from a sepulchre of ice. All around are
evidences of the existence and the might of the glaciers which once
held possession of the place. All around the rocks are carved, and
fluted, and polished, and scored. Here and there angular pieces of
quartz, held fast by the ice, inserted their edges into the rocks and
scratched them like diamonds, the scratches varying in depth and width
according to the magnitude of the cutting stone. Larger masses, held
similarly captive, scooped longitudinal depressions in the rocks over
which they passed, while in many cases the polishing must have been
effected by the ice itself. A raindrop will wear a stone away; much
more would an ice surface, squeezed into perfect contact by enormous
pressure, rub away the asperities of the rocks over which for ages it
was forced to slide. The rocks thus polished by the ice itself are so
exceedingly smooth and slippery that it is impossible to stand on them
where their inclination is at all considerable. But what a world it
must have been when the valleys were thus filled! We can restore the
state of things in thought, and in doing so we submerge many a mass
which now lifts its pinnacle skyward. Switzerland in those days could
not be so grand as it is now. Pour ice into those valleys till they are
filled, and you eliminate those contrasts of height and depth on which
the grandeur of Alpine scenery depends. Instead of skiey pinnacles and
deep-cut gorges we should have an icy sea dotted with dreary islands
formed by the highest mountain-tops.

In the afternoon I strolled up to the Siedelhorn. As I stood upon the
broken summit of the mountain the air was without a cloud; and the
sunbeams fell directly against the crown and slopes of the Galenstock
at the base of which lay the glacier of the Rhone. The level sea of
_névé_ above the great ice-cascade, the fall itself, and the terminal
glacier below the fall were all apparently at hand. At the base of the
fall the ice undergoes an extraordinary transformation; it reaches this
place more or less amorphous, it quits it most beautifully laminated,
the change being due to the pressure endured at the bottom of the fall.
The wrinkling of the glacier here was quite visible, the dwindling
of the wrinkles into bands, and the subdivision of these bands into
lines which mark the edges of the laminæ of which the glacier at this
place is made up. Beyond, amid the mountains at the opposite side of
the Rhone valley, lay the Gries glacier, half its snow in shadow,
and half illuminated by the sinking sun. Round farther to the right
were the Monte Leone and other grand masses, the grandest here being
the Mischabel with its crowd of snowy cones. Jumping a gap in the
mountains, we hit the stupendous cone of the Weisshorn, which slopes to
meet the inclines of the Mischabel, and in the wedge of space carved
out between the two the Matterhorn lifts its terrible head.

Wheeling farther in the same direction, we at length strike the mighty
spurs of the Finsteraarhorn, between two of which lies the Oberaar
glacier. Here is no turmoil of crevasses, no fantastic ice-pinnacles,
nothing to indicate the operation of those tremendous forces by which
a glacier sometimes rends its own breast. The grimmest giant of the
Oberland closes the view at the head of the Lauteraar glacier--the
Schreckhorn, whose cliffs on this side no mountaineer will ever scale.
Between the Schreckhorn and Finsteraarhorn a curious group of peaks
encircle a flat snow-field, from which the sunbeams are flung in
blazing lines. Immediately below is the Unteraar glacier, with a long
black streak upon its back, bent hither and thither, like a serpent
wriggling down the valley. Beyond it and flanking it is a ridge of
mountains with a crest of vertical rock, hacked into indentations which
suggest a resemblance to a cock’s comb. To the very root of the comb
the mountains have been planed by the ancient ice.

A scene of unspeakable desolation it must have been when not
Switzerland alone, but all Europe, was thus encased in frozen
armour--when a glacier from Ben Nevis dammed the mouth of Glenroy,
and Llanberis and Borrodale were ploughed by frozen shares sent down
by Snowdon and Scawfell--when from the Reeks of Magillicuddy came the
navigators which dug out space for the Killarney lakes, and carved
through the mountains the Gap of Dunloe.[8] Evening came, and I moved
downwards, over heaped boulders and tufted alp; down with headlong
speed over the rounded rocks of the Grimsel, making long springs at
intervals, over the polished inclines, and reaching the hospice as the
bell rings its inmates to their evening meal.

[8] See chapter on ‘Killarney,’ p. 413.

On Saturday I ascended from Viesch to the Hotel Jungfrau on the slope
of the Æggischhorn, and in the evening walked up to the summit of the
mountain alone. As usual, I wandered unconsciously from the beaten
track, getting into a chaos of crags which had been shaken from the
heights. My ascent was quick, and I soon found myself upon the crest
of broken rocks which caps the mountain. The peak and those adjacent,
which are similarly shattered, exhibit a striking picture of the ruin
which nature inflicts upon her own creations. She buildeth up and
taketh down. She lifts the mountains by her subterranean energies, and
then blasts them by her lightnings and her frost. Thus grandly she
rushes along the ‘grooves of change’ to her unattainable repose. Is it
unattainable? The incessant tendency of material forces is toward final
equilibrium; and if the quantity of this tendency be finite, a time
of repose must come at last. If one portion of the universe be hotter
than another, a flux instantly sets in to equalise the temperatures;
while winds blow and rivers roll in search of a stable equilibrium.
Matter longs for rest; when is this longing to be fully satisfied? If
satisfied, what then? Rest is not perfection; it is death. Life is only
compatible with mutation; when equilibrium sets in life ceases, and the
world thenceforward is locked in everlasting sleep.

A wooden cross bleached by many storms surmounts the pinnacle of the
Æggischhorn, and at the base of it I now take my place and scan the
surrounding scene. Down from its birthplace in the mountains comes
that noblest of ice-streams the Great Aletsch glacier. Its arms are
thrown round the shoulders of the Jungfrau, while from the Monk and
the Trugberg, the Gletscherhorn, the Breithorn, the Aletschhorn, and
many another noble pile, the tributary snows descend and thicken into
ice. The mountains are well protected by their wintry coats, and hence
the quantity of _débris_ upon the glacier is comparatively small;
still, along it can be noticed dark longitudinal streaks, which are
incipient moraines. Right and left from these longitudinal bands sweep
finer curves, twisted here and there into complex windings, which mark
the lamination of the subjacent ice. The glacier lies in a curved
valley, the side towards which its convex curvature is turned is thrown
into a state of strain, the ice breaks across the line of tension,
a curious system of oblique glacier ravines being thus produced.
From the snow-line which crosses the glacier above the Faulberg a
pure snow-field stretches upward to the Col de la Jungfrau, which
unites the Maiden to the Monk. Skies and summits are to-day without a
cloud, and no mist or turbidity interferes with the sharpness of the
outlines. Jungfrau, Monk, Eiger, Trugberg, cliffy Strahlgrat, stately,
lady-like Aletschhorn, all grandly pierce the empyrean. Like a Saul of
mountains, the Finsteraarhorn overtops all his neighbours; then we have
the Oberaarhorn, with the river glacier of Viesch rolling from his
shoulders. Below is the Märjelin See, with its crystal precipices and
its floating icebergs, snowy white, sailing on a blue-green sea. Beyond
is the range which divides the Valais from Italy. Sweeping round,
the vision meets an aggregate of peaks which look, as fledglings to
their mother, towards the mighty Dom. Then come the repellent crags of
Mont Cervin, the idea of moral savagery, of wild untameable ferocity,
mingling involuntarily with our contemplation of the gloomy pile.
Next comes an object scarcely less grand, conveying it may be even a
deeper impression of majesty and might than the Matterhorn itself--the
Weisshorn, perhaps the most splendid object in the Alps. But beauty is
associated with its force, and we think of it, not as cruel, but as
grand and strong. Further to the right is the Great Combin; other peaks
crowd around him, while at the extremity of the curve along which the
gaze has swept rises the sovran crown of Mont Blanc. And now, as the
day sinks, scrolls of pearly clouds form around the mountain-crests,
and are wafted from them into the distant air. They are without
colour of any kind; but their grace of form and lustre are not to be
described.


NOTE ON CLOUDS.

It is well known that when a receiver filled with ordinary undried air
is exhausted, a cloudiness, due to the precipitation of the aqueous
vapour diffused in the air, is produced by the first few strokes of the
pump. It is, as might be expected, possible to produce clouds in this
way with the vapours of other liquids than water.

In the course of some experiments on the chemical action of light
on vapours which have been communicated to the Royal Society, I had
frequent occasion to observe the precipitation of such clouds; indeed,
several days at a time have been devoted solely to the generation and
examination of clouds formed by the sudden dilatation of mixed air and
vapours in the experimental tubes.

The clouds were generated in two ways: one mode consisted in opening
the passage between the filled experimental tube and the air-pump, and
then simply dilating the air by working the pump. In the other, the
experimental tube was connected with a vessel of suitable size, the
passage between which and the experimental tube could be closed by a
stopcock. This vessel was first exhausted; on turning the cock the air
rushed from the experimental tube into the vessel, the precipitation of
a cloud within the tube being a consequence of the transfer. Instead
of a special vessel, the cylinders of the air-pump itself were usually
employed for this purpose.

It was found possible, by shutting off the residue of air and vapour
after each act of precipitation, and again exhausting the cylinders of
the pump, to obtain with some substances, and without refilling the
experimental tube, fifteen or twenty clouds in succession.

The clouds thus precipitated differed from each other in luminous
energy, some shedding forth a mild white light, others flashing out
with sudden and surprising brilliancy. This difference of action is,
of course, to be referred to the different reflective energies of the
particles of the clouds, which were produced by substances of very
different refractive indices.

Different clouds, moreover, possess very different degrees of
stability: some melt away rapidly, while others linger for minutes
in the experimental tube, resting, as they slowly dissolve, upon its
bottom like a heap of snow. The particles of other clouds are trailed
through the experimental tube as if they were moving through a viscous
medium.

Nothing can exceed the splendour of the diffraction phenomena exhibited
by some of these clouds; the colours are best seen by looking along
the experimental tube from a point above it, the face being turned
towards the source of illumination. The differential motions introduced
by friction against the interior surface of the tube often cause the
colours to arrange themselves in distinct layers.

The difference in texture exhibited by different clouds caused me
to look a little more closely than I had previously done into the
mechanism of cloud-formation. A certain expansion is necessary to
bring down the cloud; the moment just before precipitation the cooling
air and vapour may be regarded as divided into a number of polyhedra,
the particles along the bounding surfaces of which move in opposite
directions when precipitation actually sets in. Every cloud-particle
has consumed a polyhedron of vapour in its formation; and it is
manifest that the size of the particle must depend, not only on the
size of the vapour polyhedron, but also on the relation of the density
of the vapour to that of its liquid. If the vapour were light, and the
liquid heavy, other things being equal, the cloud-particle would be
smaller than if the vapour were heavy and the liquid light. There would
evidently be more shrinkage in the one case than in the other; these
considerations were found valid throughout the experiments; the case of
toluol may be taken as representative of a great number of others. The
specific gravity of this liquid is 0.85, that of water being unity; the
specific gravity of its vapour is 3.26, that of aqueous vapour being
0.6. Now, as the size of the cloud-particle is directly proportional
to the specific gravity of the vapour, and inversely proportional to
the specific gravity of the liquid, an easy calculation proves that,
assuming the size of the vapour polyhedra in both cases to be the
same, the size of the particle of toluol cloud must be more than six
times that of the particle of aqueous cloud. It is probably impossible
to test this question with numerical accuracy; but the comparative
coarseness of the toluol cloud is strikingly manifest to the naked eye.
The case is, as I have said, representative.

In fact, aqueous vapour is without a parallel in these particulars; it
is not only the lightest of all vapours, in the common acceptation of
that term, but the lightest of all gases except hydrogen and ammonia.
To this circumstance the soft and tender beauty of the clouds of our
atmosphere is mainly to be ascribed.

The _sphericity_ of the cloud-particles may be immediately inferred
from their deportment under the luminous beams. The light which
they shed when spherical is _continuous_: but clouds may also be
precipitated in solid flakes; and then the incessant sparkling of the
cloud shows that its particles are _plates_, and not spheres. Some
portions of the same cloud may be composed of spherical particles,
others of flakes, the difference being at once manifested through the
_calmness_ of the one portion of the cloud, and the _uneasiness_ of the
other. The sparkling of such flakes reminded me of the plates of mica
in the River Rhone at its entrance into the Lake of Geneva when shone
upon by a strong sun.--_Proceedings of the Royal Society_, vol. xvii.
p. 317.

       *       *       *       *       *

Clouds are so often referred to in these pages that I thought it might
be of interest to note the latest remarks on their formation.




VIII.

_THE BEL ALP._


On Tuesday the 13th I accompanied a party of friends to the Märjelin
See, skirted the lake, struck in upon the glacier, and having heard
much of the position and the comfort of a new hotel upon the Bel Alp, I
resolved to descend the glacier and pay the place a visit. The Valais
range had been covered before we quitted the Æggischhorn; and, though
the sun rode unimpeded in the higher heavens, vast masses of cloud
continued to thrust themselves forth like tree-branches into the upper
air.

The clouds extended, becoming ever blacker, until finally they were
unlocked by thunder, and shook themselves down upon us in furious rain.
The glacier is here cut up into oblique valleys of ice, subdivided by
sharp-edged crevasses. We advanced swiftly along the ridges, but these
finally abutted against the mountain, and we were compelled to cross
from ridge to ridge. Hirst followed Bennen, and I trusted to my own
devices. Joyously we struck our axes into the crumbling crests, and
made our way rapidly between the chasms. The sunshine gushed down upon
us, and partially dried our drenched clothes. At some distance to our
left we observed upon the ice a group of persons, consisting of two
men, a boy, and an old woman, engaged beside a crevasse; a thrill of
horror shot through me, at the thought of a man being possibly between
its jaws. We quickly joined them, and found an unfortunate cow firmly
jammed between the frozen sides of the fissure, and groaning piteously.
The men seemed very helpless; their means were inadequate, and their
efforts ill-directed. ‘Give the brute space, cut away the ice which
presses the ribs, and _you_ step upon that block which stops the chasm,
and apply your shoulders to the creature’s buttocks.’ The ice splinters
fly aloft, under the vigorous strokes of Bennen. Hirst suggests that
a rope should be passed round the horns, so as to enable all hands to
join in the pull. This is done. Another rope is passed between the hind
legs. Bennen has loosened the ice which held the ribs in bondage, and
now, like mariners heaving an anchor, we all join in a tug, timing our
efforts by an appropriate exclamation. The weight moves, but extremely
little; again the cry, and again the heave--it moves a little more.
This is repeated several times till the fore-legs are extricated and
thrown forward on the ice. We now lift the hinder parts, and succeed in
placing the animal upon the glacier, panting and trembling all over.
Folding our rope, we went onward. The day again darkened. Again the
thunder rang, being now preceded by lightning, which was thrown into
my eyes from the polished surface of my axe. Flash followed flash and
peal succeeded peal with terrific grandeur, and the loaded clouds sent
down from all their fringes dusky streamers of rain. They looked like
waterspouts, so dense was their texture. Furious as was the descending
shower, hard as we were hit by the mixed pellets of ice and water,
I enjoyed the scene. Grandly the cloud-besom swept the mountains,
their colossal outlines looming at intervals like overpowered Titans
struggling against their doom.

The glacier becoming impracticable through crevasses, we retreated to
its eastern shore, and got along the lateral moraine. It was rough
work. The slope to our left was partially clothed with spectral pines.
Storms had stripped the trunks of their branches, and the branches of
their leaves, leaving the tree-wrecks behind, as if spirit-stricken and
accursed. Our home is now in sight, perched upon the summit of a bluff
opposite. We passed swiftly over the ridges towards our destination.
Wet and thirsty, we reached the opposite side, and, striking into a
beaten track, finally reached the pleasant auberge at which our journey
ends.

From the hotel on the slope of Æggischhorn an hour’s ascent is
required to place you in presence of the magnificent view from the
summit. But the very windows of the hotel upon the Bel Alp command
noble views, and you may sit upon the bilberry slopes adjacent before
the grandest of mountain scenes. On the 14th I went down to the savage
gorge in which the Aletsch glacier ends. A pine tree stood sheer over
it; bending its trunk at a right angle near its root, and grasping a
rock with its root, it supported itself above the chasm. Standing upon
the horizontal part of the tree, I hugged its upright stem, and looked
down into the gorge. It required several minutes to chase away my
timidity, and as the wind blew more forcibly against me, I clung with
greater fixity to the tree. In this wild spot, and alone, I watched the
dying fires of the day, until the latest glow had vanished from the
mountains.

Above the Bel Alp, and two hours distant, is the grey pinnacle of the
Sparrenhorn. I went up there on the 15th. To the observer from the
hotel it appears as an isolated peak; but it forms the lofty end of a
narrow ridge, which is torn into ruins by the weather. At a distance in
front of me was a rocky promontory like the Abschwung, right and left
of which descended two streams of ice, which welded themselves to a
common trunk glacier. The scene was perfectly unexpected and strikingly
beautiful. Nowhere have I seen more perfect repose, nowhere more
tender curves or finer structural lines. The stripes of the moraine
bending along the glacier contribute to its beauty, and its deep
seclusion gives it a peculiar charm. It seems a river so protected by
its bounding mountains that no storm can ever reach it, and no billow
disturb the perfect serenity of its rest. The sweep of the Aletsch
glacier is also mighty as viewed from this point, and from no other
could the Valais range seem more majestic. It is needless to say a word
about the grandeur of the Dom, the Cervin, and the Weisshorn, all of
which, and a great deal more, are commanded from the Sparrenhorn.




IX.

_THE WEISSHORN._


On Friday the 16th of August I rose at 4.30; the eastern heaven was hot
with the glow of the rising sun, and against it were drawn the mountain
outlines. At 5.30 I bade good-bye to the excellent little auberge of
the Bel Alp,[9] and went straight down the mountain to Briegg, took the
diligence to Visp, and engaged a porter immediately to Randa. I had
sent Bennen thither to inspect the Weisshorn. On my arrival I learned
that he had made the necessary reconnaissance, and entertained hopes of
our being able to gain the top.

[9] Now a substantial hotel which merits encouragement.

[Illustration: THE WEISSHORN FROM THE RIFFEL.]

This noble mountain, which is fourteen thousand eight hundred feet
high, had been tried on various occasions and from different sides
by brave and competent climbers, but all efforts had been hitherto
unavailing.

Previous to quitting Randa to assail this formidable peak I had two
pairs of rugs sewed together so as to form two sacks. These and other
coverlets, together with our wine and provisions, were sent on in
advance of us. At 1 P.M. on the 18th of August Bennen, Wenger, and
myself quitted the hotel, and were soon zigzagging among the pines of
the opposite mountain. Wenger had been the guide of my friend Forster,
and had shown himself so active and handy on the Strahleck that I
commissioned Bennen to engage him. During the previous night I had been
very unwell, and as I climbed the slope I suffered from intense thirst.
Water seemed powerless to quench the desire for drink. We reached a
chalet, and at our request a smart young Senner caught up a pail, and
soon returned with it full of delicious milk. The effect of the milk
was astonishing. It seemed to lubricate every atom of my body, and to
exhilarate with its fragrance my brain.

Two hours’ additional climbing brought us to our bivouac, a ledge of
rock which jutted from the mountain-side, and formed an overhanging
roof. On removing the stones from beneath the ledge, a space of
comparatively dry clay was laid bare. This was to be my bed, and to
soften it Wenger considerately stirred it up with his axe. The position
was excellent, for lying upon my left side I commanded the whole range
of Monte Rosa, from the Mischabel to the Breithorn. We were on the edge
of an amphitheatre. Beyond the Schallenbach was the stately Mettelhorn.
A row of eminences swept round to the right linked by lofty ridges of
cliffs, which embraced the Schallenberg glacier. They formed, however,
only a spur of the vaster Weisshorn, the cone of which was not visible
from our dormitory. In company with Bennen I afterwards skirted the
mountain until the whole colossal pyramid stood facing us. When I first
looked at it my hopes sank, but both of us gathered confidence from a
more lengthened gaze. The mountain is a pyramid with three faces, the
intersections of which form three sharp edges or _arêtes_. The end
of the eastern ridge was nearest to us, and on it our attention was
principally fixed. We finally decided on the route to be pursued next
morning, and with a chastened hope in both our breasts we returned to
our shelter.

Water was our first necessity: it seemed everywhere, but there was none
to drink. It was locked to solidity in the ice and snow. The sound of
it came booming up from the Vispbach, as it broke into foam or rolled
its boulders over its waterworn bed; and the swish of many a minor
streamlet mingled with the muffled roar of the large one. Bennen set
out in search of the precious liquid, and after a long absence returned
with a jug and pan full. At our meal, Wenger, who is a man rich in
small expedients, turned the section of a cheese towards the flame of
our pine fire; it fizzed and blistered and turned viscous, and, the
toasted surface being removed, was consumed with relish by us all.
The sunset had been unspeakably grand, steeping the zenith in violet,
and flooding the base of the heavens with crimson light. Immediately
opposite to us rose the Mischabel, with its two great peaks, the
Grubenhorn and the Täschhorn, each barely under 15,000 feet in height.
Next came the Alphubel, with its flattened crown of snow; then the
Allaleinhorn and Rympfischhorn; then the Cima di Jazzi; next the mass
of Monte Rosa, flooded with light from bottom to top. The face of the
Lyskamm turned towards us was for the most part shaded, but here and
there its projecting portions jutted forth red hot as the light fell
upon them. The ‘Twins’ were most singularly illuminated; across the
waist of each of them was drawn a black bar, produced by the shadow of
a corner of the Breithorn, while their bases and crowns were exposed
to the crimson light. Over the rugged face of the Breithorn itself the
light fell as if in splashes, igniting its glaciers and swathing its
black crags in a layer of transparent red. The Mettelhorn was cold, so
was the entire range governed by the Weisshorn, while the glaciers they
embraced lay grey and ghastly in the twilight shade.

The sunlight lingered, while up the arch of the opposite heavens the
moon, within one day of being full, seemed hastening to our aid. She
finally appeared exactly behind the peak of the Rympfischhorn, the
cone of the mountain being projected for a short time as a triangle on
the lunar disc. Only for a short time, however; the silver sphere soon
cleared the mountain, and bore away through the tinted sky. The motion
was quite visible, and resembled that of a vast balloon. As the day
approached its end the scene assumed the most sublime aspect. All the
lower portions of the mountains were deeply shaded, while the loftiest
peaks, ranged upon a semicircle, were fully exposed to the sinking sun.
They seemed pyramids of solid fire, while here and there long stretches
of crimson light drawn over the higher snow-fields linked the summits
together. An intensely illuminated geranium flower seems to swim in its
own colour, which apparently surrounds the petals like a layer, and
defeats by its lustre any attempt of the eye to seize upon the sharp
outline of the leaves. A similar effect was here observed upon the
mountains; the glory did not seem to come from them alone, but seemed
also effluent from the air around them. As the evening advanced, the
eastern heavens low down assumed a deep purple hue, above which, and
blending with it by infinitesimal gradations, was a belt of red, and
over this again zones of orange and violet. I walked round the corner
of the mountain at sunset, and found the western sky glowing with a
more transparent crimson than that which overspread the east. The crown
of the Weisshorn was imbedded in this magnificent light. After sunset
the purple of the east changed to a deep neutral tint, and against the
faded red which spread above it the sun-forsaken mountains laid their
cold and ghastly heads. The ruddy colour vanished more and more; the
stars strengthened in lustre, until finally the moon and they held
undisputed possession of the sky.

My face was turned towards the moon until it became so chilled that
I was forced to protect it by a light handkerchief. The power of
blinding the eyes is ascribed to the moonbeams, but the real mischief
is that produced by radiation from the eyes into clear space, and the
inflammation consequent upon the chill. As the cold increased I was
fain to squeeze myself more and more underneath the ledge, so as to
lessen the space of sky against which my body could radiate. Nothing
could be more solemn than the night. Up from the valley came the low
thunder of the Vispbach. Over the Dom flashed in succession the stars
of Orion, until finally the entire constellation hung aloft. Higher up
in heaven was the moon, and her beams as they fell upon the snow-fields
and pyramids were sent back in silvery lustre by some, while others
remained a dead white. These, as the earth twirled round, came duly
in for their share of the glory. The Twins caught it at length and
retained it long, shining with a pure spiritual radiance, while the
moon continued above the hills.

At twelve o’clock I looked at my watch, and a second time at 2 A.M.
The moon was then just touching the crest of the Schallenberg, and we
were threatened with the withdrawal of her light. This soon occurred.
We rose at 2-1/4 A.M., consumed our coffee, and had to wait idly for
the dawn. A faint illumination at length overspread the sky, and with
this promise of the coming day we quitted our bivouac at 3-1/2 A.M. No
cloud was to be seen; as far as the weather was concerned we were sure
to have fair play. We rounded the shingly shoulder of the mountain to
the edge of a snow-field, but before entering upon it I disburthened
myself of my strong shooting jacket, leaving it on the mountain-side.
The sunbeams and my own exertion would, I knew, keep me only too warm
during the day. We crossed the snow, cut our way through a piece of
entangled glacier, reached the Bergschrund, and passed it without a
rope. We ascended the frozen snow of the couloir by steps, but soon
diverged from it to the rocks at our right, and mounted them to the end
of the eastern _arête_ of the mountain.

A snow saddle separated us from the higher rocks. With our staff-pikes
at one side of the saddle, we pass by steps cut upon the other. We
find the rocks hewn into fantastic turrets and obelisks, while the
loose chips of this sculpture are strewn confusedly upon the ridge.
Amid these we cautiously pick our way, winding round the towers or
scaling them amain. The work was heavy from the first, the bending,
twisting, reaching, and drawing up calling upon all the muscles of
the frame. After two hours of this work we halted, and, looking back,
saw two moving objects on the glacier below us. At first we took them
to be chamois, but they were men. The leader carried an axe, and his
companion a knapsack and an alpenstock. They followed our traces,
losing them apparently now and then, and waiting to recover them. Our
expedition had put Randa in a state of excitement, and some of its best
climbers had urged Bennen to take them with him. This he did not deem
necessary, and now here were two of them determined to try the thing
on their own account, and perhaps to dispute with us the honour of the
enterprise. On this point, however, our uneasiness was small.

Resuming our gymnastics, the rocky staircase led us to the flat summit
of a tower, where we found ourselves cut off from a similar tower by
a deep gap bitten into the mountain. The rope was here our refuge.
Bennen coiled it round his waist; we let him down along the surface
of the rock, until he fixed himself on a ledge, where he could lend
me a helping hand. I followed him, and Wenger followed me. By a kind
of screw motion we twisted ourselves round the opposite tower, and
reached the ridge behind it. Work of this kind, however, is not to
be performed by the day, and, with a view of sparing our strength, we
quitted the ridge and endeavoured to get along the southern slope of
the pyramid. The mountain was scarred by long couloirs, filled with
clear hard ice. The cutting of steps across these couloirs proved to
be so tedious and fatiguing that I urged Bennen to abandon them and
try the ridge once more. We regained it and worked along it as before.
Here and there upon the northern side the snow was folded over, and we
worked slowly upward along the cornice snow. The ridge became gradually
narrower, and the precipices on each side more sheer. We reached the
end of one of its subdivisions, and found ourselves separated from
the next rocks by a gap about twenty yards across. The ridge has here
narrowed to a mere wall, which, however, as rock, would present no
serious difficulty. But upon the wall of rock was placed a second wall
of snow, which dwindled to a pure knife-edge at the top. It was white,
of very fine grain, and a little moist. How to pass this snow catenary
I knew not, for I did not think a human foot could trust itself upon so
frail a support. Bennen’s practical sagacity, however, came into play.
He tried the snow by squeezing it with his foot, and to my astonishment
began to cross it. Even after the pressure of his feet the space he
had to stand on did not exceed a hand-breadth. I followed him, exactly
as a boy walking along a horizontal pole, with toes turned outwards.
Right and left the precipices were appalling. We reached the opposite
rock, and an earnest smile rippled over Bennen’s countenance as he
turned towards me. He knew that he had done a daring thing, though not
a presumptuous one. ’Had the snow,’ he said, ‘been less perfect, I
should not have thought of attempting it; but I knew after I had set my
foot upon the ridge that we might pass without fear.’

It is quite surprising what a number of things the simple observation
made by Faraday in 1846 enables us to explain. Bennen’s instinctive act
is justified by theory. The snow was fine in grain, pure, and moist.
When pressed, the attachments of its granules were innumerable, and
their perfect cleanness enabled them to freeze together with a maximum
energy. It was this freezing which gave the mass its sustaining power.

Two fragments of ordinary table ice brought carefully together freeze
and cement themselves at their place of junction; or if two pieces
floating in water be brought together, they instantly freeze, and by
laying hold of either of them gently you can drag the other after it
through the water. Imagine such points of attachment distributed in
great numbers through a mass of snow. The substance becomes thereby a
semi-solid instead of a mass of powder. My guide, however, unaided by
any theory, did a thing from which I should have shrunk, though backed
by all the theories in the world.

After this we found the rocks on the ridge so shaken that it required
the greatest caution to avoid bringing them down upon us. With all
our care, moreover, we sometimes dislodged vast masses, which leaped
upon the slope adjacent, loosened others by their shock, these again
others, until finally a whole flight of them would escape, setting the
mountain in a roar as they whizzed and thundered along its side to
the snow-fields 4,000 feet below us. The day was hot, the work hard,
and our bodies were drained of their liquids as by a Turkish bath. To
make good our loss we halted at intervals where the melted snow formed
liquid veins, and quenched our thirst. A bottle of champagne, poured
sparingly into our goblets over a little snow, furnished Wenger and
myself with many a refreshing draught. Bennen feared his eyes, and
would not touch champagne. We, however, did not find halting good; for
at every pause the muscles became set, and some minutes were necessary
to render them again elastic. But for both mind and body the discipline
was grand. There is scarcely a position possible to a human being
which, at one time or another during the day, I was not forced to
assume. The fingers, wrist, and forearm were my main reliance, and as
a mechanical instrument the human hand appeared to me this day to be a
miracle of constructive art.

For the most part the summit was hidden from us, but on reaching
the successive eminences it came frequently into view. After three
hours spent on the _arête_--about five hours, that is, subsequent to
starting--we saw the summit over another minor summit, which gave it
an illusive proximity. ‘You have now good hopes,’ I remarked, turning
to Bennen. ‘I do not allow myself to entertain the idea of failure,’
he replied. Well, six hours passed on the ridge, each of which put in
its inexorable claim to the due amount of mechanical work; and at the
end of this time we found ourselves apparently no nearer to the summit
than when Bennen’s hopes cropped out in confidence. I looked anxiously
at my guide as he fixed his weary eyes upon the distant peak. There was
no confidence in his expression; still I do not believe that either of
us entertained for a moment the thought of giving in. Wenger complained
of his lungs, and Bennen counselled him several times to remain behind;
but this the Oberland man refused to do. At the commencement of a day’s
work one often feels anxious, if not timid; but when the work is
very hard we become callous and sometimes stupefied by the incessant
knocking about. This was my case at present, and I kept watch lest my
indifference should become carelessness. I repeatedly supposed a case
where a sudden effort might be required of me, and felt all through
that I had a fair residue of strength to fall back upon should such a
call be made. This conclusion was sometimes tested by a spurt; flinging
myself suddenly from rock to rock, I proved my condition by experiment
instead of relying on surmise. An eminence in the ridge which cut off
the view of the summit was now the object of our exertions. We reached
it; but how hopelessly distant did the summit appear! Bennen laid his
face upon his axe for a moment; a kind of sickly despair was in his eye
as he turned to me, remarking, ‘Lieber Herr, die Spitze ist noch sehr
weit oben.’

Lest the desire to gratify me should urge him beyond the bounds of
prudence, I told my guide that he must not persist on my account; that
I should cheerfully return with him the moment he thought it no longer
safe to proceed. He replied that, though weary, he felt quite sure of
himself, and asked for some food. He had it, and a gulp of wine, which
mightily refreshed him. Looking at the mountain with a firmer eye, he
exclaimed, ‘Herr! wir müssen ihn haben,’ and his voice, as he spoke,
rung like steel within my heart. I thought of Englishmen in battle, of
the qualities which had made them famous: it was mainly the quality of
not knowing when to yield--of fighting for duty even after they had
ceased to be animated by hope. Such thoughts helped to lift me over
the rocks. Another eminence now fronted us, behind which, how far we
knew not, the summit lay. We scaled this height, and above us, but
clearly within reach, a silvery pyramid projected itself against the
blue sky. I was assured ten times over by my companions that it was the
highest point before I ventured to stake my faith upon the assertion.
I feared that it also might take rank with the illusions which had so
often beset our ascent, and I shrunk from the consequent moral shock.
A huge prism of granite, or granitic gneiss, terminated the _arête_,
and from it a knife-edge of pure white snow ran up to a little point.
We passed along the edge, reached that point, and instantly swept with
our eyes the whole range of the horizon. We stood upon the crown of the
redoubtable Weisshorn.

The long-pent feelings of my two companions found vent in a wild and
reiterated cheer. Bennen shook his arms in the air and shouted as a
Valaisian, while Wenger raised the shriller yell of the Oberland. We
looked downwards along the ridge, and far below, perched on one of
its crags, could discern the two Randa men. Again and again the roar
of triumph was sent down to them. They had accomplished but a small
portion of the ridge, and soon after our success they wended their way
homewards. They came, willing enough, no doubt, to publish our failure
had we failed; but we found out afterwards that they had been equally
strenuous in announcing our success; they had seen us, they affirmed,
like three flies upon the summit of the mountain. Both men had to
endure a little persecution for the truth’s sake, for nobody in Randa
would believe that the Weisshorn could be scaled, and least of all by
a man who for two days previously had been the object of Philomène the
waitress’s constant pity, on account of the incompetence of his stomach
to accept all that she offered for its acceptance. The energy of
conviction with which the men gave their evidence had, however, proved
conclusive to the most sceptical before we arrived.

Bennen wished to leave some outward and visible sign of our success on
the summit. He deplored having no suitable flag; but as a substitute
for such it was proposed that he should use the handle of one of our
axes as a flagstaff, and surmount it by a red pocket-handkerchief. This
was done, and for some time subsequently the extempore banner was seen
flapping in the wind. To his extreme delight, it was shown to Bennen
himself three days afterwards by my friend Mr. Francis Galton, from
the Riffelberg hotel.

Every Swiss climber is acquainted with the Weisshorn. I have long
regarded it as the noblest of all the Alps, and most other travellers
share this opinion. The impression it produces is in some measure due
to the comparative isolation with which it juts into the heavens. It
is not masked by other mountains, and all around the Alps its final
pyramid is in view. Conversely, the Weisshorn commands a vast range of
prospect. Neither Bennen nor myself had ever seen anything at all equal
to it. The day, moreover, was perfect; not a cloud was to be seen; and
the gauzy haze of the distant air, though sufficient to soften the
outlines and enhance the colouring of the mountains, was far too thin
to obscure them. Over the peaks and through the valleys the sunbeams
poured, unimpeded save by the mountains themselves, which sent their
shadows in bars of darkness through the illuminated air. I had never
before witnessed a scene which affected me like this one. I opened
my note-book to make a few observations, but soon relinquished the
attempt. There was something incongruous, if not profane, in allowing
the scientific faculty to interfere where silent worship seemed the
‘reasonable service.’

We had been ten hours climbing from our bivouac to the summit, and it
was now necessary that we should clear the mountain before the close of
day. Our muscles were loose and numbed, and, unless extremely urged,
declined all energetic tension: the thought of our success, however,
ran like a kind of wine through our fibres and helped us down. We once
fancied the descent would be rapid, but it was far from it. As in
ascending, Bennen took the lead; he slowly cleared each crag, paused
till I joined him, I pausing till Wenger joined me, and thus one or
other of us was always in motion. Our leader showed a preference for
the snow, while I held on to the rocks, where my hands could assist
my feet. Our muscles were sorely tried by the twisting round the
splintered turrets of the _arête_, but a long, long stretch of the
ridge must be passed before we can venture to swerve from it. We were
roused from our stupefaction at times by the roar of the stones which
we loosed from the ridge and sent leaping down the mountain. Soon after
recrossing the snow catenary already mentioned we quitted the ridge
to get obliquely along the slope of the pyramid. The face of it was
scarred by couloirs, of which the deeper and narrower ones were filled
with ice, while the others acted as highways for the rocks quarried
by the weathering above. Steps must be cut in the ice, but the swing
of the axe is very different now from what it was in the morning.
Bennen’s blows descended with the deliberateness of a man whose fire is
half-quenched; still they fell with sufficient power, and the needful
cavities were formed. We retraced our morning steps over some of the
ice-slopes. No word of warning was uttered here as we ascended, but
now Bennen’s admonitions were frequent and emphatic--‘Take care not to
slip.’ I imagined, however, that even if a man slipped he would be able
to arrest his descent; but Bennen’s response when I stated this opinion
was very prompt--‘No! it would be utterly impossible. If it were snow
you might do it, but it is pure ice, and if you fall you will lose
your senses before you can use your axe.’ I suppose he was right. At
length we turned directly downwards, and worked along one of the ridges
which lie in the line of steepest fall. We first dropped cautiously
from ledge to ledge. At one place Bennen clung for a considerable time
to a face of rock, casting out feelers of leg and arm, and desiring
me to stand still. I did not understand the difficulty, for the rock,
though steep, was by no means vertical. I fastened myself on to it,
Bennen being on a ledge below, waiting to receive me. The spot on which
he stood was a little rounded protuberance sufficient to afford him
footing, but over which the slightest momentum would have carried him.
He knew this, and hence his caution. Soon after this we quitted our
ridge and dropped into a couloir to the left of it. It was dark, and
damp with trickling water. Here we disencumbered ourselves of the rope,
and found our speed greatly augmented. In some places the rocks were
worn to a powder, along which we shot by glissades. We swerved again
to the left, crossed a ridge, and got into another and dryer couloir.
The last one was dangerous, as the water exerted a constant sapping
action upon the rocks. From our new position we could hear the clatter
of stones descending the gulley we had just forsaken. Wenger, who had
brought up the rear during the day, is now sent to the front; he has
not Bennen’s power, but his legs are long and his descent rapid. He
scents out the way, which becomes more and more difficult. He pauses,
observes, dodges, but finally comes to a dead stop on the summit of a
precipice, which sweeps like a rampart round the mountain. We moved to
the left, and after a long _détour_ succeeded in rounding the precipice.

Another half-hour brings us to the brow of a second precipice, which
is scooped out along its centre so as to cause the brow to overhang.
Chagrin was in Bennen’s face: he turned his eyes upwards, and I feared
mortally that he was about to propose a reascent to the _arête_. It
was very questionable whether our muscles could have responded to
such a demand. While we stood pondering here, a deep and confused
roar attracted our attention. From a point near the summit of the
Weisshorn, a rock had been discharged down a dry couloir, raising a
cloud of dust at each bump against the mountain. A hundred similar
ones were immediately in motion, while the spaces between the larger
masses were filled by an innumerable flight of smaller stones. Each of
them shook its quantum of dust in the air, until finally the avalanche
was enveloped in a cloud. The clatter was stunning, for the collisions
were incessant. Black masses of rock emerged here and there from the
cloud, and sped through the air like flying fiends. Their motion was
not one of translation merely, but they whizzed and vibrated in their
flight as if urged by wings. The echoes resounded from side to side,
from the Schallenberg to the Weisshorn and back, until finally, after
many a deep-sounding thud in the snow, the whole troop came to rest at
the bottom of the mountain. This stone avalanche was one of the most
extraordinary things I had ever witnessed, and in connection with it
I would draw the attention of future climbers of the Weisshorn to the
danger which would infallibly beset any attempt to ascend it from this
side, except by one of its _arêtes_. At any moment the mountain-side
may be raked by a fire as deadly as that of cannon.

After due deliberation we moved along the precipice westward, I fearing
that each step forward but plunged us into deeper difficulty. At one
place, however, the precipice bevelled off to a steep incline of smooth
rock, along which ran a crack, wide enough to admit the fingers, and
sloping obliquely down to the lower glacier. Each in succession gripped
the rock and shifted his body sideways along the crack until he came
near enough to the glacier to reach it by a rough glissade. We passed
swiftly along the glacier, sometimes running, and, on steeper slopes,
sliding, until we were pulled up for the third time by a precipice
which seemed even worse than either of the others. It was quite sheer,
and as far as I could see right or left altogether hopeless. To my
surprise, both the men turned without hesitation to the right. I felt
desperately blank, but I could notice no expression of dismay in the
countenance of either of my companions. They inspected the moraine
matter over which we walked, and at length one of them exclaimed, ‘Da
sind die Spuren,’ lengthening his strides at the same moment. We looked
over the brink at intervals, and at length discovered what appeared
to be a mere streak of clay on the face of the precipice. On this
streak we found footing. It was by no means easy, but to hard-pushed
men it was a deliverance. The streak vanished, and we must get down
the rock. This fortunately was rough, so that by pressing the hands
against its rounded protuberances, and sticking the boot-nails against
its projecting crystals, we let ourselves gradually down. A deep cleft
separated the glacier from the precipice; this was crossed, and we were
free, being clearly placed beyond the last bastion of the mountain.

In this admirable fashion did my guides behave on this occasion. The
day previous to my arrival at Randa they had been up the mountain, and
they then observed a solitary chamois moving along the base of this
very precipice, and making ineffectual attempts to get up it. At one
place the creature succeeded; this spot they fixed in their memories,
and when they reached the top of the precipice they sought for the
traces of the chamois, found them, and were guided by them to the only
place where escape in any reasonable time was possible. Our way was
now clear; over the glacier we cheerfully marched, escaping from the
ice just as the moon and the eastern sky contributed about equally to
the illumination. The moonlight was afterwards intercepted by clouds.
In the gloom we were often at a loss, and wandered half-bewildered
over the grassy slopes. At length the welcome tinkle of cow-bells
was heard in the distance, and guided by them we reached the chalet
a little after 9 P.M. The cows had been milked and the milk disposed
of, but the men managed to get us a moderate draught. Thus refreshed
we continued the descent. I was half famished, for my solid nutriment
during the day consisted solely of part of a box of meat lozenges
given to me by Mr. Hawkins. Bennen and myself descended the mountain
deliberately, and after many windings emerged upon the valley, and
reached the hotel a little before 11 P.M. I had a basin of broth, _not_
made according to Liebig, and a piece of mutton boiled probably for the
fifth time. Fortified by these, and comforted by a warm footbath, I
went to bed, where six hours’ sound sleep chased away all consciousness
of fatigue. I was astonished on the morrow to find the loose atoms of
my body knitted so firmly by so brief a rest. Up to my attempt upon the
Weisshorn I had felt more or less dilapidated, but here all weakness
ended, and during my subsequent stay in Switzerland I was unacquainted
with infirmity.




X.

_INSPECTION OF THE MATTERHORN._


On the afternoon of the 20th we quitted Randa, with a threatening
sky overhead. The considerate Philomène compelled us to take an
umbrella, which we soon found useful. The flood-gates of heaven were
unlocked, while, defended by our cotton canopy, Bennen and myself
walked arm-in-arm to Zermatt. I instantly found myself in the midst
of a circle of pleasant friends, some of whom had just returned from
a successful attempt upon the Lyskamm. On the 22nd quite a crowd of
travellers crossed the Theodule Pass; and, knowing that every corner
of the hotel at Breuil would be taken up, I halted a day, so as to
allow the people to disperse. Breuil commands a view of the southern
side of the Matterhorn; and it was now an object with me to discover,
if possible, upon the true peak of this formidable mountain, some
ledge or cranny where three men might spend a night. The mountain
may be accessible or inaccessible, but one thing seems certain, that
starting from Breuil, or even from the chalets above Breuil, the
work of reaching the summit is too much for a single day. But could a
shelter be found amid the wild battlements of the peak itself, which
would enable one to attack the obelisk at day-dawn, the possibility of
conquest was so far an open question as to tempt a trial. I therefore
sent Bennen on to reconnoitre, purposing myself to cross the Theodule
alone on the following day.

On the afternoon of the 22nd I sauntered slowly up to the Riffel,
leaning at times on the head of my axe, or sitting down upon the grassy
knolls, as my mood prompted. The air which filled the valleys of the
Oberland, and swathed in mitigated density the highest peaks, was
slightly opalescent, though still transparent, the floating particles
forming so many _points d’appui_, from which the light was scattered
through surrounding space. The whole medium glowed as if shone upon by
a distant furnace, and through it the outline of the mountains loomed.
The glow augmented as the sun sank, reached its maximum, paused, and
then ran speedily down to a cold and colourless twilight.

Next morning at nine o’clock, with some scraps of information from
the guides to help me on my way, I quitted the Riffel to cross the
Theodule. I was soon followed by the domestic of the hotel. Bennen had
requested him to see me to the edge of the glacier, and he now joined
me with this intention. He knew my designs upon the Matterhorn, and
strongly deprecated them. ‘Only think, Herr,’ he urged, ‘what will
avail your ascent of the Weisshorn if you are smashed upon the Mont
Cervin? Mein Herr!’ he added with condensed emphasis, ‘thun Sie es
nicht.’ The whole conversation was in fact a homily, the strong point
of which was the utter uselessness of success on the one mountain if
it were to be followed by annihilation on the other. We reached the
ridge above the glacier, where, handing him a trinkgeld, which I had to
force on his acceptance, I bade him good-bye, assuring him that I would
submit in all things to Bennen’s opinion. He had the highest idea of
Bennen’s wisdom, and hence the assurance sent him home comforted.

[Illustration: THE MATTERHORN.]

I was soon upon the ice, once more alone, as I delight to be at times.
As a habit going alone is to be deprecated, but sparingly indulged in
it is a great luxury. There are no doubt moods when the mother is glad
to get rid of her offspring, the wife of her husband, the lover of his
mistress, and when it is not well to keep them together. And so, at
rare intervals, it is good for the soul to feel the full influence of
that ‘society where none intrudes.’ When the work is clearly within
your power, when long practice has enabled you to trust your own eye
and judgment in unravelling crevasses, and your own axe and arm
in subduing their more serious difficulties, it is an entirely new
experience to be alone amid those sublime scenes. The peaks wear a more
solemn aspect, the sun shines with a more effectual fire, the blue
of heaven is more deep and awful, and the hard heart of man is often
made as tender as a child’s. You contract a closer friendship for the
universe in virtue of your more intimate contact with its parts. The
glacier to-day filled the air with low murmurs, while the sound of the
distant moulins rose to a kind of roar. The _débris_ rustled on the
moraines, the smaller rivulets babbled in their channels, as they ran
to join their trunk, and the surface of the glacier creaked audibly as
it yielded to the sun. It seemed to breathe and whisper like a living
thing. To my left was Monte Rosa and her royal court, to my right the
mystic pinnacle of the Matterhorn, which from a certain point here upon
the glacier attains its maximum sharpness. It drew my eyes towards
it with irresistible fascination as it shimmered in the blue, too
preoccupied with heaven to think even with contempt on the designs of a
son of earth to reach its inviolate crest.

I crossed the Görner glacier quite as speedily as if I had been
professionally led. Then up the undulating slope of the Theodule
glacier, with a rocky ridge to the right, over which I was informed a
rude track led to the pass of St. Theodule. I am not great at finding
tracks, and I missed this one, ascending until it became evident that I
had gone too far. Near its higher extremity the crest of the ridge is
cut across by three curious chasms, and one of these I thought would
be a likely gateway through the ridge. I climbed the steep buttress of
the spur and was soon in the fissure. Huge masses of rock were jammed
into it, the presence of which gave variety to the exertion, calling
forth strength, but not exciting fear. From the summit the rocks sloped
gently down to the snow, and in a few minutes the presence of broken
bottles on the moraine showed me that I had hit upon the track. Upwards
of twenty unhappy bees staggered against me on the way: tempted by
the sun, or wafted by the wind, they had quitted the flowery Alps to
meet torpor and death in the ice-world above. From the summit I went
swiftly down to Breuil, where I was welcomed by the host, welcomed by
the waiter; loud were the expressions of content at my arrival; and I
was informed that Bennen had started early in the morning to ‘promenade
himself’ around the Matterhorn.

I lay long upon the Alp, scanning crag and snow in search of my guide.
From the admirable account of the first attempt on the Matterhorn,
drawn up by Mr. Hawkins,[10] it may be inferred that the ascent is
not likely to be a matter of mere amusement. The account narrates that
after climbing for several hours in the face of novel difficulties, my
companion thought it wise to halt so as to secure our retreat. I will
here state in a few words what occurred after our separation from him.
Bennen and I had first a hard scramble up some very steep rocks, our
motions giving to those below us the impression that we were urging up
bales of goods instead of the simple weight of our own bodies. Turning
the corner of the ridge, we had to cross an unpleasant slope of smooth
rock, covered by about eighteen inches of snow. In ascending, this
place was passed in silence, but in coming down the fear arose that the
superficial layer might slip away with us. Bennen seldom warns me, but
he did so here emphatically, declaring his own powerlessness to render
any help should the footing give way. Having crossed this slope in our
ascent, we were fronted by a cliff, against which we rose mainly by aid
of the felspar crystals protuberant from its face. Midway up the cliff
Bennen asked me to hold on, as he did not feel sure that it was the
best route. I accordingly ceased moving, and lay against the rock with
legs and arms outstretched. Bennen climbed to the top of the cliff, but
returned immediately with a flush of confidence in his eye. ‘I will
lead you to the top,’ he said excitedly. Had I been free I should have
cried ‘Bravo!’ but in my position I did not care to risk the muscular
motion which a hearty bravo would demand.

[10] Chapter III. of this volume.

Aided by the rope, I was at his side in a minute, and we soon learned
that his confidence was premature. Difficulties thickened round us; on
no other mountain are they so thick, and each of them is attended by
possibilities of the most blood-chilling kind. Our mode of motion was
this: Bennen advanced while I held on to a rock, prepared for the jerk
if he should slip. When he had secured himself, he called out, ‘Ich bin
fest, kommen Sie.’ I then worked forward, sometimes halting where he
had halted, sometimes passing him until a firm anchorage was gained,
when it again became his turn to advance. Thus each of us waited until
the other could seize upon something capable of bearing the shock of
a falling man. At some places Bennen deemed a little extra assurance
necessary; and here he emphasised his statement that he was ‘fest’ by
a suitable hyperbole. ‘Ich bin fest wie ein Mauer,--fest wie ein Berg,
ich halte Sie gewiss,’ or some such expression.

Looking from Breuil, a series of moderate-sized prominences are seen
along the _arête_ of the Matterhorn; but when you are near them, these
black eminences rise like tremendous castles in the air, so wild and
high as almost to quell all hope of scaling or getting round them. At
the base of one of these edifices Bennen paused and looked closely at
the grand mass; he wiped his forehead, and turning to me said, ‘Was
denken Sie, Herr?’--‘Shall we go on, or shall we return? I will do what
you wish.’ ‘I am without a wish, Bennen,’ I replied: ‘where you go I
follow, be it up or down.’ He disliked the idea of giving in, and would
willingly have thrown the onus of stopping upon me. We attacked the
castle, and by a hard effort reached one of its mid ledges, whence we
had plenty of room to examine the remainder. We might certainly have
continued the ascent beyond this place, but Bennen paused here. To a
minute of talk succeeded a minute of silence, during which my guide
earnestly scanned the heights. He then turned towards me, and the words
seemed to fall from his lips through a resisting medium, as he said,
‘Ich denke die Zeit ist zu kurz’ (I think the time is too short).

By this time each of the neighbouring peaks had unfolded a cloud
banner, remaining clear to windward, but having a streamer hooked on to
its summit and drawn far out into space by the moist south wind. It was
a grand and affecting sight, grand intrinsically, but doubly impressive
to feelings already loosened by the awe inseparable from our position.
Looked at from Breuil, the mountain shows two summits separated from
each other by a possibly impassable cleft. Only the lower one of these
could be seen from where we stood. I asked Bennen how high he supposed
it to be above the point where we then stood; he estimated its height
at 400 feet, I at 500 feet. Probably both of us were under the mark;
however, I state the fact as it occurred. The object of my present
visit to Breuil was to finish the piece of work thus abruptly broken
off, and so I awaited Bennen’s return with anxious interest.

At dusk I saw him striding down the Alp, and went out to meet him. I
sought to gather his opinion from his eye before he spoke, but could
make nothing out. It was perfectly firm, but might mean either pro
or con. ‘Herr,’ he said at length, in a tone of unusual emphasis, ‘I
have examined the mountain carefully, and find it more difficult and
dangerous than I had imagined. There is no place upon it where we
could well pass the night. We might do so on yonder col upon the snow,
but there we should be almost frozen to death, and totally unfit for
the work of the next day. On the rocks there is no ledge or cranny
which could give us proper harbourage; and starting from Breuil it
is certainly impossible to reach the summit in a single day.’ I was
entirely taken back by this report. Bennen was evidently dead against
any attempt upon the mountain. ‘We can, at all events, reach the lower
of the two summits,’ I remarked. ‘Even that is difficult,’ he replied;
‘but when you have reached it, what then? The peak has neither name nor
fame.’ I was silent; slightly irascible, perhaps; but it was against my
habit to utter a word of remonstrance or persuasion. Bennen made his
report with his eyes open. He knew me well, and I think mutual trust
has rarely been more strongly developed between guide and traveller
than between him and me. I knew that I had but to give the word and
he would face the mountain with me next day, but it would have been
inexcusable in me to deal thus with him. So I stroked my beard, and,
like Lelia in the ‘Princess,’ when

                    Upon the sward
    She tapt her tiny silken-sandal’d foot,

I crushed the grass with my hobnails, seeking thus a safety-valve for
my disappointment.

My sleep was unsatisfying that night, and on the following morning I
felt a void within. The hope of finishing my work creditably had been
suddenly dislodged, and, for a time, vacuity took its place. It was
like the removal of a pleasant drug or the breaking down of a religious
faith. I hardly knew what to do with myself. One thing was certain--the
Italian valleys had no tonic strong enough to set me right; the
mountains alone could restore what I had lost. Over the Joch then
once more! We packed up and bade farewell to the host and waiter. Both
men seemed smitten with a sudden languor, and could hardly respond
to my adieus. They had expected us to be their guests for some time,
and were evidently disgusted at our want of pluck. ‘Mais, monsieur,
il faut faire la pénitence pour une nuit.’ Veils of the silkiest
cloud began to draw themselves round the mountain, and to stretch in
long gauzy filaments through the air, where they finally curdled up
to common cloud, and lost the grace and beauty of their infancy. Had
they condensed to thunder I should have been better satisfied; but it
was some consolation to see them thicken so as to hide the mountain,
and quench the longing with which I should have viewed its unclouded
head. The thought of spending some days chamois-hunting occurred to me.
Bennen seized the idea with delight, promising me an excellent gun.
We crossed the summit, descended to Zermatt, paused there to refresh
ourselves, and went forward to St. Nicholas, where we spent the night.




XI.

_OVER THE MORO._


I had only seen one half of Monte Rosa; and from the Italian side the
aspect of the mountain was unknown to me. I had been upon the Monte
Moro three years ago, but looked from it merely into an infinite sea
of haze. To complete my knowledge of the mountain it was necessary to
go to Macugnaga, and over the Moro I accordingly resolved to go. But
resolution had as yet taken no deep root, and on reaching Saas I was
beset by the desire to cross the Alphubel. Bennen called me at three;
but over the pass grey clouds were hanging, and, determined not to mar
this fine excursion by choosing an imperfect day, I then gave it up. At
seven o’clock, however, all trace of cloud had disappeared; it had been
merely a local gathering of no importance, which the first sunbeams
resolved into transparency. It was now, however, too late to think
of the Alphubel, so I reverted to my original design, and at 9 A.M.
started up the valley towards Mattmark. A party of friends in advance
contributed strongly to draw me on in this direction.

Onward then we went through the soft green meadows, with the river
sounding to our right. The sun showered gold upon the pines, and
brought richly out the colouring of the rocks. The blue wood-smoke
ascended from the hamlets, and the companionable grasshopper sang
and chirruped right and left. High up the sides of the mountains the
rocks were planed down to tablets by the ancient glaciers. The valley
narrowed, and we skirted a pile of moraine-like matter, which was roped
compactly together by the roots of the pines. Huge blocks here choke
the channel of the river, and raise its murmurs to a roar. We emerge
from shade into sunshine, and observe the smoke of a distant cataract
jetting from the side of the mountain. Crags and boulders are here
heaped in confusion upon the hill-side, and among them the hardy trees
find a lodgment, asking no nutriment from the stones--asking only a
pedestal on which they may plant their trunks and lift their branches
into the nourishing air. Then comes the cataract itself, plunging in
rhythmic gushes down the shining rocks.

The valley again opens, and finds room for a little hamlet--dingy
hovels, with a white little church in the midst of them; patches of
green meadow and yellow rye, with the gleam of the river here and
there. The moon hangs over the Mischabelhörner, turning a face which
ever waxes paler towards the sun. The valley in the distance seems shut
in by the Allalein glacier, which is approached amid the waterworn
boulders strewn by the river in its hours of turbulence. The rounded
rocks are now beautified with lichens, and scattered trees glimmer
among the heaps. Nature heals herself. She feeds the glacier and planes
the mountains down. She fuses the glacier and exposes the dead rocks.
But instantly her energies are exerted to neutralise the desolation,
clothing the crags with beauty, and sending the wandering wind in
melody through the branches of the pines.

At the Mattmark hotel, which stands at the foot of the Monte Moro,
I was joined by a gentleman who had just liberated himself from an
unpleasant guide. Bennen halted on the way to adjust his knapsack,
while my companion and myself went on. We lost sight of my guide, lost
the track also, and clambered over crag and snow to the summit, where
we waited till Bennen arrived. The mass of Monte Rosa here grandly
revealed itself from top to bottom. Dark cliffs and white snows were
finely contrasted, and the longer I looked at it, the more noble and
impressive did the mountain appear. We were very soon clear of the
snow, and went straight down the declivity towards Macugnaga.

We put up at the Monte Moro, where a party of friends greeted me with
a vociferous welcome. This was my first visit to Macugnaga, and, save
as a caldron for the generation of fogs, I knew scarcely anything about
it. But there were no fogs there at the time to which I refer, and the
place wore quite a charmed aspect. I walked out alone in the evening,
up through the meadow towards the base of Monte Rosa, and on no other
occasion have I seen peace, beauty, and grandeur so harmoniously
blended. Earth and air were exquisite, and I returned to the hotel
brimful of content.

Monte Rosa with her peaks and spurs builds here a noble amphitheatre.
From the heart of the mountain creeps the Macugnaga glacier. To the
right a precipitous barrier extends to the Cima di Jazzi, and between
the latter and Monte Rosa this barrier is scarred by two couloirs, one
of which, or the cliff beside it, has the reputation of forming the
old pass of the Weissthor. It had long been uncertain whether this
so-called ‘Alter Pass’ had ever been used as such, and many superior
mountaineers deemed it from inspection to be impracticable. All doubt
on this point was removed this year; for Mr. Tuckett, led by Bennen,
had crossed the barrier by the couloir most distant from Monte Rosa,
and consequently nearest to the Cima di Jazzi. As I stood in front of
the hotel in the afternoon, I said to Bennen that I should like to try
the pass on the following day; in ten minutes afterwards the plan of
our expedition was arranged. We were to start before the dawn, and, to
leave Bennen’s hands free, a muscular young fellow named Andermatten
was engaged to carry our provisions. It was also proposed to vary the
proceedings by assailing the ridge by the couloir nearest to Monte
Rosa.




XII.

_THE OLD WEISSTHOR._


I was called by my host at a quarter before three. The firmament of
Monte Rosa was almost as black as the rocks beneath it, while above in
the darkness trembled the stars. At 4 A.M. we quitted the hotel. We
wound along the meadows, by the slumbering houses, and the unslumbering
river. The eastern heaven soon brightened, and we could look direct
through the gloom of the valley at the opening of the dawn. We threaded
our way amid the boulders which the torrent had scattered over the
plain, and among which groups of stately pines now find anchorage. Some
of the trees had exerted all their force in a vertical direction, and
rose straight, tall, and mastlike, without lateral branches. We reached
a great moraine, grey with years, and clothed with magnificent pines;
our way lay up it, and from the top we dropped into a little dell
of magical beauty. Deep hidden by the glacier-built ridges, guarded
by noble trees, soft and green at the bottom, and tufted round with
bilberry bushes, through which peeped here and there the lichen-covered
crags, I have rarely seen a spot in which I should so like to dream
away a day. Before I entered it, Monte Rosa was still in shadow, but on
my emergence I noticed that her precipices were all aglow. The purple
colouring of the mountains observed on looking down the valley was
indescribable; out of Italy I have never seen anything like it. Oxygen
and nitrogen could not produce the effect; some effluence from the
earth, some foreign constituent of the atmosphere, developed in those
deep valleys by the southern sun, must sift the solar beams, weaken
the rays of medium refrangibility, and blend the red and violet of
the spectrum to that incomparable hue. The air indeed is filled with
floating matters which vary from day to day, and it is mainly to such
extraneous substances that the chromatic splendours of our atmosphere
are to be ascribed. The air south of the Alps is in this respect
different from that on the north, but a modicum even of arsenic might
be respired with satisfaction, if warmed by the bloom which suffused
the air of Italy this glorious dawn.

The ancient moraines of the Macugnaga glacier rank among the finest
that I have seen; long, high ridges tapering from base to edge, hoary
with age, but beautified by the shrubs and blossoms of to-day. We
crossed the ice and them. At the foot of the old Weissthor lay couched
a small glacier, which had landed a multitude of boulders on the slope
below it; and amid these we were soon threading our way. We crossed
the little glacier, which at one place strove to be disagreeable, and
here I learned from the deportment of his axe the kind of work to which
our porter had been previously accustomed. Half a dozen strokes shook
the head of the implement from its handle. We reached the rocks to the
right of the couloir and climbed them for some distance. At the base
the ice was cut by profound fissures, which extended quite across, and
rendered a direct advance up the gulley impossible; but higher up we
dropped down upon the snow.

Close to the rocks it was scarred by a furrow six or eight feet deep,
and about twelve in width, evidently the track of avalanches, or of
rocks let loose from the heights. Into this we descended. The bottom
was firm, and roughened by stones which found a lodgment there. It
seemed that we had here a very suitable roadway to the top. But a
sudden crash was heard aloft. I looked upward, and right over the
snow-brow which closed the view perceived a large brown boulder
in the air, while a roar of unseen stones showed that the visible
projectile was merely the first shot of a general cannonade. They
appeared--pouring straight down upon us--the sides of the furrow
preventing them from squandering their force in any other direction.
‘Schnell!’ shouted the man behind me, and there is a ring in the word,
when sharply uttered in the Alps, that almost lifts a man off his feet.
I sprang forward, but, urged by a sterner impulse, the man behind
sprung right on to me. We cleared the furrow exactly as the first stone
flew by, and once in safety we could calmly admire the energy with
which the rattling boulders sped along.

Our way now lay up the couloir; the snow was steep, but knobbly,
and hence but few steps were required to give the boots a hold. We
crossed and recrossed obliquely, like a horse drawing a laden cart
up hill. At times we paused and examined the heights. The view ended
in the snow-fields above, but near the summit suddenly rose a high
ice-wall. If we persisted in the couloir, this barrier would have to be
surmounted, and the possibility of scaling it was very questionable.
Our attention therefore was turned to the rocks at our right, and the
thought of assailing them was several times mooted and discussed. They
at length seduced us, and we resolved to abandon the snow. To reach
the rocks, however, we had to recross the avalanche channel, which
was here very deep. Bennen hewed a gap at the top of its flanking
wall, and, stooping over, scooped steps out of its vertical face. He
then made a deep hole, in which he anchored his left arm, let himself
thus partly down, and with his right pushed the steps to the bottom.
While this was going on small stones were continually flying down the
gulley. Bennen reached the floor, and I followed. Our companion was
still clinging to the snow-wall, when a horrible clatter was heard
overhead. It was another stone avalanche, which there was hardly a
hope of escaping. Happily a rock was here firmly stuck in the bed of
the gulley, and I chanced to be beside it when the first huge missile
appeared. This was the delinquent which had set the others loose. I was
directly in the line of fire, but, ducking behind the boulder, I let
the projectile shoot over my head. Behind it came a shoal of smaller
fry, each of them, however, quite competent to crack a human life.
‘Schnell!’ with its metallic clang, rung from the throat of Bennen; and
never before had I seen his axe so promptly and vigorously applied.

While this infernal cannonade was directed upon us we hung upon a slope
of snow which had been pressed and polished to ice by the descending
stones, and so steep that a single slip would have converted us into
an avalanche also. Without steps of some kind we dared not set foot on
the slope, and these had to be cut while the stone shower was falling
on us. Mere scratches in the ice, however, were all the axe could
accomplish, and on these we steadied ourselves with the energy of
desperate men. Bennen was first, and I followed him, while the stones
flew thick beside and between us. My excellent guide thought of me
more than of himself, and once caught upon the handle of his axe, as a
cricketer catches a ball upon his bat, a lump which might have finished
my climbing. The labour of his axe was here for a time divided between
the projectiles and the ice, while at every pause in the volley ‘he
cut a step and sprang forward.’ Had the peril been less, it would have
been amusing to see our duckings and contortions as we fenced with
our swarming foes. A final jump landed us on an embankment out of the
direct line of fire, and we thus escaped a danger extremely exciting to
us all.

We had next to descend an ice-slope to a place at which the rocks could
be invaded. Here Andermatten slipped, shot down the slope, knocked
Bennen off his legs, but before the rope had jerked me off mine the
guide had stopped his flight. The porter’s hat, however, followed the
rushing stones. It was shaken off his head and lost. If discipline for
eye, limb, head, and heart be of any value, we had it, and were still
likely to have it, here. Our first experience of the rocks was by no
means comforting: they were uniformly steep, and, as far as we could
judge from a long look upwards, they were likely to continue so. A
stiffer bit than ordinary intervened now and then, making us feel how
possible it was to be entirely cut off.

We at length reached real difficulty number one. All three of us were
huddled together on a narrow ledge, with a smooth and vertical cliff
above us. Bennen tried it in various ways, but he was several times
forced back to the ledge. At length he managed to hook the fingers of
one hand over the top of the cliff, while to aid his grip he tried to
fasten his shoes against its face. But the nails scraped freely over
the granular surface, and he had for a time to lift himself almost by a
single arm. As he did so he had as ugly a place beneath him as a human
body could well be suspended over. We were tied to him of course; but
the jerk, had his grip failed, would have been terrible. He raised
at length his breast to a level with the top, and leaning over it he
relieved the strain. Seizing upon something further on, he lifted
himself quite to the top; then tightened the rope, while I slowly
worked myself over the face of the cliff after him. We were soon side
by side, and immediately afterwards Andermatten, with his long unkempt
hair, and face white with excitement, hung midway between heaven and
earth supported by the rope alone. We hauled him up bodily, and as he
stood upon the ledge his limbs quivered beneath him.

We now strained slowly upwards amid the maze of crags, and scaled
a second cliff, resembling, though in a modified form, that just
described. There was no peace, no rest, no delivery from the anxiety
‘which weighed upon the heart.’ Bennen looked extremely blank, and
often cast an eye downward to the couloir we had quitted, muttering
aloud, ‘Had we only held on to the snow!’ He had soon reason to
emphasise his ejaculation.

After climbing for some time, we reached a smooth vertical face of
rock from which, right or left, there was no escape, and over which
we must go. Bennen first tried it unaided, but was obliged to recoil.
Without a lift of five or six feet the thing was impossible. When a boy
I have often climbed a wall by placing a comrade in a stooping posture
with his hands and head against the wall, getting on his back, and
permitting him gradually to straighten himself till he became erect.
This plan I now proposed to Bennen, offering to take him on my back.
‘Nein, Herr!’ he replied; ‘nicht Sie, ich will es mit Andermatten
versuchen.’ I could not persuade him, so Andermatten got upon the
ledge, and fixed his knee for Bennen to stand on. In this position my
guide obtained a precarious grip, just sufficient to enable him to pass
with safety from the knee to the shoulder. He paused here, and pulled
away such splinters as might prove treacherous if he laid hold of them.
He at length found a firm one, and had next to urge himself, not
fairly upward, for right above us the top was entirely out of reach,
but obliquely along the face of the cliff. He succeeded, anchored
himself, and called upon me to advance.

The rope was tight, it is true, but it was not vertical, so that a
slip would cause me to swing like a pendulum over the cliff’s face.
With considerable effort I managed to hand Bennen his axe, and while
doing so my own staff escaped me and was irrecoverably lost. I
ascended Andermatten’s shoulders as Bennen did, but my body was not
long enough to bridge the way to the guide’s arm; so I had to risk the
possibility of becoming a pendulum. A little protrusion gave my left
foot some support. I suddenly raised myself a yard, and here was met
by the iron grip of my guide. In a second I was safely stowed away in
a neighbouring fissure. Andermatten now remained. He first detached
himself from the rope, tied it round his coat and knapsack, which were
drawn up. The rope was again let down, and the porter tied it firmly
round his waist. It was not made in England, and was perhaps lighter
than it ought to be; so to help it hands and feet were scraped with
spasmodic energy over the rock. He struggled too much, and Bennen cried
sharply, ‘Langsam! langsam! Keine Furcht!’ The poor fellow looked very
pale and bewildered as his bare head emerged above the ledge. His body
soon followed. Bennen always used the imperfect for the present tense,
‘Er war ganz bleich,’ he remarked to me, by the ‘war’ meaning _ist_.

The young man seemed to regard Bennen with a kind of awe. ‘Sir,’ he
exclaimed, ‘you would not find another guide in Switzerland to lead
you up here.’ Nor, indeed, in Bennen’s behalf be it spoken, would he
have done so if he could have avoided it; but we had fairly got into
a net, the meshes of which must be resolutely cut. I had previously
entertained the undoubting belief that where a chamois could climb
a man could follow; but when I saw the marks of the animal on these
all but inaccessible ledges, my belief, though not eradicated, became
weaker than it had previously been.

Onward again, slowly winding through the craggy mazes, and closely
scanning the cliffs as we ascended. Our easiest work was stiff, but the
‘stiff’ was an agreeable relaxation from the perilous. By a lateral
deviation we reached a point whence we could look into the couloir by
which Mr. Tuckett had ascended: here Bennen relieved himself by a sigh
and ejaculation: ‘Would that we had chosen it! we might pass up yonder
rocks blindfold!’ But repining was useless; our work was marked out
for us and had to be accomplished. After another difficult tug Bennen
reached a point whence he could see a large extent of the rocks above
us. There was no serious difficulty within view, and the announcement
of this cheered us mightily. Every vertical yard, however, was to be
won only by strenuous effort. For a long time the snow cornice hung
high above us; we now approached its level; the last cliff formed a
sloping stair with geologic strata for steps. We sprang up it, and the
magnificent snow-field of the Görner glacier immediately opened to our
view. The anxiety of the last four hours disappeared like an unpleasant
dream, and with that perfect happiness which perfect health can alone
impart, we consumed our cold mutton and champagne on the summit of the
old Weissthor.




XIII.

_RESCUE FROM A CREVASSE._


Mr. Huxley and myself had been staying for some days at Grindelwald,
hoping for steady weather, and looking at times into the wild and noble
region which the Schreckhorn, the Wetterhorn, the Viescherhörner, and
the Eiger feed with eternal snows. We had scanned the buttresses of
the Jungfrau with a view to forcing a passage between the Jungfrau
and the Monk from the Wengern Alp to the Aletsch glacier. The weather
for a time kept hopes and fears alternately afloat, but finally it
declared against us; so we moved with the unelastic tread of beaten
soldiers over the Great Sheideck, and up the Vale of Hasli to the
Grimsel. We crossed the pass whose planed and polished rocks had long
ago attracted the attention of Sir John Leslie, though the solution
which he then offered ignored the ancient glacier which we now know
to have been the planing tool employed. On rounding an angle of the
Mayenwand, two travellers suddenly appeared in front of us; they were
Mr. (now Sir John) Lubbock and his guide. He had been waiting at the
new hotel erected by M. Seiler at the foot of the Mayenwand, expecting
our arrival; and finally, despairing of this, he had resolved to
abandon the mountains, and was now bound for Brientz. In fact, the
lakes of Switzerland, and the ancient men who once bivouacked along
their borders, were to him the principal objects of interest; and we
caught him in the act of declaring a preference for the lowlands which
we could not by any means share.

We reversed his course, carried him with us down the mountain, and
soon made ourselves at home in M. Seiler’s hotel. Here we had three
days’ training on the glacier and the adjacent heights, and on one of
the days Lubbock and myself made an attempt upon the Galenstock. By
the flank of the mountain, with the Rhone glacier on our right, we
reached the heights over the ice cascade and crossed the glacier above
the fall. The sky was clear and the air pleasant as we ascended; but
in the earth’s atmosphere the sun works his swiftest necromancy, the
lightness of air rendering it in a peculiar degree capable of change.
Clouds suddenly generated came drifting up the valley of the Rhone,
covering the glacier and swathing the mountain-tops, but leaving clear
for a time the upper _névé_ of the Rhone. Grandeur is conceded while
beauty is sometimes denied to the Alps. But the higher snow-fields of
the great glaciers are altogether beautiful--not throned in repellent
grandeur, but endowed with a grace so tender as to suggest the
loveliness of woman.

The day was one long succession of surprises wrought by the
cloud-filled and wind-rent air. We reached the top, and found there
a gloom which might be felt. It was almost thick enough to cut each
of us away from the vision of his fellows. But suddenly, in the air
above us, the darkness would melt away, and the deep blue heaven would
reveal itself spanning the dazzling snows. Beyond the glacier rose the
black and craggy summit of the Finsteraarhorn, and other summits and
other crags emerged in succession as the battle-clouds rolled away. But
the smoke would again whirl in upon us, and we looked once more into
infinite haze from the cornice which lists the mountain-ridge. Again
the clouds are torn asunder, and again they close. And thus, in upper
air, did the sun play a wild accompaniment to the mystic music of the
world below.

From the Rhone glacier we proceeded down the Rhone valley to Viesch,
whence, in the cool twilight, all three of us ascended to the Hotel
Jungfrau, on the Æggischhorn. This we made our head-quarters for
some days, and here Lubbock and I decided to ascend the Jungfrau.
The proprietor of the hotel keeps guides for this excursion, but his
charges are so high as to be almost prohibitory. I, however, needed
no guide in addition to my faithful Bennen; but simply a porter of
sufficient strength and skill to follow where he led. In the village of
Laax Bennen found such a porter--a young man named Bielander, who had
the reputation of being both courageous and strong. He was the only son
of his mother, and she was a widow.

This young man and a second porter we sent on with our provisions to
the Grotto of the Faulberg, where we were to spend the night. Between
the Æggischhorn and this cave the glacier presents no difficulty which
the most ordinary caution cannot overcome, and the thought of danger
in connection with it never occurred to us. An hour and a half after
the departure of our porters we slowly wended our way to the lake of
Märjelin, which we skirted, and were soon upon the ice. The middle of
the glacier was almost as smooth as a carriage-road, cut here and there
by musical brooks produced by the superficial ablation. To Lubbock the
scene opened out with the freshness of a new revelation, as, previously
to this year, he had never been among the glaciers of the Alps. To me,
though not new, the region had lost no trace of the interest with which
I first viewed it. We moved briskly along the frozen incline, until,
after a couple of hours’ march, we saw a solitary human being standing
on the lateral moraine of the glacier, near the point where we were to
quit it for the cave of the Faulberg.

At first this man excited no attention. He stood and watched us, but
did not come towards us, until finally our curiosity was aroused by
observing that he was one of our own two men. The glacier here is
always cut by crevasses, which, while they present no real difficulty,
require care. We approached our porter, but he never moved; and when we
came up to him he looked stupid, and did not speak until he was spoken
to. Bennen addressed him in the patois of the place, and he answered in
the same patois. His answer must have been more than usually obscure,
for Bennen misunderstood the most important part of it. ‘My God!’ he
exclaimed, turning to us, ‘Walters is killed!’ Walters was the guide
at the Æggischhorn, with whom, in the present instance, we had nothing
to do. ‘No, not Walters,’ responded the man; ‘it is my comrade that
is killed.’ Bennen looked at him with a wild bewildered stare. ‘How
killed?’ he exclaimed. ‘Lost in a crevasse,’ was the reply. We were all
so stunned that for some moments we did not quite seize the import of
the terrible statement. Bennen at length tossed his arms in the air,
exclaiming, ‘Jesu Maria! what am I to do?’ With the swiftness that some
ascribe to dreams, I surrounded the fact with imaginary adjuncts, one
of which was that the man had been drawn dead from the crevasse, and
was now a corpse in the cave of the Faulberg, for I took it for granted
that, had he been still entombed, his comrade would have run or called
for our aid. Several times in succession the porter affirmed that the
missing man was certainly dead. ‘How does he know that he is dead?’
Lubbock demanded. ‘A man is sometimes rendered insensible by a fall
without being killed.’ This question was repeated in German, but met
with the same dogmatic response. ‘Where is the man?’ I asked. ‘There,’
replied the porter, stretching his arm towards the glacier. ‘In the
crevasse?’ A stolid ‘Ja!’ was the answer. It was with difficulty that I
quelled an imprecation. ‘Lead the way to the place, you blockhead,’ and
he led the way.

We were soon beside a wide and jagged cleft which resembled a kind
of cave more than an ordinary crevasse. This cleft had been spanned
by a snow bridge, now broken, and to the edge of which footsteps
could be traced. The glacier at the place was considerably torn, but
simple patience was the only thing needed to unravel its complexity.
This quality our porter lacked, and, hoping to make shorter work of
it, he attempted to cross the bridge. It gave way, and he went down,
carrying an immense load of _débris_ along with him. We looked into
the hole, at one end of which the vision was cut short by darkness,
while immediately under the broken bridge it was crammed with snow
and shattered icicles. We saw nothing more. We listened with strained
attention, and from the depths of the glacier issued a low moan. Its
repetition assured us that it was no delusion--the man was still alive.
Bennen from the first had been extremely excited; and the fact of
his having, as a Catholic, saints and angels to appeal to, augmented
his emotion. When he heard the moaning he became almost frantic. He
attempted to get into the crevasse, but was obliged to recoil. It was
quite plain that a second life was in danger, for my guide seemed to
have lost all self-control. I placed my hand heavily upon his shoulder,
and admonished him that upon his coolness depended the life of his
friend. ‘If you behave like a man, we shall save him; if like a woman,
he is lost.’

[Illustration: RECOVERY OF OUR PORTER.]

A first-rate rope accompanied the party, but unhappily it was with the
man in the crevasse. Coats, waistcoats, and braces were instantly taken
off and knotted together. I watched Bennen while this work was going
on; his hands trembled with excitement, and his knots were evidently
insecure. The last junction complete, he exclaimed, ‘Now let me down!’
‘Not until each of these knots has been tested; not an inch!’[11] Two
of them gave way, and Lubbock’s waistcoat also proved too tender for
the strain. The _débris_ was about forty feet from the surface of the
glacier, but two intermediate prominences afforded a kind of footing.
Bennen was dropped down upon one of these; I followed, being let down
by Lubbock and the other porter. Bennen then descended the remaining
distance, and was followed by me. More could not find room.

[11] ‘Ach, Herr,’ he replied to one of my remonstrances, ‘Sein Sie
nicht so hart.’

The shape and size of the cavity were such as to produce a kind of
resonance, which rendered it difficult to fix the precise spot from
which the sound issued; but the moaning continued, becoming to all
appearance gradually feebler. Fearing to wound the man, the ice-rubbish
was cautiously rooted away; it rang curiously as it fell into the
adjacent gloom. A layer two or three feet thick was thus removed; and
finally, from the frozen mass, and so bloodless as to be almost as
white as the surrounding snow, issued a single human hand. The fingers
moved. Round it we rooted, cleared the arm, and reached the knapsack,
which we cut away. We also regained our rope. The man’s head was then
laid bare, and my brandy-flask was immediately at his lips. He tried
to speak, but his words jumbled themselves to a dull moan. Bennen’s
feelings got the better of him at intervals; he wrought like a hero,
but at times he needed guidance and stern admonition. The arms once
free, we passed the rope underneath them, and tried to draw the man
out. But the ice-fragments round him had regelated so as to form a
solid case. Thrice we essayed to draw him up, thrice we failed; he had
literally to be hewn out of the ice, and not until his last foot was
extricated were we able to lift him. By pulling him from above, and
pushing him from below, the man was at length raised to the surface of
the glacier.

For an hour we had been in the crevasse in shirt-sleeves--the porter
had been in it for two hours--and the dripping ice had drenched us.
Bennen, moreover, had worked with the energy of madness, and now the
reaction came. He shook as if he would fall to pieces; but brandy and
some dry covering revived him. The rescued man was helpless, unable
to stand, unable to utter an articulate sentence. Bennen proposed to
carry him down the glacier towards home. Had this been attempted, the
man would certainly have died upon the ice. Bennen thought he could
carry him for two hours; but the guide underrated his own exhaustion
and overrated the vitality of the porter. ‘It cannot be thought of,’ I
said: ‘to the cave of Faulberg, where we must tend him as well as we
can.’ We got him to the side of the glacier, where Bennen took him on
his back; in ten minutes he sank under his load. It was now my turn,
so I took the man on my back and plodded on with him as far as I was
able. Helping each other thus by turns, we reached the mountain grot.

The sun had set, and the crown of the Jungfrau was embedded in amber
light. Thinking that the Märjelin See might be reached before darkness,
I proposed starting in search of help. Bennen protested against my
going alone, and I thought I noticed moisture in Lubbock’s eye. Such an
occasion brings out a man’s feeling if he have any. I gave them both
my blessing and made for the glacier. But my anxiety to get quickly
clear of the crevasses defeated its own object. Thrice I found myself
in difficulty, and the light was visibly departing. The conviction
deepened that persistence would be folly, and the most impressive
moment of my existence was that on which I stopped at the brink of
a profound fissure and looked upon the mountains and the sky. The
serenity was perfect--not a cloud, not a breeze, not a sound, while the
last hues of sunset spread over the solemn west.

I returned; warm wine was given to our patient, and all our dry
clothes were wrapped around him. Hot-water bottles were placed at
his feet, and his back was briskly rubbed. He continued to groan a
long time; but, finally, both this and the trembling ceased. Bennen
watched him solemnly, and at length muttered in anguish, ‘Sir, he is
dead!’ I leaned over the man and found him breathing gently; I felt
his pulse--it was beating tranquilly. ‘Not dead, dear old Bennen; he
will be able to crawl home with us in the morning.’ The prediction was
justified by the event; and two days afterwards we saw him at Laax,
minus a bit of his ear, with a bruise upon his cheek, and a few scars
upon his hand, but without a broken bone or serious injury of any kind.

The self-denying conduct of the second porter made us forget his
stupidity--it may have been stupefaction. As I lay there wet, through
the long hours of that dismal night, I almost registered a vow never to
tread upon a glacier again. But, like the forces in the physical world,
human emotions vary with the distance from their origin, and a year
afterwards I was again upon the ice.

       *       *       *       *       *

Towards the close of 1862 Bennen and myself made ‘the tour of
Monte Rosa,’ halting for a day or two at the excellent hostelry
of Delapierre, in the magnificent Val du Lys. We scrambled up the
Grauhaupt, a point exceedingly favourable to the study of the
conformation of the Alps. We also halted at Alagna and Macugnaga. But,
notwithstanding their admitted glory, the Italian valleys did not suit
either Bennen or me. We longed for the more tonic air of the northern
slopes, and were glad to change the valley of Ansasca for that of
Saas. We subsequently, on a perfect day, crossed the Alphubel Joch--a
very noble pass, and by no means difficult if the ordinary route be
followed. But Bennen and I did not follow that route. We tried to cross
the mountains obliquely from the chalets of Täsch, close under the
Alphubel, and, as a consequence, encountered on a spur of the mountain
a danger to which I will not further refer than to say that Bennen’s
voice is still present to me as he said, ‘Ach, Herr! es thut mir Leid,
Sie hier zu sehen.’[12]

[12] Rendered in accordance with the tone and sentiment, this would
be, ‘Ah! sir, it breaks my heart to see you here.’




XIV.

_THE MATTERHORN-SECOND ASSAULT._


Four years ago I had not entertained a wish or a thought regarding the
climbing of the Matterhorn. Indeed, assailing mountains of any kind was
then but an accidental interlude to less exciting occupations upon the
glaciers of the Alps. But in 1859 Mr. Vaughan Hawkins had inspected the
mountain from Breuil, and in 1860, on the strength of this inspection,
he invited me to join him in an attack upon the untrodden peak.
Guided by Johann Bennen, and accompanied by an old chamois-hunter
named Carrel, we tried the mountain, but had to halt midway among its
precipices. We returned to Breuil with the belief that, if sufficient
time could be secured, the summit--at least, _one_ summit--might be
won. Had I felt that we had done our best on this occasion, I should
have relinquished all further thought of the mountain; but, unhappily,
I felt the reverse, and thus a little cloud of dissatisfaction hung
round the memory of the attempt. In 1861 I once more looked at the
Matterhorn, but, as shown in Chapter X., was forbidden to set foot
upon it. Finally, in 1862, the desire to finish what I felt to be a
piece of work only half completed beset me so strongly that I resolved
to make a last attack upon the unconquered hill.

The resolution, as a whole, may have been a rash one, but there was no
rashness displayed in the carrying out of its details. I did not ignore
the law of gravity, but felt, on the contrary, that the strongest
aspirations towards the summit of the Matterhorn would not prevent
precipitation to its base through a false step or a failing grasp.
The general plan proposed was this: Two first-rate guides were to be
engaged, and, to leave their arms free, they were to be accompanied by
two strong and expert porters. The party was thus to consist of five in
all. During the ascent it was proposed that three of those men should
always be, not only out of danger, but attached firmly to the rocks;
and while they were thus secure, it was thought that the remaining two
might take liberties, and commit themselves to ventures which would
otherwise be inexcusable or impossible. With a view to this, I had a
rope specially manufactured in London, and guaranteed by its maker
to bear a far greater strain than was ever likely to be thrown upon
it. A light ladder was also constructed, the two sides of which might
be carried like huge alpenstocks, while its steps, which could be
inserted at any moment, were strapped upon a porter’s back. Long iron
nails and a hammer were also among our appliances. Actual experience
considerably modified these arrangements, and compelled us in almost
all cases to resort to methods as much open to a savage as to people
acquainted with the mechanical arts.

Throughout the latter half of July rumours from the Matterhorn were
rife in the Bernese Oberland, and I felt an extreme dislike to add
to the gossip. Wishing, moreover, that others who desired it might
have a fair trial, I lingered for nearly three weeks among the
Bernese and Valasian Alps. This time, however, was not wasted. It was
employed in burning up the effete matters which nine months’ work
in London had lodged in my muscles--in rescuing the blood from that
fatty degeneration which a sedentary life is calculated to induce. I
chose instead of the air of a laboratory that of the Wetterhorn, the
Galenstock, and the mountains which surround the Great Aletsch glacier.
Each succeeding day added to my strength.

There is assuredly morality in the oxygen of the mountains, as there is
immorality in the miasma of a marsh, and a higher power than mere brute
force lies latent in Alpine mutton. We are recognising more and more
the influence of physical elements in the conduct of life, for when the
blood flows in a purer current the heart is capable of a higher glow.
Spirit and matter are interfused; the Alps improve us _totally_, and we
return from their precipices wiser as well as stronger men.

It is usual for the proprietor of the hotel on the Æggischhorn to
retain a guide for excursions in the neighbourhood; and last year he
happened to have in his employment one Walters, a man of superior
strength and energy. He was the house companion of Bennen, who was
loud in his praise. Thinking it would strengthen Bennen, hand and
heart, to have so tried a man beside him, I engaged Walters, and
we all three set off with cheerful spirits to Zermatt. Thence we
proceeded over the Matterjoch; and as we descended to Breuil we looked
long at the dangerous eminences to our right, among which we were to
trust ourselves in a day or two. There was nothing jubilant in our
thoughts or conversation; the character of the work before us quelled
presumption. We felt nothing that could be called confidence as to the
issue of the enterprise, but we also felt the inner compactness and
determination of men who, though they know their work to be difficult,
feel no disposition to shrink from it. The Matterhorn, in fact, was our
temple, and we approached it with feelings not unworthy of so great
a shrine. Arrived at Breuil, we found that a gentleman, whose long
perseverance merited victory (and who has since gained it),[13] was
then upon the mountain. The succeeding day was spent in scanning the
crags and in making preparations. At night Mr. Whymper returned from
the Matterhorn, having left his tent upon the rocks. In the frankest
spirit, he placed it at my disposal, and thus relieved me from the
necessity of carrying up my own. At Breuil I engaged two porters,
both named Carrel, the youngest of whom was the son of the Carrel
who accompanied Mr. Hawkins and me in 1860, while the other was old
Carrel’s nephew. He had served as a _bersaglier_ in three campaigns,
and had fought at the battle of Solferino; his previous habits of life
rendered him an extremely handy and useful companion, and his climbing
powers proved also very superior.

[13] Mr. Whymper.

About noon on an August day we disentangled ourselves from the hotel,
first slowly sauntering along a small green valley, but soon meeting
the bluffs, which indicated our approach to uplifted land. The bright
grass was quickly left behind, and soon afterwards we were toiling
laboriously upward among the rocks. The Val Tournanche is bounded on
the right by a chain of mountains, the higher end of which abutted, in
former ages, against Matterhorn. But now a gap is cut out between both,
and a saddle stretches from the one to the other. From this saddle a
kind of couloir runs downwards, widening out gradually and blending
with the gentler slopes below. We held on to the rocks to the left of
this couloir, until we reached the base of a precipice which fell sheer
from the summits above. Water trickled from the upper ledges, and the
descent of a stone at intervals admonished us that gravity had here
more serious missiles at command than the drippings of the liquefied
snow. So we moved with prudent speed along the base of the precipice,
crossing at one place the ice-gulley where Mr. Whymper nearly lost
his life. Immediately afterwards we found ourselves upon the saddle
which stretches with the curvature of a chain to the base of the true
Matterhorn. The opening out of the western mountains from this point of
view is grand and impressive, and with our eyes and hearts full of the
scene we moved along the saddle, and soon came to rest upon the first
steep crags of the real Monarch of the Alps.

Here we paused, unlocked our scrip, and had some bread and wine. Again
and again we looked to the cliffs above us, ignorant of the treatment
that we were to receive at their hands. We had gathered up our traps,
and bent to the work before us, when suddenly an explosion occurred
overhead. We looked aloft and saw in mid-air a solid shot from the
Matterhorn, describing its proper parabola, and finally splitting into
fragments as it smote one of the rocky towers in front of us. Down the
scattered fragments came like a kind of spray, slightly wide of us,
but still near enough to compel a sharp look-out. Two or three such
explosions occurred, but we chose the back-fin of the mountain for our
track, and from this the falling stones were speedily deflected right
or left. Before the set of sun we reached our place of bivouac. A roomy
tent was already there, and we had brought with us an additional light
one, intended to afford accommodation to me. It was pitched in the
shadow of a great rock, which seemed to offer a safe barrier against
the cannonade from the heights. Carrel, the soldier, built a platform,
on which he placed the tent, for the mountain itself furnished no level
space of sufficient area.

Meanwhile, fog, that enemy of the climber, came creeping up the
valleys, while dense flounces of cloud gathered round the hills. As
night drew near, the fog thickened through a series of intermittences
which a mountain-land alone can show. Sudden uprushings of air would
often carry the clouds aloft in vertical currents, while horizontal
gusts swept them wildly to and fro. Different currents impinging upon
each other sometimes formed whirling cyclones of cloud. The air was
tortured in its search of equilibrium. Sometimes all sight of the
lower world was cut away--then again the fog would melt and show us the
sunny pastures of Breuil smiling far beneath. Sudden peals upon the
heights, succeeded by the sound of tumbling rocks, announced, from time
to time, the disintegration of the Matterhorn. We were quite swathed in
fog when we retired to rest, and had scarcely a hope that the morrow’s
sun would be able to dispel the gloom. Throughout the night the rocks
roared intermittently, as they swept down the adjacent couloir. I
opened my eyes at midnight, and, through a minute hole in the canvas
of my tent, saw a star. I rose and found the heavens swept clear of
clouds, while above me the solemn battlements of the Matterhorn were
projected against the blackened sky.

At 2 A.M. we were astir. Carrel made the fire, boiled the water, and
prepared our coffee. It was 4 A.M. before we had fairly started. We
adhered as long as possible to the hacked and weather-worn spine of
the mountain, until at length its disintegration became too vast. The
alternations of sun and frost have made wondrous havoc on the southern
face of the Matterhorn; but they have left brown-red masses of the
most imposing magnitude behind--pillars, and towers, and splintered
obelisks, grand in their hoariness--savage, but still softened by
the colouring of age. The mountain is a gigantic ruin: but its
firmer masonry will doubtless bear the shocks of another æon. We were
compelled to quit the ridge, which now swept round and fronted us like
a wall. The weather had cleft the rock clean away, leaving smooth
sections, with here and there a ledge barely competent to give a man
footing. It was manifest that for some time our fight must be severe.
We examined the precipice, and exchanged opinions. Bennen swerved to
the right and to the left to render his inspection complete. There
was no choice; over this wall we must go, or give up the attempt. We
reached its base, roped ourselves together, and were soon upon the face
of the precipice. Walters was first, and Bennen second, both exchanging
pushes and pulls. Walters, holding on to the narrow ledges above,
scraped his ironshod boots against the cliff, thus lifting himself in
part by friction. Bennen was close behind, aiding him with an arm, a
knee, or a shoulder. Once upon a ledge, he was able to give Bennen a
hand. Thus we advanced, straining, bending, and clinging to the rocks
with a grasp like that of desperation, but with heads perfectly cool.
We perched upon the ledges in succession--each in the first place
making his leader secure, and accepting his help afterwards. A last
strong effort threw the body of Walters across the top of the wall;
and, he being safe, our success thus far was ensured.

This ascent landed us once more upon the ridge, with safe footing on
the ledged strata of the disintegrated gneiss. Pushing upward, we
approached the conical summit seen from Breuil--the peak, however,
being the end of a nearly horizontal ridge foreshortened from below.
But before us, and assuredly as we thought within our grasp, was
the highest point of the renowned Matterhorn. ‘Well,’ I remarked to
Bennen, ‘we shall at all events win the lower summit.’ ‘That will not
satisfy us,’ was his reply. I knew he would answer thus, for a laugh
of elation, which had something of scorn in it, had burst from the
party when the true summit came in view. We felt perfectly certain
of success; not one amongst us harboured a thought of failure. ‘In
an hour,’ cried Bennen, ‘the people at Zermatt shall see our flag
planted yonder.’ Up we went in this spirit, with a forestalled triumph
making our ascent a jubilee. We reached the first summit, and planted
a flag upon it. Walters, however, who was an exceedingly strong and
competent guide, but without the genius which is fired by difficulty,
had previously remarked, with reference to the last precipice of the
mountain, ‘We may still find difficulty there.’ The same thought had
probably brooded in other minds; still it angered me slightly to hear
misgiving obtain an audible expression.

From the point on which we planted our first flagstaff a hacked and
extremely acute ridge ran, and abutted against the final precipice.
Along this we moved cautiously, while the face of the precipice came
clearer and clearer into view. The ridge on which we stood ran right
against it; it was the only means of approach, while ghastly abysses
fell on either side. We sat down, and inspected the place; no glass
was needed, it was so near. Three out of the four men muttered almost
simultaneously, ‘It is impossible.’ Bennen was the only man of the
four who did not utter the word. A jagged stretch of the ridge still
separated us from the precipice. I pointed to a spot at some distance
from the place where we sat, and asked the three doubters whether
that point might not be reached without much danger. ‘We think so,’
was the reply. ‘Then let us go there.’ We reached the place, and sat
down there. The men again muttered despairingly, and at length they
said distinctly, ‘We must give it up.’ I by no means wished to put on
pressure, but directing their attention to a point at the base of the
precipice, I asked them whether they could not reach that point without
much risk. The reply was, ‘Yes.’ ‘Then,’ I said, ‘let us go there.’ We
moved cautiously along, and reached the point aimed at. The ridge was
here split by a deep cleft which separated it from the final precipice.
So savage a spot I had never seen, and I sat down upon it with the
sickness of disappointed hope. The summit was within almost a stone’s
throw of us, and the thought of retreat was bitter in the extreme.
Bennen excitedly pointed out a track which he thought practicable. He
spoke of danger, of difficulty, never of impossibility; but this was
the ground taken by the other three men.

As on other occasions, my guide sought to fix on me the responsibility
of return, but with the usual result. ‘Where you go I will follow, be
it up or down.’ It took him half an hour to make up his mind. But he
was finally forced to accept defeat. What could he do? The other men
had yielded utterly, and our occupation was clearly gone. Hacking a
length of six feet from one of the sides of our ladder, we planted it
on the spot where we stopped. It was firmly fixed, and, protected as it
is from lightning by the adjacent peak, it will probably stand there
when those who planted it think no more of the Matterhorn.

How this wondrous mountain has been formed will be the subject of
subsequent enquiry. It is not a spurt of molten matter ejected from the
nucleus of the earth; from base to summit there is no truly igneous
rock. It has no doubt been upraised by subterranean forces, but that it
has been lifted as an isolated mass is not conceivable. It must have
formed part of a mighty boss or swelling, from which the mountain
was subsequently sculptured. These subjects, however, cannot be well
discussed here. To get down the precipice we had scaled in the morning,
we had to fix the remaining length of our ladder at the top, to tie our
rope firmly on to it, and allow it to hang down the cliff. We slid down
it in succession, and there it still dangles, for we could not detach
it. A tempest of hail was here hurled against us; as if the Matterhorn,
not content with shutting its door in our faces, meant to add an
equivalent to the process of kicking us downstairs. The ice-pellets
certainly hit us as bitterly as if they had been thrown in spite,
and in the midst of this malicious cannonade we struck our tents and
returned to Breuil.

       *       *       *       *       *

[Three years subsequently, Carrel the _bersaglier_, and some other Val
Tournanche men, reached my rope, found it bleached to whiteness, but
still strong enough to bear the united weights of three men. By it they
were enabled to scale the precipice, spend the night at a considerable
elevation, and, through the scrutiny rendered possible by an early
start, to find a way to the summit of the Matterhorn. They reached the
top a day or two after the memorable first ascent from Zermatt.]




XV.

_FROM STEIN TO THE GRIMSEL._


On the 19th of July 1863 Mr. Philip Lutley Sclater and I reached
Reichenbach, and on the following day we sauntered up the valley of
Hasli, and over the Kirchet to Imhof, where we turned to the left
into Gadmenthal. Our destination was Stein, which we reached by a
grass-grown road through fine scenery. The goatherds were milking
when we arrived. At the heels of one quadruped, supported by the
ordinary uni-legged stool of the Senner, bent a particularly wild
and dirty-looking individual, who, our guide informed us, was the
proprietor of the inn. ‘He is but a rough Bauer,’ said Jaun, ‘but he
has engaged a pretty maiden to keep house for him.’ While he thus
spoke a light-footed creature glided from the door towards us, and
bade us welcome. She led us upstairs, provided us with baths, took our
orders for dinner, helped us by her suggestions, and answered all our
questions with the utmost propriety and grace. She had been two years
in England, and spoke English with a particularly winning accent.
How she came to be associated with the unkempt individual outside was
a puzzle to both of us. It is Emerson, I think, who remarks on the
benefit which a beautiful face, without trouble to itself, confers
upon him who looks at it. And, though downright beauty could hardly be
claimed for our young hostess, she was handsome enough and graceful
enough to brighten a tired traveller’s thoughts, and to raise by her
presence the modest comforts she dispensed to the level of luxuries.[14]

[14] Thackeray, in his ‘Peg of Limavady,’ is perhaps more to the point
than Emerson:

    ‘Presently a maid
      Enters with the liquor--
    Half a pint of ale
      Frothing in a beaker;
    As she came she smiled,
      And the smile bewitching,
    On my word and honour,
      Lighted all the kitchen.’


It rained all night, and at 3.30 A.M., when we were called, it still
fell heavily. At 5, however, the clouds began to break, and half an
hour afterwards the heavens were swept quite clear of them. At 6 we
bade our pretty blossom of the Alps good-bye. She had previously
brought her gentle influence to bear upon her master to moderate the
extortion of some of his charges. We were soon upon the Stein glacier,
and after some time reached a col from which we looked down upon the
lower portion of the nobler and more instructive Trift glacier. Brown
bands were drawn across the ice-stream, forming graceful loops with
their convexities turned downwards. The higher portions of the glacier
were not in view; still those bands rendered the inference secure that
an ice-fall existed higher up, at the base of which the bands had
originated. We shot down a shingly couloir to the Trift, and looking
up the glacier the anticipated cascade came into view. At its bottom
the ice, by pressure, underwent that notable change, analogous to
slaty cleavage, which caused the glacier to weather and gather dirt in
parallel grooves, thus marking upon its surface the direction of its
interior lamination.

The ice-cascade being itself impracticable, we scaled the rocks to the
left of it, and were soon in presence of the far-stretching snow-fields
from which the lower glacier derives nutriment. With a view to hidden
crevasses, we here roped ourselves together. The sun was strong, its
direct and reflected blaze combining against us. The scorching warmth
experienced at times by cheeks, lips, and neck indicated that in
my case mischief was brewing; but the eyes being well protected by
dark spectacles, I was comparatively indifferent to the prospective
disfigurement of my face. Mr. Sclater was sheltered by a veil, a
mode of defence which the habit of going into places requiring the
unimpeded eyesight has caused me to neglect.

There would seem to be some specific quality in the sun’s rays which
produces the irritation of the skin experienced in the Alps. The solar
heat may be compared, in point of _quantity_, with that radiated from
a furnace; and the heat encountered by the mountaineer on Alpine
snows is certainly less intense than that endured by workmen in many
of our technical operations. But the terrestrial heat appears to
lack the _quality_ which gives the solar rays their power. The sun
is incomparably richer in what are called chemical rays than are our
fires, and to such rays the irritation may be due. The keen air of the
heights may also have much to do with it. As a remedy for sunburn I
have tried glycerine, and found it a failure. The ordinary lip-salve of
the druggists’ shops is also worse than useless; but pure cold-cream,
for a supply of which I have often had occasion to thank a friend, is
an excellent ameliorative.

After considerable labour we reached the ridge--a very glorious one
as regards the view--which forms the common boundary of the Rhone and
Trift glaciers.[15] Before us and behind us for many a mile fell the
dazzling _névés_, down to the points where the grey ice emerging from
its white coverlet declared the junction of snow-field and glacier. We
had plodded on for hours soddened by the solar heat and parched with
thirst. There was

[15] Seven years previously Mr. Huxley and myself had attempted to
reach this col from the other side.

    Water, water everywhere,
    But not a drop to drink;

for, when placed in the mouth, the liquefaction of the ice was so slow,
and the loss of heat from the surrounding tissues so painful, that
sucking it was worse than total abstinence. In the midst of this solid
water you might die of thirst. At some distance below the col, on the
Rhone side, the musical trickle of water made itself audible, and to
the rocks from which it fell we repaired, and refreshed ourselves.
The day was far spent, the region was wild and lonely, when, beset by
that feeling which has often caused me to wander singly in the Alps, I
broke away from my companions, and went rapidly down the glacier. Our
guide had previously informed me that before reaching the cascade of
the Rhone the ice was to be forsaken, and the Grimsel, our destination,
reached by skirting the base of the peak called Nägelis Grätli.
After descending the ice for some time I struck the bounding rocks,
and, climbing the mountain obliquely, found myself among the crags
which lie between the Grimsel pass and the Rhone glacier. It was an
exceedingly desolate place, and I soon had reason to doubt the wisdom
of being there alone. Still difficulty rouses powers of which we should
otherwise remain unconscious. The heat of the day had rendered me
weary, but among these rocks the weariness vanished, and I became clear
in mind and fresh in body through the knowledge that after nightfall
escape from this wilderness would be impossible.

I reached the watershed of the region, where I accepted the guidance of
a tiny stream. It received in its course various lateral tributaries,
and at one place expanded into a small blue lake bounded by banks of
snow. I kept along its side afterwards until, arching over a brow of
granite, it discharged itself down precipitous and glaciated rocks.
Here I learned that the stream was the feeder of the Grimsel lake. I
halted on the brow for some time. The hospice was in sight, but the
precipices between it and me seemed desperately forbidding. Nothing is
more trying to the climber than those cliffs which have been polished
by the ancient glaciers. Even at moderate inclinations, as may be
learned from an experiment on the Höllenplatte, or some other of the
polished rocks in Haslithal, they are not easy. I need hardly say that
the inclination of the rocks flanking the Grimsel is the reverse of
moderate. It is dangerously steep.

How to get down these smooth and precipitous tablets was now a problem
of the utmost interest to me; for the day was too far gone, and I was
too ignorant of the locality, to permit of time being spent in the
search of an easier place of descent. Right or left of me I saw none.
The continuity of the cliffs below me was occasionally broken by cracks
and narrow ledges, with scanty grass-tufts sprouting from them here
and there. The problem was to get down from crack to crack and from
ledge to ledge. A salutary anger warms the mind when thus challenged,
and, aided by this warmth, close scrutiny will dissolve difficulties
which timidity might render insuperable. Bit by bit I found myself
getting lower, closely examining at every pause the rocks below me.
The grass-tufts helped me for a time, but at length a slab was reached
where no friendly grass could grow. This slab was succeeded by others
equally forbidding. I looked upwards, thinking of retreat, but the
failing day urged me on. From the middle of the smooth surface jutted
a narrow ledge. Grasping the top of the rock, I let myself down as far
as my stretched arms would permit, and then let go my hold. I came
upon the ledge with an energy that alarmed me. A downward-pointing
crack with a streak of grass in it was next attained; it terminated in
a small, steep gulley, the portion of which within view was crossed
by three transverse ledges, and I judged that by friction the motion
down the groove could be so regulated as to enable me to come to rest
at each successive ledge. But the rush was unexpectedly rapid, and I
shot over the first ledge. Having some power in reserve, I tried to
clamp myself against the rock, but the second ledge was crossed like
the first. The wish to spare clothes or avoid abrasions of the skin
here vanished, and for dear life I grappled with the rock. Braces gave
way, clothes were rent, wrists and hands were skinned and bruised,
while hips and knees suffered variously. The motion however ended. I
was greatly heated, but immensely relieved otherwise. A little lower
down I discovered a singular cave in the mountain-side, with water
dripping from its roof into a well of crystal clearness. The ice-cold
liquid soon restored me to a normal temperature. I felt quite fresh on
entering the Grimsel inn, but a curious physiological effect manifested
itself when I had occasion to speak. The power of the brain over the
lips was so lowered that I could hardly make myself understood.




XVI.

_THE OBERAARJOCH._

ADVENTURE AT THE ÆGGISCHHORN.


My guide Bennen reached the Grimsel the following morning. Uncertain
of my own movements, I had permitted him this year to make a new
engagement, which he was now on his way to fulfil. As a mountaineer,
Bennen had no superior, and he added to his strength, courage, and
skill, the qualities of a natural gentleman. He was now ready to bear
us company over the Oberaarjoch to the Æggischhorn. On the morning
of the 22nd we bade the cheerless Grimsel inn good-bye, reached the
Unteraar glacier, crossed its load of uncomfortable moraine shingle,
and clambered up the slopes at the other side. Nestled aloft in a
higher valley was the Oberaar glacier, along the unruffled surface of
which our route lay.

The morning threatened, and fitful gleams of sunlight wandered over
the ice. The Joch was swathed in mist, which now and then gave way,
permitting a wild radiance to shoot over the top. On the windy summit
we took a mouthful of food and roped ourselves together. Here, as in
a hundred other places, I sought in the fog for the vesicles of De
Saussure, but failed to find them. Bennen, as long as we were on the
Berne side of the col, permitted Jaun to take the lead; but now we
looked into Wallis, or rather into the fog which filled it, and he, as
Wallis guide, came to the front. I knew the Viesch glacier well, but
how Bennen meant to unravel its difficulties without landmarks I knew
not. I asked him whether, if the fog continued, he could make his way
down the glacier. There was a pleasant _timbre_ in Bennen’s voice, a
light and depth in his smile, due to the blending together of conscious
strength and warm affection. With this smile he turned round and said,
‘Herr, ich bin hier zu Hause. Der Viescher Gletscher ist meine Heimath.’

Downwards we went, striking the rocks of the Rothhorn so as to avoid
the riven ice. Suddenly we passed from dense fog into clear air: we had
crossed ‘the cloud-plane,’ and found a transparent atmosphere between
it and the glacier. The dense covering above us was sometimes torn
asunder by the wind, which whirled the detached cloud-tufts round the
peaks. Contending air-currents were thus revealed, and thunder, which
is the common associate, if not the product, of such contention, began
to rattle among the crags. At first the snow upon the glacier was
sufficiently heavy to bridge the crevasses, thus permitting of rapid
motion; but by degrees the fissures opened, and at length drove us to
the rocks. These in their turn became impracticable. Dropping down a
waterfall well known to the climbers of this region, we came again upon
the ice, which was here cut by complex chasms. These we unravelled as
long as necessary, and finally escaped from them to the mountain-side.
The first big drops of a thunder-shower were already falling when we
reached an overhanging crag which gave us shelter. We quitted it too
soon, beguiled by a treacherous gleam of blue, and were thoroughly
drenched before we reached the Æggischhorn.

This was my last excursion with Bennen. In the month of February of
the following year he was killed by an avalanche on the Haut de Cry, a
mountain near Sion.[16]

[16] Bennen’s death is described in Chapter XVIII. A liberal collection
was made in England for his mother and sisters; and Mr. Hawkins, Mr.
Tuckett, and myself had a small monument erected to his memory in Ernan
churchyard. The supervision of the work was entrusted to a clerical
friend of Bennen’s, who made but a poor use of his trust.

Having work to execute, I remained at the Æggischhorn for nearly a
month in 1863. My favourite place for rest and writing was a point on
the mountain-side about an hour westwards from the hotel, where the
mighty group of the Mischabel, the Matterhorn, and the Weisshorn were
in full view. One day I remained in this position longer than usual,
held by the fascination of the setting sun. The mountains had stood
out nobly clear during the entire day, but towards evening, upon the
Dom, a singular cloud settled, which was finally drawn into a long
streamer by the wind. Nothing can be finer than the effect of the red
light of sunset on those streamers of cloud. Incessantly dissipated,
but ever renewed, they glow with the intensity of flames. By-and-by the
banner broke, resembling in its action that of a liquid cylinder when
unduly stretched, forming a series of crimson cloud-balls which were
united by slender filaments of fire. I waited for this glory to fade
into a deadly pallor before I thought of returning to the hotel.

On arriving there I found discussed with eager interest the fate of
two ladies and a gentleman, who had quitted the hotel in the morning
without a guide, and who were now, it was said, lost on the mountain.
‘I recommended them,’ said Herr Wellig, the landlord, ‘to take a guide,
but they would not heed me.’ I asked him what force he had at hand.
Three active young fellows came immediately forward. Two of them I
sent across the mountain by the usual route to the Märjelin See, and
the third I took with myself along the watercourse of the Æggischhorn.
After some walking we dipped into a little dell, where the glucking of
cowbells announced the existence of chalets. The party had been seen
passing there in the morning, but not returning. The embankment of
the watercourse fell at some places vertically for twenty or thirty
feet. Here I thought an awkward slip might have occurred, and, to meet
the possibility of having to carry a wounded man, I took an additional
lithe young fellow from the chalet.

We shouted as we went along, but the echoes were our only response. Our
pace was rapid, and in the dubious light false steps were frequent.
We all at intervals mistook the grey water for the grey and narrow
track beside it, and stepped into the stream. We proposed ascending
to the chalets of Märjelin, but previous to quitting the watercourse
we halted, and, directing our voices down hill, shouted a last shout.
And faintly up the mountain came a sound which could not be an echo.
We all heard it, though it could hardly be detached from the murmur of
the adjacent stream. We went rapidly down the Alp, and after a little
time shouted again. More audible than before, but still very faint,
came the answer from below. We continued at a headlong pace, and soon
assured ourselves that the sound was not only that of a human voice,
but of an English voice. Thus stimulated, we swerved to the left, and,
regardless of a wetting, dashed through the torrent which tumbles from
the Märjelin See. Close to the Viesch glacier we found the objects of
our search--the two ladies, tired out, seated upon the threshold of a
forsaken chalet, and the gentleman seated on a rock beside them.

He was both an experienced climber and a brave man, but he had started
with a sprained ankle, and every visitor knows how bewildering the
spurs of the Æggischhorn are, even to those whose tendons are sound.
Thus weakened, he was overtaken by the night, lost his way, and, in
his efforts to extricate himself, had experienced one or two serious
tumbles. Finally, giving up the attempt, he had resigned himself to
spending the night where we found him. The ladies were quite tired
out, and to reach the Æggischhorn that night was out of the question.
I tried the chalet door and found it locked, but an ice-axe soon hewed
the bolt away, and forced an entrance. There was some pinewood within,
and some old hay, which, under the circumstances, formed a delicious
couch for the ladies. In a few minutes a fire was blazing and crackling
in the chimney corner. Having thus secured them, I returned to the
chalets first passed, sent them bread, butter, cheese, and milk, and
had the lively gratification of seeing them return safe and sound to
the hotel next morning.




XVII.

_ASCENT OF THE JUNGFRAU._


I had spent nearly a fortnight at the Æggischhorn in 1863, employing
alternate days in wandering and musing over the green Alps, and in more
vigorous action upon the Aletsch glacier. Day after day a blue sky
spanned the earth, and night after night the stars glanced down from an
unclouded heaven. There is no nobler mountain group in Switzerland than
that seen on a fine day from the middle of the Aletsch glacier looking
southwards; while to the north, and more close at hand, rise the
Jungfrau and other summits familiar to every tourist who has crossed
the Wengern Alp. The love of being alone amid those scenes caused me,
on the 3rd of August, to withdraw from all society, and ascend the
glacier, which for nearly two hours was almost as even as a highway,
no local danger calling away the attention from the near and distant
mountains. The ice yielded to the sun, rills were formed, which united
to rivulets, and these again coalesced to rapid brooks, which ran with
a pleasant music through deep channels cut in the ice. Sooner or later
these brooks were crossed by cracks; into these cracks the water fell,
scooping gradually out for itself a vertical shaft, the resonance of
which raised the sound of the falling water to the dignity of thunder.
These shafts constitute the so-called moulins of the glacier, examples
of which are shown upon the Mer de Glace to every tourist who visits
the Jardin from Chamouni. The moulins can only form where the glacier
is not much riven, as here alone the rivulets can acquire the requisite
volume to produce a moulin.

After two hours’ ascent, the ice began to wear a more hostile aspect,
and long stripes of last year’s snow drawn over the sullied surface
marked the lines of crevasses now partially filled and bridged over.
For a time this snow was consolidated, and I crossed numbers of the
chasms, sounding in each case before trusting myself to its tenacity.
But as I ascended, the width and depth of the fissures increased,
and the fragility of the snow-bridges became more conspicuous. The
crevasses yawned here and there with threatening gloom, while along
their fringes the crystallising power of water played the most
fantastic freaks. Long lines of icicles dipped into the darkness, and
at some places the liquefied snow had refrozen into clusters of plates,
ribbed and serrated like the leaves of ferns. The cases in which
the snow covering of the crevasses, when tested by the axe, yielded,
became gradually more numerous, demanding commensurate caution. It is
impossible to feel otherwise than earnest in such scenes as this, with
the noblest and most beautiful objects in nature around one, with the
sense of danger raising the feelings at times to the level of awe.

My way upwards became more and more difficult, and circuit after
circuit had to be made to round the gaping fissures. There is a passive
cruelty in the aspect of these chasms sufficient to make the blood run
cold. Among them it is not good for man to be alone, so I halted in
the midst of them and swerved back towards the Faulberg. But instead
of it I struck the lateral tributary of the Aletsch, which runs up to
the Grünhorn Lücke. In this passage I was more than once entangled in a
mesh of fissures, but it is marvellous what steady, cool scrutiny can
accomplish upon the ice, and how often difficulties of apparently the
gravest kind may be reduced to a simple form by skilful examination.
I tried to get along the rocks to the Faulberg, but after investing
half an hour in the attempt I thought it prudent to retreat. I finally
reached the Faulberg by the glacier, and with great comfort consumed my
bread and cheese and emptied my goblet in the shadow of its caves. On
this day it was my desire to get near the buttresses of the Jungfrau,
and to see what prospect of success a lonely climber would have in an
attempt upon the mountain. Such an attempt might doubtless be made, but
at a risk which no sane man would willingly incur.

On August 6, however, I had the pleasure of joining Dr. Hornby and Mr.
Philpotts, who, with Christian Almer and Christian Lauener for their
guides, wished to ascend the Jungfrau. We quitted the Æggischhorn at
2.15 P.M., and in less than four hours reached the grottoes of the
Faulberg. A pine fire was soon blazing, a pan of water soon bubbling
sociably over the flame, and the evening meal was quickly prepared
and disposed of. For a time the air behind the Jungfrau and Monk
was exceedingly dark and threatening; rain was streaming down upon
Lauterbrunnen, and the skirt of the storm wrapped the summits of the
Jungfrau and the Monk. Southward, however, the sky was clear, and there
were such general evidences of hope that we were not much disheartened
by the local burst of ill-temper displayed by the atmosphere to the
north of us. Like a gust of passion the clouds cleared away, and
before we went to rest all was sensibly clear. Still the air was not
transparent, and for a time the stars twinkled through it with a feeble
ray. There was no visible turbidity, but a something which cut off
half the stellar brilliancy. The starlight, however, became gradually
stronger, not on account of the augmenting darkness, but because the
air became clarified as the night advanced.

Two of our party occupied the upper cave, and the guides took
possession of the kitchen, while a third lay in the little grot below.
Hips and ribs felt throughout the night the pressure of the subjacent
rock. A single blanket, moreover, though sufficient to keep out the
pain of cold, was insufficient to induce the comfort of warmth; so I
lay awake in a neutral condition, neither happy nor unhappy, watching
the stars without emotion as they appeared in succession above the
mountain-heads.

At half-past 12 a rumbling in the kitchen showed the guides to be
alert, and soon afterwards Christian Almer announced that tea was
prepared. We rose, consumed a crust and basin each, and at 1.15 A.M.,
being perfectly harnessed, we dropped down upon the glacier. The
crescent moon was in the sky, but for a long time we had to walk in
the shadow of the mountains, and therefore required illumination. The
bottoms were knocked out of two empty bottles, and each of these,
inverted, formed a kind of lantern which protected from the wind a
candle stuck in the neck. Almer went first, holding his lantern in his
left hand and his axe in the right, moving cautiously along the snow
which, as the residue of the spring avalanches, fringed the glacier.
At times, for no apparent reason, the leader paused and struck his
ice-axe into the snow. Looking right or left, a chasm was always
discovered in these cases, and the cautious guide sounded the snow,
lest the fissure should have prolonged itself underneath so as to cross
our track. A tributary glacier joined the Aletsch from our right--a
long corridor filled with ice, and covered by the purest snow. Down
this valley the moonlight streamed, silvering the surface upon which it
fell.

Here we cast our lamps away, and roped ourselves together. To our left
a second long ice-corridor stretched up to the Lötsch saddle, which
hung like a chain between the opposing mountains. In fact, at this
point four noble ice-streams form a junction, and flow afterwards in
the common channel of the Great Aletsch glacier. Perfect stillness
might have been expected to reign upon the ice, but even at that early
hour the gurgle of subglacial water made itself heard, and we had to
be cautious in some places lest a too thin crust might let us in. We
went straight up the glacier, towards the col which links the Monk
and Jungfrau together. The surface was hard, and we went rapidly and
silently over the snow. There is an earnestness of feeling on such
occasions which subdues the desire for conversation. The communion we
held was with the solemn mountains and their background of dark blue
sky.

‘Der Tag bricht!’ exclaimed one of the men. I looked towards the
eastern heaven, but could discover no illumination which hinted at the
approach of day. At length the dawn really appeared, brightening the
blue of the eastern firmament; at first it was a mere augmentation of
cold light, but by degrees it assumed a warmer tint. The long uniform
incline of the glacier being passed, we reached the first eminences of
snow which heave like waves around the base of the Jungfrau. This is
the region of beauty in the higher Alps--beauty pure and tender, out of
which emerges the savage scenery of the peaks. For the healthy and the
pure in heart these higher snow-fields are consecrated ground.

The snow bosses were soon broken by chasms deep and dark, which
required tortuous winding on our part to get round them. Having
surmounted a steep slope, we passed to some red and rotten rocks, which
required care on the part of those in front to prevent the loose and
slippery shingle from falling upon those behind. We gained the ridge
and wound along it. High snow eminences now flanked us to the left,
and along the slope over which we passed the _séracs_ had shaken their
frozen boulders. We tramped amid the knolls of the fallen avalanches
towards a white wall which, so far as we could see, barred further
progress. To our right were noble chasms, blue and profound, torn into
the heart of the _névé_ by the slow but resistless drag of gravity on
the descending snows. Meanwhile the dawn had brightened into perfect
day, and over mountains and glaciers the gold and purple light of the
eastern heaven was liberally poured. We had already caught sight of the
peak of the Jungfrau, rising behind an eminence and piercing for fifty
feet or so the rosy dawn. And many another peak of stately altitude
caught the blush, while the shaded slopes were all of a beautiful
azure, being illuminated by the firmament alone. A large segment
of space enclosed between the Monk and Trugberg was filled like a
reservoir with purple light. The world, in fact, seemed to worship, and
the flush of adoration was on every mountain-head.

Over the distant Italian Alps rose clouds of the most fantastic forms,
jutting forth into the heavens like enormous trees, thrusting out
umbrageous branches which bloomed and glistened in the solar rays.
Along the whole southern heaven these fantastic masses were ranged
close together, but still perfectly isolated, until on reaching a
certain altitude they seemed to meet a region of wind which blew their
tops like streamers far away through the air. Warmed and tinted by
the morning sun those unsubstantial masses rivalled in grandeur the
mountains themselves.

The final peak of the Jungfrau is now before us, and apparently _so_
near! But the mountaineer alone knows how delusive the impression of
nearness often is in the Alps. To reach the slope which led up to the
peak we must scale or round the barrier already spoken of. From the
coping and the ledges of this beautiful wall hung long stalactites
of ice, in some cases like inverted spears, with their sharp points
free in air. In other cases, the icicles which descended from the
overhanging top reached a projecting lower ledge, and stretched like a
crystal railing from the one to the other. To the right of this barrier
was a narrow gangway, from which the snow had not yet broken away so as
to form a vertical or overhanging wall. It was one of those accidents
which the mountains seldom fail to furnish, and on the existence of
which the success of the climber entirely depends. Up this steep and
narrow gangway we cut our steps, and a few minutes placed us safely at
the bottom of the final pyramid of the Jungfrau.

From this point we could look down into the abyss of the Roththal,
and certainly its wild environs seemed to justify the uses to which
superstition has assigned the place. For here it is said the original
demons of the mountains hold their orgies, and hither the spirits of
the doubly-damned among men are sent to bear them company. The slope
up which we had now to climb was turned towards the sun; its aspect
was a southern one, and its snows had been melted and recongealed to
hard ice. The axe of Almer rung against the obdurate solid, and its
fragments whirred past us with a weird-like sound to the abysses below.
They suggested the fate which a false step might bring along with it.
It is a practical tribute to the strength and skill of the Oberland
guides that no disaster has hitherto occurred upon the peak of the
Jungfrau.

The work upon this final ice-slope was long and heavy, and during this
time the summit appeared to maintain its distance above us. We at
length cleared the ice, and gained a stretch of snow which enabled us
to treble our upward speed. Thence to some loose and shingly rocks,
again to the snow, whence a sharp edge led directly up to the top. The
exhilaration of success was here added to that derived from physical
nature. On the top fluttered a little black flag, planted by our most
recent predecessors. We reached it at 7.15 A.M., having accomplished
the ascent from the Faulberg in six hours. The snow was flattened on
either side of the apex so as to enable us all to stand upon it, and
here we stood for some time, with all the magnificence of the Alps
unrolled before us.

We may look upon those mountains again and again from a dozen different
points of view, a perennial glory surrounds them which associates
with every new prospect fresh impressions. I thought I had scarcely
ever seen the Alps to greater advantage. Hardly ever was their majesty
more fully revealed or more overpowering. The colouring of the air
contributed as much to the effect as the grandeur of the masses on
which that colouring fell. A calm splendour overspread the mountains,
softening the harshness of the outlines without detracting from their
strength. But half the interest of such scenes is psychological; the
soul takes the tint of surrounding nature, and in its turn becomes
majestic.

And as I looked over this wondrous scene towards Mont Blanc, the Grand
Combin, the Dent Blanche, the Weisshorn, the Dom, and the thousand
lesser peaks which seemed to join in celebration of the risen day, I
asked myself, as on previous occasions: How was this colossal work
performed? Who chiselled these mighty and picturesque masses out of
a mere protuberance of the earth? And the answer was at hand. Ever
young, ever mighty--with the vigour of a thousand worlds still within
him--the real sculptor was even then climbing up the eastern sky. It
was he who raised aloft the waters which cut out these ravines; it was
he who planted the glaciers on the mountain-slopes, thus giving gravity
a plough to open out the valleys; and it is he who, acting through
the ages, will finally lay low these mighty monuments, rolling them
gradually seaward--

    Sowing the seeds of continents to be;

so that the people of an older earth may see mould spread and corn
wave over the hidden rocks which at this moment bear the weight of the
Jungfrau.[17]

[17] Eight years ago I was evidently a sun-worshipper; nor have I
yet lost the conviction of his ability to do all here ascribed to
him.--J.T., 1871.




XVIII.

_DEATH OF BENNEN ON THE HAUT DE CRY._

By PHILIP C. GOSSETT.

    [On a March morning in 1864 I was returning to town from
    Chislehurst, when my attention was directed to an account of an
    Alpine disaster published in that day’s ‘Times.’ No names were
    mentioned, and I commented rather severely on the rashness of
    trusting to mountain-snow so early in the year. On the following
    day I learned that my brave Bennen was one of the victims. Mr.
    P. C. Gossett wrote for the ‘Alpine Journal’ a ‘Narrative of the
    Accident,’ which, through the obliging kindness of the author, I am
    enabled to publish here. Mr. Gossett was accompanied by his friend
    M. Boissonnet on the fatal day.]


On February 28, 1864, we left Sion with Bennen to mount the Haut de
Cry. We started at 2.15 A.M. in a light carriage that brought us to
the village of Ardon, distant six miles. We there met three men that
were to accompany us as local guides and porters--Jean Joseph Nance,
Frederic Rebot, who acted as my personal guide, and Auguste Bevard.
We at once began to ascend on the right bank of the Lyzerne. The night
was splendid, the sky cloudless, and the moon shining brightly. For
about half an hour we went up through the vineyards by a rather steep
path, and then entered the valley of the Lyzerne, about 700 feet above
the torrent. We here found a remarkably good path, gradually rising
and leading towards the Col de Chéville. Having followed this path for
about three hours, we struck off to the left, and began zigzagging up
the mountain-side through a pine forest. We had passed what may be
called the snow-line in winter a little above 2,000 feet. We had not
ascended for more than a quarter of an hour in this pine forest before
the snow got very deep and very soft. We had to change leader every
five or six minutes, and even thus our progress was remarkably slow. We
saw clearly that, should the snow be as soft above the fir region, we
should have to give up the ascent. At 7 A.M. we reached a chalet, and
stopped for about twenty minutes to rest and look at the sunrise on the
Diablerets. On observing an aneroid, which we had brought with us, we
found that we were at the height of about 7,000 feet: the temperature
was -1° C.

The Haut de Cry has four _arêtes_, the first running towards the W.,
the second SE., the third E., and the fourth NE. We were between the
two last-named _arêtes_. Our plan was to go up between them to the
foot of the peak, and mount it by the _arête_ running NE. As we had
expected, the snow was in much better state when once we were above
the woods. For some time we advanced pretty rapidly. The peak was
glistening before us, and the idea of success put us in high spirits.
Our good fortune did not last long; we soon came to snow frozen on the
surface, and capable of bearing for a few steps and then giving way.
But this was nothing compared to the trouble of pulling up through
the pine wood, so instead of making us grumble it only excited our
hilarity. Bennen was in a particularly good humour, and laughed aloud
at our combined efforts to get out of the holes we every now and then
made in the snow. Judging from appearances, the snow-field over which
we were walking covered a gradually rising Alp. We made a second
observation with our aneroid, and found, rather to our astonishment and
dismay, that we had only risen 1,000 feet in the last three hours. It
was 10 o’clock: we were at the height of about 8,000 feet; temperature
= -1.5 C. During the last half-hour we had found a little hard snow,
so we had all hope of success. Thinking we might advance better on
the _arête_, we took to it, and rose along it for some time. It soon
became cut up by rocks, so we took to the snow again. It turned out
to be here hard frozen, so that we reached the real foot of the peak
without the slightest difficulty. It was steeper than I had expected
it would be, judging from the valley of the Rhone. Bennen looked at it
with decided pleasure; having completed his survey, he proposed to take
the eastern _arête_, as in doing so we should gain at least two hours.
Rebot had been over this last-named _arête_ in summer, and was of
Bennen’s opinion. Two or three of the party did not like the idea much,
so there was a discussion on the probable advantages and disadvantages
of the NE. and E. _arêtes_. We were losing time; so Bennen cut matters
short by saying: ‘Ich will der Erste über die arête!’ Thus saying, he
made for the E. _arête_; it looked very narrow, and, what was worse,
it was considerably cut up by high rocks, the intervals between the
teeth of the _arête_ being filled up with snow. To gain this _arête_,
we had to go up a steep snow-field, about 800 feet high, as well as
I remember. It was about 150 feet broad at the top, and 400 or 500
at the bottom. It was a sort of couloir on a large scale. During the
ascent we sank about one foot deep at every step. Bennen did not seem
to like the look of the snow very much. He asked the local guides
whether avalanches ever came down this couloir, to which they answered
that our position was perfectly safe. We had mounted on the northern
side of the couloir, and having arrived at 150 feet from the top, we
began crossing it on a horizontal curve, so as to gain the E. _arête_.
The inflexion or dip of the couloir was slight, not above 25 feet, the
inclination near 35°. We were walking in the following order: Bevard,
Nance, Bennen, myself, Boissonnet, and Rebot. Having crossed over
about three-quarters of the breadth of the couloir, the two leading
men suddenly sank considerably above their waists. Bennen tightened
the rope. The snow was too deep to think of getting out of the hole
they had made, so they advanced one or two steps, dividing the snow
with their bodies. Bennen turned round and told us he was afraid of
starting an avalanche; we asked whether it would not be better to
return and cross the couloir higher up. To this the three Ardon men
opposed themselves; they mistook the proposed precaution for fear, and
the two leading men continued their work. After three or four steps
gained in the aforesaid manner, the snow became hard again. Bennen
had not moved--he was evidently undecided what he should do; as soon,
however, as he saw hard snow again, he advanced and crossed parallel
to, but above, the furrow the Ardon men had made. Strange to say, the
snow supported him. While he was passing I observed that the leader,
Bevard, had about twenty feet of rope coiled round his shoulder. I
of course at once told him to uncoil it and get on the _arête_, from
which he was not more than fifteen feet distant. Bennen then told
me to follow. I tried his steps, but sank up to my waist in the very
first. So I went through the furrows, holding my elbows close to my
body, so as not to touch the sides. This furrow was about twelve feet
long, and, as the snow was good on the other side, we had all come
to the false conclusion that the snow was accidentally softer there
than elsewhere. Boissonet then advanced; he had made but a few steps
when we heard a deep, cutting sound. The snow-field split in two about
fourteen or fifteen feet above us. The cleft was at first quite narrow,
not more than an inch broad. An awful silence ensued; it lasted but a
few seconds, and then it was broken by Bennen’s voice, ‘Wir sind alle
verloren.’ His words were slow and solemn, and those who knew him felt
what they really meant when spoken by such a man as Bennen. They were
his last words. I drove my alpenstock into the snow, and brought the
weight of my body to bear on it; it went in to within three inches of
the top. I then waited. It was an awful moment of suspense. I turned
my head towards Bennen to see whether he had done the same thing. To
my astonishment, I saw him turn round, face the valley, and stretch
out both arms. The ground on which we stood began to move slowly, and
I felt the utter uselessness of any alpenstock. I soon sank up to
my shoulders and began descending backwards. From this moment I saw
nothing of what had happened to the rest of the party. With a good deal
of trouble I succeeded in turning round. The speed of the avalanche
increased rapidly, and before long I was covered up with snow and in
utter darkness. I was suffocating, when with a jerk I suddenly came
to the surface again. The rope had caught most probably on a rock,
and this was evidently the moment when it broke. I was on a wave of
the avalanche, and saw it before me as I was carried down. It was
the most awful sight I ever witnessed. The head of the avalanche was
already at the spot where we had made our last halt. The head alone
was preceded by a thick cloud of snow-dust; the rest of the avalanche
was clear. Around me I heard the horrid hissing of the snow, and far
before me the thundering of the foremost part of the avalanche. To
prevent myself sinking again, I made use of my arms much in the same
way as when swimming in a standing position. At last I noticed that I
was moving slower; then I saw the pieces of snow in front of me stop at
some yards’ distance; then the snow straight before me stopped, and I
heard on a large scale the same creaking sound that is produced when a
heavy cart passes over hard-frozen snow in winter. I felt that I also
had stopped, and instantly threw up both arms to protect my head in
case I should again be covered up. I had stopped, but the snow behind
me was still in motion; its pressure on my body was so strong that I
thought I should be crushed to death. This tremendous pressure lasted
but a short time, and ceased as suddenly as it had begun. I was then
covered up by snow coming from behind me. My first impulse was to try
and uncover my head--but this I could not do: the avalanche had frozen
by pressure the moment it stopped, and I was frozen in. Whilst trying
vainly to move my arms, I suddenly became aware that the hands as
far as the wrist had the faculty of motion. The conclusion was easy,
they must be above the snow. I set to work as well as I could; it was
time, for I could not have held out much longer. At last I saw a faint
glimmer of light. The crust above my head was getting thinner, and
it let a little air pass, but I could not reach it any more with my
hands; the idea struck me that I might pierce it with my breath. After
several efforts I succeeded in doing so, and felt suddenly a rush of
air towards my mouth; I saw the sky again through a little round hole.
A dead silence reigned around me; I was so surprised to be still alive,
and so persuaded at the first moment that none of my fellow-sufferers
had survived, that I did not even think of shouting for them. I then
made vain efforts to extricate my arms, but found it impossible; the
most I could do was to join the ends of my fingers, but they could not
reach the snow any longer. After a few minutes I heard a man shouting:
what a relief it was to know that I was not the sole survivor! to know
that perhaps he was not frozen in and could come to my assistance! I
answered; the voice approached, but seemed uncertain where to go, and
yet it was now quite near. A sudden exclamation of surprise! Rebot
had seen my hands. He cleared my head in an instant, and was about to
try and cut me out completely, when I saw a foot above the snow, and
so near to me that I could touch it with my arms, although they were
not quite free yet. I at once tried to move the foot; it was my poor
friend’s. A pang of agony shot through me as I saw that the foot did
not move. Poor Boissonnet had lost sensation, and was perhaps already
dead. Rebot did his best: after some time he wished me to help him,
so he freed my arms a little more, so that I could make use of them.
I could do but little, for Rebot had torn the axe from my shoulder as
soon as he had cleared my head (I generally carry an axe separate from
my alpenstock--the blade tied to the belt, and the handle attached to
the left shoulder). Before coming to me Rebot had helped Nance out of
the snow; he was lying nearly horizontally, and was not much covered
over. Nance found Bevard, who was upright in the snow, but covered up
to the head. After about twenty minutes the two last-named guides came
up. I was at length taken out; the snow had to be cut with the axe down
to my feet before I could be pulled out. A few minutes after 1 o’clock
P.M. we came to my poor friend’s face.... I wished the body to be taken
out completely, but nothing could induce the three guides to work any
longer, from the moment they saw that it was too late to save him. I
acknowledge that they were nearly as incapable of doing anything as I
was. When I was taken out of the snow the cord had to be cut. We tried
the end going towards Bennen, but could not move it; it went nearly
straight down and showed us that there was the grave of the bravest
guide the Valais ever had, and ever will have. The cold had done its
work on us; we could stand it no longer, and began the descent. We
followed the frozen avalanche for about twenty-five minutes, that being
the easiest way of progressing, and then took the track we had made in
the morning; in five hours we reached Ardon.

[Illustration: JOHANN JOSEPH BENNEN.]

I have purposely put apart the details I have been asked to give on
certain points.

1. The avalanche consisted only of snow; the upper stratum was eleven
days old. At the moment the avalanche started it was about twelve
o’clock, probably a few minutes before. The temperature was then above
freezing point, and we were within 300 or 350 feet from the summit.
The snow was thawing, and the whole snow-field in a state of uncertain
equilibrium. By cutting through the snow at the top of the couloir
we cut one of the main points by which the snow of the two different
layers held together; what led us into the error was, as I have before
said, the fact that the snow was quite hard in some places, and quite
soft in others. The avalanche may have taken a minute to descend; I can
give no correct estimation on this point. We fell between 1,900 and
1,960 feet, the head of the avalanche going 800 feet lower.

2. The rope was in my opinion the cause of my poor friend’s as well
as of Bennen’s death. The following facts may prove it: At the moment
the avalanche started the first and last guides merely held the rope;
Bennen had not seen the use of a rope at all, so we had been less
strict than we should otherwise have been in its use. During the
descent the rope caught, probably on a rock below the surface. This
happened between Bennen and Nance, that is to say between the second
and third man in the marching line. Nance told me afterwards that this
was the worst part of the descent; he had the pressure of the snow
on his body, whilst the rope nearly cut him in two. I believe that
it was at this moment that Bennen and Boissonnet lost their upright
position, owing to the pressure of snow on their backs. Nance also lost
his position, but was fortunate in being thrown out horizontally, and
that almost on the surface of the avalanche. I was between Bennen and
Boissonnet, but not tied to the rope, as I had iron rings to my belt
through which the cord ran. Rebot, who was last in the line, was thrown
clean out of the avalanche; he was carried during the descent towards
one of the sides of the stream. He was the only one of us who escaped
unhurt. Thus, when we stopped in our descent, two only were _tied_ to
the rope--Boissonnet and Bennen--the very two who perished.

3. The congealing of the snow happened by pressure. The fore part
of the avalanche stopped first, and the rest was forced against it.
The circumstance I can least understand is the sudden fall in the
temperature of the air after the accident. I can give no estimate of
it, but it was intense.

4. The bruises Bevard, Nance, and I sustained were slight, but our feet
were severely frost-bitten. Bennen has been accused of rashness in this
unfortunate accident. It is not the case. He was misled by the total
difference of the state of snow in a winter ascent from what is to be
met with in summer.

I have been recently favoured with a letter from Mr. Gossett, from
which the following is an extract:

  ‘Berne: March 17, 1871.

    ‘Bennen’s body was found with great difficulty the third day after
    Boissonnet was found. The cord-end had been covered up with snow.
    The curé d’Ardon informed me that poor Bennen was found eight feet
    under the snow, in a horizontal position, the head facing the
    valley of the Lyzerne. His watch had been wrenched from the chain,
    probably when the cord broke; the chain, however, remained attached
    to his waistcoat. Three years ago I met one of my Ardon guides;
    he told me that Bennen’s watch had been found by a shepherd seven
    months after the accident. This shepherd had been one of the party
    who went up to look for Bennen; during the following summer he
    had watched the melting of the avalanche. When mounted, the watch
    obeyed. This reminds me of your fall on the Morteratsch glacier.[18]

    [18] See Chapter XIX.

    ‘I know you were very much attached to Bennen; the same was the
    case with him in regard to you. An hour before his death the
    Matterhorn showed its black head over one of the _arêtes_ of the
    Haut de Cry. I asked Bennen whether he thought it would ever be
    ascended. His answer was a decided “Yes”; but he added, alluding
    to your last attack on the mountain, “Wir waren fünf; der Professor
    und ich stimmten für Vorwärts; die drei andern stimmten dagegen.”

    ‘There is one circumstance in reference to my fall with the
    avalanche of the Haut de Cry that I am utterly unable to
    understand: I mean what physical phenomena took place when the
    avalanche stopped and froze. It stopped because in its progress
    downwards the broad couloir down which it was going got narrower,
    and the mass of snow could not pass. It froze because the
    successive portions of the body of the avalanche became compressed
    against the head, which latter had come to a stop. When the layer
    in which I was stopped, the pressure on my body was enormous--so
    great, in fact, that I expected I should be crushed flat. This
    pressure ceased _suddenly_: I know it, for the atrocious pains
    it was causing ceased _suddenly_ too. What happened during that
    interval?’

[Bennen was well acquainted with winter snow, but no man of his temper,
and in his position, would place himself in direct opposition to local
guides, whose knowledge of the mountain must have been superior to his
own.]




XIX.

_ACCIDENT ON THE PIZ MORTERATSCH._


While staying at Pontresina in 1864 I joined Mr. Hutchinson, and Mr.
Lee-Warner, of Rugby, in a memorable expedition up the Piz Morteratsch.
This is a very noble mountain, and, as we thought, safe and easy to
ascend. The resolute Jenni, by far the boldest man in Pontresina, was
my guide; while Walter, the official _guide chef_, was taken by my
companions. With a dubious sky overhead, we started on the morning of
July 30, a little after four A.M. There is rarely much talk at the
beginning of a mountain excursion: you are either sleepy or solemn so
early in the day. Silently we passed through the pine woods of the
beautiful Rosegg valley, watching anxiously at intervals the play of
the clouds around the adjacent heights. At one place a spring gushed
from the valley-bottom, as clear and almost as copious as that which
pours out the full-formed river Albula. The traces of ancient glaciers
were present everywhere, the valley being thickly covered with the
rubbish which the ice had left behind. An ancient moraine, so large
that in England it might take rank as a mountain, forms a barrier
across the upper valley. Once probably it was the dam of a lake, but it
is now cut through by the river which rushes from the Rosegg glacier.
These works of the ancient ice are to the mind what a distant horizon
is to the eye. They give to the imagination both pleasure and repose.

The morning, as I have said, looked threatening, but the wind was
good; by degrees the cloud-scowl relaxed, and broader patches of blue
became visible above us. We called at the Rosegg chalets, and had
some milk. We afterwards wound round a shoulder of the hill, at times
upon the moraine of the glacier, and at times upon the adjacent grass
slope; then over shingly inclines, covered with the shot rubbish of the
heights. Two ways were now open to us, the one easy but circuitous,
the other stiff but short. Walter was for the former, and Jenni for
the latter, their respective choices being characteristic of the two
men. To my satisfaction Jenni prevailed, and we scaled the steep and
slippery rocks. At the top of them we found ourselves upon the rim of
an extended snow-field. Our rope was here exhibited, and we were bound
by it to a common destiny. In those higher regions the snow-fields
show a beauty and a purity of which persons who linger low down
have no notion. We crossed crevasses and bergschrunds, mounted vast
snow-basses, and doubled round walls of ice with long stalactites
pendent from their eaves. One by one the eminences were surmounted.
The crowning rock was attained at half-past twelve. On it we uncorked
a bottle of champagne; mixed with the pure snow of the mountain, it
formed a beverage, and was enjoyed with a gusto, which the sybarite of
the city could neither imitate nor share.

We spent about an hour upon the warm gneiss-blocks on the top. Veils
of cloud screened us at intervals from the sun, and then we felt the
keenness of the air; but in general we were cheered and comforted
by the solar light and warmth. The shiftings of the atmosphere were
wonderful. The white peaks were draped with opalescent clouds which
never lingered for two consecutive minutes in the same position. Clouds
differ widely from each other in point of beauty, but I had hardly seen
them more beautiful than they appeared to-day, while the succession of
surprises experienced through their changes were such as rarely fall to
the lot even of an experienced mountaineer.

These clouds are for the most part produced by the chilling of the
air through its own expansion. When thus chilled, the aqueous vapour
diffused through it, which is previously unseen, is precipitated in
visible particles. Every particle of the cloud has consumed in its
formation a little polyhedron of vapour, and a moment’s reflection will
make it clear that the size of the cloud-particles must depend, not
only on the size of the vapour polyhedron, but on the relation of the
density of the vapour to that of its liquid. If the vapour were light
and the liquid heavy, other things being equal, the cloud-particle
would be _smaller_ than if the vapour were heavy and the liquid light.
There would evidently be more _shrinkage_ in the one case than in the
other. Now there are various liquids whose weight is not greater than
that of water, while the weight of their vapours, bulk for bulk, is
five or six times that of aqueous vapour. When those heavy vapours
are precipitated as clouds, which is easily done artificially, their
particles are found to be far coarser than those of an aqueous cloud.
Indeed water is without a parallel in this particular. Its vapour is
the lightest of all vapours, and to this fact the soft and tender
beauty of the clouds of our atmosphere is mainly due.[19]

[19] Chapter V., p. 405, is devoted to ‘Clouds.’ See also note, p. 82.

After an hour’s halt upon the summit the descent began. Jenni is the
most daring man and powerful character among the guides of Pontresina.
The manner in which he bears down all the others in conversation,
and imposes his own will upon them, shows that he is the dictator of
the place. He is a large and rather an ugly man, and his progress up
hill, though resistless, is slow. He had repeatedly expressed a wish
to make an excursion with me, and on this occasion he may have desired
to show us what he could do upon the mountains. He accomplished two
daring things--the one successfully, while the other was within a
hair’s-breadth of a very shocking issue.

In descending we went straight down upon a bergschrund, which had
compelled us to make a circuit in coming up. This particular kind of
fissure is formed by the lower portion of a snow-slope falling away
from the upper, a crevasse being thus formed between both, which often
surrounds the mountain as a fosse of terrible depth. Walter was the
first of our party, and Jenni was the last. It was quite evident that
the leader hesitated to cross the chasm; but Jenni came forward, and
half by expostulation, half by command, caused him to sit down on the
snow at some height above the fissure. I think, moreover, he helped
him with a shove. At all events, the slope was so steep that the guide
shot down it with an impetus sufficient to carry him clear over the
schrund. We all afterwards shot the chasm in this pleasant way. Jenni
was behind. Deviating from our track, he deliberately chose the widest
part of the chasm, and shot over it, lumbering like behemoth down the
snow-slope at the other side. It was an illustration of that practical
knowledge which long residence among the mountains can alone impart,
and in the possession of which our best English climbers fall far
behind their guides.

The remaining steep slopes were also descended by glissade, and
we afterwards marched cheerily over the gentler inclines. We had
ascended by the Rosegg glacier, and now we wished to descend upon the
Morteratsch glacier and make it our highway home.

We reached the point at which it was necessary to quit our morning’s
track, and immediately afterwards got upon some steep rocks, rendered
slippery here and there by the water which trickled over them. To our
right was a broad couloir, filled with snow, which had been melted
and refrozen, so as to expose a steeply sloping wall of ice. We were
tied together in the following order: Jenni led, I came next, then Mr.
Hutchinson, a practised mountaineer, then Mr. Lee-Warner, and last of
all the guide Walter. Lee-Warner had had but little experience of the
higher Alps, and he was placed in front of Walter, so that any false
step on his part might be instantly checked.

After descending the rocks for a time Jenni turned and asked
me whether I thought them or the ice-slope the better track. I
pronounced without hesitation in favour of the rocks, but he seemed
to misunderstand me, and turned towards the couloir. I stopped him at
the edge of it, and said, ‘Jenni, you know where you are going; the
slope is pure ice.’ He replied, ‘I know it; but the ice is quite bare
for a few yards only. Across this exposed portion I will cut steps,
and then the snow which covers the ice will give us a footing.’ He cut
the steps, reached the snow, and descended carefully along it, all
following him, apparently in good order. After some time he stopped,
turned, and looked upwards at the last three men. ‘Keep carefully in
the steps, gentlemen,’ he said; ‘a false step here might detach an
avalanche.’ The word was scarcely uttered when I heard the sound of a
fall behind me, then a rush, and in a moment my two friends and their
guide, all apparently entangled together, whirred past me. I suddenly
planted myself to resist their shock, but in an instant I was in their
wake, for their impetus was irresistible. A moment afterwards Jenni
was whirled away, and thus, in the twinkling of an eye, all five of us
found ourselves riding downwards with uncontrollable speed on the back
of an avalanche which a single slip had originated.

Previous to stepping on the slope, I had, according to habit,
made clear to my mind what was to be done in case of mishap; and
accordingly, when overthrown, I turned promptly on my face and drove
my bâton through the moving snow, and into the ice underneath. No
time, however, was allowed for the break’s action; for I had held it
firmly thus for a few seconds only, when I came into collision with
some obstacle and was rudely tossed through the air, Jenni at the same
time being shot down upon me. Both of us here lost our bâtons. We had
been carried over a crevasse, had hit its lower edge, and, instead of
dropping into it, were pitched by our great velocity far beyond it.
I was quite bewildered for a moment, but immediately righted myself,
and could see the men in front of me half buried in the snow, and
jolted from side to side by the ruts among which we were passing.
Suddenly I saw them tumbled over by a lurch of the avalanche, and
immediately afterwards found myself imitating their motion. This was
caused by a second crevasse. Jenni knew of its existence and plunged,
he told me, right into it--a brave act, but for the time unavailing.
By jumping into the chasm he thought a strain might be put upon the
rope sufficient to check the motion. But, though over thirteen stone in
weight, he was violently jerked out of the fissure and almost squeezed
to death by the pressure of the rope.

A long slope was below us, which led directly downwards to a brow where
the glacier fell precipitously. At the base of the declivity the ice
was cut by a series of profound chasms, towards which we were rapidly
borne. The three foremost men rode upon the forehead of the avalanche,
and were at times almost wholly immersed in the snow; but the moving
layer was thinner behind, and Jenni rose incessantly and with desperate
energy drove his feet into the firmer substance underneath. His voice,
shouting ‘Halt! Herr Jesus, halt!’ was the only one heard during the
descent. A kind of condensed memory, such as that described by people
who have narrowly escaped drowning, took possession of me, and my power
of reasoning remained intact. I thought of Bennen on the Haut de Cry,
and muttered, ‘It is now my turn.’ Then I coolly scanned the men in
front of me, and reflected that, if their _vis viva_ was the only thing
to be neutralised, Jenni and myself could stop them; but to arrest both
them and the mass of snow in which they were caught was hopeless. I
experienced no intolerable dread. In fact, the start was too sudden and
the excitement of the rush too great to permit of the development of
terror.

Looking in advance, I noticed that the slope, for a short distance,
became less steep, and then fell as before. ‘Now or never we must be
brought to rest.’ The speed visibly slackened, and I thought we were
saved. But the momentum had been too great: the avalanche crossed the
brow and in part regained its motion. Here Hutchinson threw his arm
round his friend, all hope being extinguished, while I grasped my belt
and struggled to free myself. Finding this difficult, from the tossing,
I sullenly resumed the strain upon the rope. Destiny had so related
the downward impetus to Jenni’s pull as to give the latter a slight
advantage, and the whole question was whether the opposing force would
have sufficient time to act. This was also arranged in our favour,
for we came to rest so near the brow that two or three seconds of our
average motion of descent must have carried us over. Had this occurred,
we should have fallen into the chasms, and been covered up by the tail
of the avalanche. Hutchinson emerged from the snow with his forehead
bleeding, but the wound was superficial; Jenni had a bit of flesh
removed from his hand by collision against a stone; the pressure of the
rope had left black welts on my arms; and we all experienced a tingling
sensation over the hands, like that produced by incipient frostbite,
which continued for several days. This was all. I found a portion of my
watch-chain hanging round my neck, another portion in my pocket; the
watch was gone.

This happened on the 30th of July. Two days afterwards I went to Italy,
and remained there for ten or twelve days. On the 16th of August,
being again at Pontresina, I made on that day an expedition in search
of the lost watch. Both the guides and myself thought the sun’s heat
might melt the snow above it, and I inferred that if its back should
happen to be uppermost the slight absorbent power of gold for the solar
rays would prevent the watch from sinking as a stone sinks under like
circumstances. The watch would thus be brought quite to the surface;
and, although a small object, it might possibly be seen from some
distance. Five friends accompanied me up the Morteratsch glacier. One
of them was the late Mr. North, member for Hastings, a most lovable
man. He was then sixty-four years of age, but he exhibited a courage
and collectedness, and indeed a delight, in the wild savagery of the
crevasses which were perfectly admirable.

Two only of the party, both competent mountaineers, accompanied me
to the track of our glissade, but none of us ventured on the ice
where it originated. Just before stepping upon the snow, a stone some
tons in weight, detached by the sun from the heights above us, came
rushing down the line of our descent. Its leaps became more and more
impetuous, and on reaching the brow near which we had been brought to
rest it bounded through the air, and with a single spring reached the
lower glacier, raising a cloud of ice-dust. Some fragments of rope
found upon the snow assured us that we were upon the exact track of
the avalanche, and then the search commenced. It had not continued
twenty minutes when a cheer from one of the guides--Christian Michel of
Grindelwald--announced the discovery of the watch. It had been brought
to the surface in the manner surmised, and on examination seemed to
be dry and uninjured. I noticed, moreover, that the position of the
hands indicated that it had only run down beneath the snow. I wound it
up, hardly hoping, however, to find it capable of responding. But it
showed instant signs of animation. It had remained eighteen days in
the avalanche, but the application of its key at once restored it to
action, and it has gone with unvarying regularity ever since.

       *       *       *       *       *

Mr. Hutchinson has published the following note of the accident in the
‘Alpine Journal’:

‘As one of the party concerned in the accident on the Piz Morteratsch
last July, I trust I shall not be thought presumptuous in bearing my
testimony to the entire accuracy of Professor Tyndall’s account. I can
add no facts of any importance to those there mentioned, unless it be
that we estimated the distance down which we were carried at fully
1,000 feet--a conclusion which, Mr. Tyndall tells me, was confirmed by
his subsequent visit to the spot. The angle of the slope we did not
measure, nor can I give the time of our descent with any accuracy; it
seemed to me a lifetime. From the moment that the snow cracked, Jenni
behaved with the greatest coolness and courage. But he ought not to
have taken us down the ice-slope so late in the day--it was then nearly
half-past two o’clock--and that after a warning word from Professor
Tyndall and myself. Of Walter’s conduct the less said the better; our
opinion of his courage was not raised by this trial of it.’

       *       *       *       *       *

[Until Mr. Gossett’s letter reached me a few days ago I was not aware
of the singular likeness between the loss of Bennen’s watch and of my
own.--April 1871.]

[Illustration: THE GORGE OF PFEFFERS (SHOWING EROSIVE ACTION).]




XX.

_ALPINE SCULPTURE._


To the physical geologist the conformation of the Alps, and of
mountain-regions generally, constitutes one of the most interesting
problems of the present day. To account for this conformation, two
hypotheses have been advanced, which may be respectively named the
hypothesis of _fracture_ and the hypothesis of _erosion_. Those who
adopt the former maintain that the forces by which the Alps were
elevated produced fissures in the earth’s crust, and that the valleys
of the Alps are the tracks of these fissures. Those who hold the latter
hypothesis maintain that the valleys have been cut out by the action
of ice and water, the mountains themselves being the residual forms
of this grand sculpture. To the erosive action here indicated must be
added that due to the atmosphere (the severance and detachment of rocks
by rain and frost), as affecting the forms of the more exposed and
elevated peaks.

I had heard it stated that the Via Mala was a striking illustration of
the fissure theory--that the profound chasm thus named, and through
which the Hinter-Rhein now flows, could be nothing else than a crack
in the earth’s crust. To the Via Mala I therefore went in 1864 to
instruct myself by actual observation upon the point in question.

The gorge commences about a quarter of an hour above Tusis; and, on
entering it, the first conclusion is that it must be a fissure. This
conclusion in my case was modified as I advanced. Some distance up the
gorge I found upon the slopes to my right quantities of rolled stones,
evidently rounded by water-action. Still further up, and just before
reaching the first bridge which spans the chasm, I found more rolled
stones, associated with sand and gravel. Through this mass of detritus,
fortunately, a vertical cutting had been made, which exhibited a
section showing perfect stratification. There was no agency in the
place to roll these stones, and to deposit these alternating layers of
sand and pebbles, but the river which now rushes some hundreds of feet
below them. At one period of the Via Mala’s history the river must have
run at this high level. Other evidences of water-action soon revealed
themselves. From the parapet of the first bridge I could see the solid
rock 200 feet above the bed of the river scooped and eroded.

It is stated in the guide-books that the river, which usually runs
along the bottom of the gorge, has been known almost to fill it during
violent thunderstorms; and it may be urged that the marks of erosion
which the sides of the chasm exhibit are due to those occasional
floods. In reply to this, it may be stated that even the existence of
such floods is not well authenticated, and that if the supposition
were true, it would be an additional argument in favour of the cutting
power of the river. For if floods operating at rare intervals could
thus erode the rock, the same agency, acting without ceasing upon the
river’s bed, must certainly be competent to excavate it.

I proceeded upwards, and from a point near another bridge (which of
them I did not note) had a fine view of a portion of the gorge. The
river here runs at the bottom of a cleft of profound depth, but so
narrow that it might be leaped across. That this cleft must be a crack
is the impression first produced; but a brief inspection suffices to
prove that it has been cut by the river. From top to bottom we have
the unmistakable marks of erosion. This cleft was best seen by looking
downwards from a point near the bridge; but looking upwards from the
bridge itself, the evidence of aqueous erosion was equally convincing.

The character of the erosion depends upon the rock as well as upon the
river. The action of water upon some rocks is almost purely mechanical;
they are simply ground away or detached in sensible masses. In other
cases the action is chemical as well as mechanical. Water, in passing
over limestone, charges itself with carbonate of lime without damage to
its transparency; the rock is _dissolved_ in the water; and the gorges
cut by water in such rocks often resemble those cut in the ice of
glaciers by glacier streams. To the solubility of limestone is probably
to be ascribed the fantastic forms which peaks of this rock usually
assume, and also the grottos and caverns which interpenetrate limestone
formations. A rock capable of being thus dissolved will expose a smooth
surface after the water has quitted it; and in the case of the Via Mala
it is the polish of the surfaces, and also the curved hollows scooped
in the sides of the gorge, which assure us that the chasm has been the
work of the river.

About four miles from Tusis, and not far from the little village of
Zillis, the Via Mala opens into a plain bounded by high terraces,
evidently cut by water. It occurred to me the moment I saw it that
the plain had been the bed of an ancient lake; and a farmer, who was
my temporary companion, immediately informed me that such was the
tradition of the neighbourhood. This man conversed with intelligence,
and as I drew his attention to the rolled stones, which rest not only
above the river, but above the road, and inferred that the river must
have been there to have rolled those stones, he saw the force of the
evidence perfectly. In fact, in former times, and subsequent to the
retreat of the great glaciers, a rocky barrier crossed the valley at
this place, damming the river which came from the glaciers higher up.
A lake was thus formed which poured its waters over the barrier. Two
actions were here at work, both tending to obliterate the lake--the
raising of its bed by the deposition of detritus, and the cutting of
its dam by the river. In process of time the cut deepened into the
Via Mala; the lake was drained, and the river now flows in a definite
channel through the plain which its waters once totally covered.

From Tusis I crossed to Tiefenkasten by the Schien Pass, and thence
over the Julier Pass to Pontresina. There are three or four ancient
lake-beds between Tiefenkasten and the summit of the Julier. They are
all of the same type--a more or less broad and level valley-bottom,
with a barrier in front through which the river has cut a passage, the
drainage of the lake being the consequence. These lakes are sometimes
dammed by barriers of rock, sometimes by the moraines of ancient
glaciers.

An example of this latter kind occurs in the Rosegg valley, about
twenty minutes below the end of the Rosegg glacier, and about an hour
from Pontresina. The valley here is crossed by a pine-covered moraine
of the noblest dimensions: in the neighbourhood of London it might
be called a mountain. That it is a moraine, the inspection of it
from a point on the Surlei slopes above it will convince any person
possessing an educated eye. Where, moreover, the interior of the mound
is exposed, it exhibits moraine-matter--detritus pulverised by the
ice, with boulders entangled in it. It stretched quite across the
valley, and at one time dammed the river up. But now the barrier is
cut through, the stream having about one-fourth of the moraine to its
right, and the remaining three-fourths to its left. Other moraines of a
more resisting character hold their ground as barriers to the present
day. In the Val di Campo, for example, about three-quarters of an hour
from Pisciadello, there is a moraine composed of large boulders, which
interrupt the course of a river and compel the water to fall over them
in cascades. They have in great part resisted its action since the
retreat of the ancient glacier which formed the moraine. Behind the
moraine is a lake-bed, now converted into a meadow, which is quite
level, and rests on a deep layer of mould.

At Pontresina a very fine and instructive gorge is to be seen. The
river from the Morteratsch glacier rushes through a deep and narrow
chasm which is spanned at one place by a stone bridge. The rock is not
of a character to preserve smooth polishing; but the larger features of
water-action are perfectly evident from top to bottom. Those features
are in part visible from the bridge, but still better from a point a
little distance from the bridge in the direction of the upper village
of Pontresina. The hollowing out of the rock by the eddies of the water
is here quite manifest. A few minutes’ walk upwards brings us to the
end of the gorge; and behind it we have the usual indications of an
ancient lake, and terraces of distinct water origin.

From this position the genesis of the gorge is clearly revealed. After
the retreat of the ancient glacier, a transverse ridge of comparatively
resisting material crossed the valley at this place. Over the lowest
part of this ridge the river flowed, rushing steeply down to join
at the bottom of the slope the stream which issued from the Rosegg
glacier. On this incline the water became a powerful eroding agent, and
finally cut its channel to its present depth.

Geological writers of reputation assume at this place the existence
of a fissure, the ‘washing out’ of which resulted in the formation
of the gorge. Now no examination of the bed of the river ever proved
the existence of this fissure; and it is certain that water can cut
a channel through unfissured rock--that cases of deep cutting can be
pointed out where the clean bed of the stream is exposed, the rock
which forms the floor of the river not exhibiting a trace of fissure.
An example of this kind occurs near the Bernina Gasthaus, about two
hours from Pontresina. A little way below the junction of the two
streams from the Bernina Pass and the Heuthal the river flows through a
channel cut by itself, and 20 or 30 feet in depth. At some places the
river-bed is covered with rolled stones; at other places it is bare,
but shows no trace of fissure. The abstract power of water (if I may
use the term) to cut through rock is demonstrated by such instances.
But if water be competent to form a gorge without the aid of a fissure,
why assume the existence of such in cases like that at Pontresina?
It seems far more philosophical to accept the simple and impressive
history written on the walls of those gorges by the agent which
produced them.

Numerous cases might be pointed out, varying in magnitude, but all
identical in kind, of barriers which crossed valleys and formed
lakes having been cut through by rivers, narrow gorges being the
consequence. One of the most famous examples of this kind is the
Finsteraarschlucht in the valley of Hasli. Here the ridge called the
Kirchet seems split across, and the river Aar rushes through the
fissure. Behind the barrier we have the meadows and pastures of Imhof
resting on the sediment of an ancient lake. Were this an isolated
case, one might reasonably conclude that the Finsteraarschlucht was
produced by an earthquake, as some suppose it to have been; but when
we find it to be a single sample of actions which are frequent in the
Alps--when probably a hundred cases of the same kind, though different
in magnitude, can be pointed out--it seems quite unphilosophical to
assume that in each particular case an earthquake was at hand to form
a channel for the river. As in the case of the barrier at Pontresina,
the Kirchet, after the retreat of the Aar glacier, dammed the waters
flowing from it, thus forming a lake, on the bed of which now stands
the village of Imhof. Over this barrier the Aar tumbled towards
Meyringen, cutting, as the centuries passed, its bed ever deeper, until
finally it became deep enough to drain the lake, leaving in its place
the alluvial plain, through which the river now flows in a definite
channel.[20]

[20] For further observations see p. 256.

But the broad view taken by the advocates of the fracture theory is,
that the valleys are the tracks of primeval fissures produced by the
upheaval of the land, and the cracks across the barriers to which I
have referred are in reality portions of the great cracks which formed
the valleys. Such an argument, however, would virtually concede the
theory of erosion as applied to the _valleys_ of the Alps. The narrow
gorges, often not more than twenty or thirty feet across, sometimes
even narrower, frequently occur at the bottom of broad valleys. Such
fissures might enter into the list of accidents which gave direction to
the real erosive agents which scooped the valley out; but the formation
of the valley, as it now exists, could no more be ascribed to it than
the motion of a railway train could be ascribed to the finger of the
engineer which turns on the steam.

These deep gorges occur, I believe, for the most part in limestone
strata; and the effects which the merest driblet of water can produce
on such rocks are quite astonishing. It is not uncommon to meet chasms
of considerable depth produced by small streams the beds of which are
dry for a large portion of the year. Right and left of the larger
gorges such secondary chasms are usually to be found. The idea of
_time_ must, I think, be more and more included in our reasonings on
these phenomena. Happily, the marks which the rivers have, in most
cases, left behind them, and which refer, geologically considered, to
actions of yesterday, give us ground and courage to conceive what may
be effected in geologic periods. Thus the modern portion of the Via
Mala throws light upon the whole. Near Bergün, in the valley of the
Albula, there is also a little Via Mala, which is not less significant
than the great one. The river flows here through a profound limestone
gorge; but to the very edges of the gorge we have the evidences of
erosion. The most striking illustration of water-action upon limestone
rock which I have ever witnessed is, I think, furnished by the gorge at
Pfäffers. Here the traveller passes along the side of the chasm midway
between top and bottom. Whichever way he looks, backwards or forwards,
upwards or downwards, towards the sky or towards the river, he meets
everywhere the irresistible and impressive evidence that this wonderful
fissure has been sawn through the mountain by the waters of the Tamina.

I have thus far confined myself to the consideration of the gorges
formed by the cutting through of the rock-barriers which frequently
cross the valleys of the Alps; as far as I have examined them they are
the work of erosion. But the larger question still remains, To what
action are we to ascribe the formation of the valleys themselves? This
question includes that of the formation of the mountain-ridges, for
were the valleys wholly filled, the ridges would disappear. Possibly no
answer can be given to this question which is not beset with more or
less of difficulty. Special localities might be found which would seem
to contradict every solution which refers the conformation of the Alps
to the operation of a single cause.

Still the Alps present features of a character sufficiently definite
to bring the question of their origin within the sphere of close
reasoning. That they were in whole or in part once beneath the sea will
not be disputed; for they are in great part composed of sedimentary
rocks which required a sea to form them. Their present elevation
above the sea is due to one of those local changes in the shape of
the earth which have been of frequent occurrence throughout geologic
time, and which in some cases have depressed the land, and in others
caused the sea-bottom to protrude beyond its surface. Considering the
inelastic character of its materials, the protuberance of the Alps
could hardly have been pushed out without dislocation and fracture; and
this conclusion gains in probability when we consider the foldings,
contortions, and even reversals in position of the strata in many parts
of the Alps. Such changes in the position of beds which were once
horizontal could not have been effected without dislocation. Fissures
would be produced by these changes; and such fissures, the advocates of
the fracture theory contend, mark the positions of the valleys of the
Alps.

Imagination is necessary to the man of science, and we could not reason
on our present subject without the power of presenting mentally a
picture of the earth’s crust cracked and fissured by the forces which
produced its upheaval. Imagination, however, must be strictly checked
by reason and by observation. That fractures occurred cannot, I
think, be doubted, but that the valleys of the Alps are thus formed is
a conclusion not at all involved in the admission of dislocations. I
never met with a precise statement of the manner in which the advocates
of the fissure theory suppose the forces to have acted--whether they
assume a general elevation of the region, or a local elevation of
distinct ridges; or whether they assume local subsidences after a
general elevation, or whether they would superpose upon the general
upheaval minor and local upheavals.

In the absence of any distinct statement, I will assume the elevation
to be general--that a swelling out of the earth’s crust occurred here,
sufficient to place the most prominent portions of the protuberance
three miles above the sea-level. To fix the ideas, let us consider
a circular portion of the crust, say one hundred miles in diameter,
and let us suppose, in the first instance, the circumference of this
circle to remain fixed, and that the elevation was confined to the
space within it. The upheaval would throw the crust into a state of
strain; and, if it were inflexible, the strain must be relieved by
fracture. Crevasses would thus intersect the crust. Let us now enquire
what proportion the area of these open fissures is likely to bear to
the area of the unfissured crust. An approximate answer is all that
is here required; for the problem is of such a character as to render
minute precision unnecessary.

No one, I think, would affirm that the area of the fissures would be
one-hundredth the area of the land. For let us consider the strain upon
a single line drawn over the summit of the protuberance from a point on
its rim to a point opposite. Regarding the protuberance as a spherical
swelling, the length of the arc corresponding to a chord of 100 miles
and a versed sine of 3 miles is 100.24 miles; consequently the surface
to reach its new position must stretch 0.24 of a mile, or be broken. A
fissure or a number of cracks with this total width would relieve the
strain; that is to say, the sum of the widths of all the cracks over
the length of 100 miles would be 420 yards. If, instead of comparing
the width of the fissures with the length of the lines of tension, we
compared their areas with the area of the unfissured land, we should of
course find the proportion much less. These considerations will help
the imagination to realise what a small ratio the area of the open
fissures must bear to the unfissured crust. They enable us to say, for
example, that to assume the area of the fissures to be one-tenth of
the area of the land would be quite absurd, while that the area of the
fissures could be one-half or more than one-half that of the land would
be in a proportionate degree unthinkable. If we suppose the elevation
to be due to the shrinking or subsidence of the land all round our
assumed circle, we arrive equally at the conclusion that the area of
the open fissures would be altogether insignificant as compared with
that of the unfissured crust.

To those who have seen them from a commanding elevation, it is needless
to say that the Alps themselves bear no sort of resemblance to the
picture which this theory presents to us. Instead of deep cracks with
approximately vertical walls, we have ridges before us running into
peaks, and gradually sloping to form valleys. Instead of a fissured
crust, we have a state of things closely resembling the surface of the
ocean when agitated by a storm. The valleys, instead of being much
narrower than the ridges, occupy the greater space. A plaster cast
of the Alps turned upside down, so as to invert the elevations and
depressions, would exhibit blunter and broader mountains, with narrower
valleys between them, than the present ones. The valleys that exist
cannot, I think, with any correctness of language be called fissures.
It may be urged that they originated in fissures: but even this is
unproved, and, were it proved, would still make the fissures play the
subordinate part of giving direction to the agents which are to be
regarded as the real sculptors of the Alps.

The fracture theory, then, if it regards the elevation of the Alps
as due to the operation of a force acting throughout the entire
region, is, in my opinion, utterly incompetent to account for the
conformation of the country. If, on the other hand, we are compelled
to resort to local disturbances, the manipulation of the earth’s
crust necessary to obtain the valleys and the mountains will, I
imagine, bring the difficulties of the theory into very strong relief.
Indeed an examination of the region from many of the more accessible
eminences--from the Galenstock, the Grauhaupt, the Pitz Languard,
the Monte Confinale--or, better still, from Mont Blanc, Monte Rosa,
the Jungfrau, the Finsteraarhorn, the Weisshorn, or the Matterhorn,
where local peculiarities are toned down, and the operations of the
powers which really made this region what it is are alone brought into
prominence--must, I imagine, convince every physically-minded man
of the inability of any fracture theory to account for the present
conformation of the Alps.

A correct model of the mountains, with an unexaggerated vertical
scale, produces the same effect upon the mind as the prospect from one
of the highest peaks. We are apt to be influenced by local phenomena
which, though insignificant in view of the general question of Alpine
conformation, are, with reference to our customary standards, vast and
impressive. In a true model those local peculiarities disappear; for
on the scale of a model they are too small to be visible; while the
essential facts and forms are presented to the undistracted attention.

A minute analysis of the phenomena strengthens the conviction which the
general aspect of the Alps fixes in the mind. We find, for example,
numerous valleys which the most ardent plutonist would not think of
ascribing to any other agency than erosion. That such is their genesis
and history is as certain as that erosion produced the Chines in the
Isle of Wight. From these indubitable cases of erosion--commencing,
if necessary, with the small ravines which run down the flanks of the
ridges, with their little working navigators at their bottoms--we can
proceed, by almost insensible gradations, to the largest valleys of the
Alps; and it would perplex the plutonist to fix upon the point at which
fracture begins to play a material part.

In ascending one of the larger valleys, we enter it where it is wide
and where the eminences are gentle on either side. The flanking
mountains become higher and more abrupt as we ascend, and at length we
reach a place where the depth of the valley is a maximum. Continuing
our walk upwards, we find ourselves flanked by gentler slopes, and
finally emerge from the valley and reach the summit of an open col,
or depression in the chain of mountains. This is the common character
of the large valleys. Crossing the col, we descend along the opposite
slope of the chain, and through the same series of appearances in the
reverse order. If the valleys on both sides of the col were produced
by fissures, what prevents the fissure from prolonging itself across
the col? The case here cited is representative; and I am not acquainted
with a single instance in the Alps where the chain has been cracked in
the manner indicated. The cols are simply depressions, and in the case
of many of them the unfissured rock can be traced from side to side.

The typical instance just sketched follows as a natural consequence
from the theory of erosion. Before either ice or water can exert great
power as an erosive agent, it must collect in sufficient mass. On the
higher slopes and plateaus--in the region of cols--the power is not
fully developed; but lower down tributaries unite, erosion is carried
on with increased vigour, and the excavation gradually reaches a
maximum. Lower still the elevations diminish and the slopes become more
gentle; the cutting power gradually relaxes, until finally the eroding
agent quits the mountains altogether, and the grand effects which it
produced in the earlier portions of its course entirely disappear.

I have hitherto confined myself to the consideration of the broad
question of the erosion theory as compared with the fracture theory;
and all that I have been able to observe and think with reference
to the subject leads me to adopt the former. Under the term erosion
I include the action of water, of ice, and of the atmosphere,
including frost and rain. Water and ice, however, are the principal
agents, and which of these two has produced the greatest effect it
is perhaps impossible to say. Two years ago I wrote a brief note ‘On
the Conformation of the Alps,’[21] in which I ascribed the paramount
influence to glaciers. The facts on which that opinion was founded are,
I think, unassailable; but whether the conclusion then announced fairly
follows from the facts is, I confess, an open question.

[21] Phil. Mag. vol. xxiv. p. 169.

The arguments which have been thus far urged against the conclusion
are not convincing. Indeed, the idea of glacier erosion appears so
daring to some minds that its boldness alone is deemed its sufficient
refutation. It is, however, to be remembered that a precisely similar
position was taken up by many respectable people when the question of
ancient glacier extension was first mooted. The idea was considered
too hardy to be entertained; and the evidences of glacial action were
sought to be explained by reference to almost any process rather than
the true one. Let those who so wisely took the side of ‘boldness’ in
that discussion beware lest they place themselves, with reference to
the question of glacier erosion, in the position formerly occupied by
their opponents.

Looking at the little glaciers of the present day--mere pigmies as
compared to the giants of the glacial epoch--we find that from every
one of them issues a river more or less voluminous, charged with the
matter which the ice has rubbed from the rocks. Where the rocks are
of a soft character, the amount of this finely pulverised matter
suspended in the water is very great. The water, for example, of the
river which flows from Santa Catarina to Bormio is thick with it. The
Rhine is charged with this matter, and by it has so silted up the Lake
of Constance as to abolish it for a large fraction of its length. The
Rhone is charged with it, and tens of thousands of acres of cultivable
land are formed by it above the Lake of Geneva.

In the case of every glacier we have two agents at work--the ice
exerting a crushing force on every point of its bed which bears its
weight, and either rasping this point into powder or tearing it bodily
from the rock to which it belongs; while the water which everywhere
circulates upon the bed of the glacier continually washes the detritus
away and leaves the rock clean for further abrasion. Confining the
action of glaciers to the simple rubbing away of the rocks, and
allowing them sufficient time to act, it is not a matter of opinion,
but a physical certainty, that they will scoop out valleys. But the
glacier does more than abrade. Rocks are not homogeneous; they are
intersected by joints and places of weakness, which divide them into
virtually detached masses. A glacier is undoubtedly competent to root
such masses bodily away. Indeed the mere _à priori_ consideration of
the subject proves the competence of a glacier to deepen its bed.
Taking the case of a glacier 1,000 feet deep (and some of the older
ones were probably three times this depth), and allowing 40 feet of ice
to an atmosphere, we find that on every square inch of its bed such a
glacier presses with a weight of 375 lbs., and on every square yard
of its bed with a weight of 486,000 lbs. With a _vertical_ pressure
of this amount the glacier is urged down its valley by the pressure
from behind. We can hardly, I think, deny to such a tool a power of
excavation.

Before concluding these remarks, I refreshed my memory by a second
reading of the paper of Mr. John Ball, published in the ‘Philosophical
Magazine’ for February 1863. Mr. Ball’s great experience of the Alps
naturally renders everything he writes regarding them interesting. But
though I have attended to the suggestions contained in his paper, I
am unable to see the cogency of his arguments. An inspection of the
map of Switzerland, with reference to the direction of its valleys,
suggests to my mind no objection whatever to the theory of erosion.

The reperusal of his paper assured me that Mr. Ball had paid attention
to the formation of ancient lakes. He deems their beds a prominent
feature of Alpine valleys; and he considers the barriers which dammed
them up, and which were not removed by the ancient glaciers, as ‘a
formidable difficulty in the way of Prof. Tyndall’s bold hypothesis.’
‘Looking at the operation as a whole,’ writes Mr. Ball, ‘it is to me
quite inconceivable that a glacier should be competent to scoop out
valleys a mile or more in depth, and yet be unable to remove the main
inequalities from its own channel.’

To this I reply that a glacier _is_ competent to remove such barriers,
and they probably have been ground down in some cases thousands of
feet. But being of more resisting material than the adjacent rock, they
are not ground down to the level of that rock. Were its bed uniform in
the first instance, the glacier would, in my opinion, _produce_ the
inequalities which Mr. Ball thinks it ought to remove. I have recently
had the pleasure of examining some of these barriers in the company
of Mr. Ball; and to me they represented nothing more than the natural
accidents of the locality. It would, I think, be far more wonderful
to find the rocks of the Alps perfectly homogeneous, than to find
them exhibiting such variations of resistance to grinding down as are
actually observed.

The question of lake-basins is now in competent hands, and on its
merits I will offer no opinion. But I cannot help remarking that the
dams referred to by Mr. Ball furnish a conclusive reply to some of the
arguments which have been urged against Prof. Ramsay’s theory. These
barriers have been crossed by the ice, and many of them present steeper
gradients than Prof. Ramsay has to cope with in order to get his ice
out of his lake-basins. An inspection of the barriers shows that they
were incompetent to embay the ice: they are scarred and fluted from
bottom to top. When it is urged against Prof. Ramsay that a glacier
cannot drop into a hole 2,000 feet deep and get out again, the distance
ought to be stated over which these 2,000 feet have to be distributed.
A depression 2,000 feet deep, if only of sufficient length, would
constitute no material obstacle to the motion of a great glacier.

The retardation of a glacier by its bed has also been referred to as
proving its impotence as an erosive agent; but this very retardation is
in some measure an expression of the magnitude of the erosive energy.
Either the bed must give way, or the ice must slide over itself; and
to make ice slide over itself requires great power. We get some idea
of the crushing pressure which the moving glacier exercises against
its bed from the fact that the resistance, and the effort to overcome
it, are such as to make the upper layers of a glacier move bodily over
the lower ones--a portion only of the total motion being due to the
progress of the entire mass of the glacier down its valley.

The sudden bend in the valley of the Rhone at Martigny has also been
regarded as conclusive evidence against the theory of erosion. ‘Why,’
it has been asked, ‘did not the glacier of the Rhone go straight
forward instead of making this awkward bend?’ But if the valley be
a crack, why did the crack make this bend? The crack, I submit, had
at least as much reason to prolong itself in a straight line as the
glacier had. A statement of Sir John Herschel with reference to another
matter is perfectly applicable here: ‘A crack once produced has a
tendency to run--for this plain reason, that at its momentary limit,
at the point at which it has just arrived, the divellent force on the
molecules there situated is counteracted only by half of the cohesive
force which acted when there was no crack, viz. the cohesion of the
uncracked portion alone’ (‘Proc. Roy. Soc.’ vol. xii. p. 678). To
account then for the bend, the adherent of the fracture theory must
assume the existence of some accident which turned the crack at right
angles to itself; and he surely will permit the adherent of the erosion
theory to make a similar assumption.

The influence of small accidents on the direction of rivers is
beautifully illustrated in glacier streams, which are made to cut
either straight or sinuous channels by causes apparently of the
most trivial character. In his interesting paper ‘On the Lakes of
Switzerland,’ M. Studer also refers to the bend of the Rhine at Sargans
in proof that the river must there follow a pre-existing fissure. I
made a special expedition to the place in 1864; and though I felt that
M. Studer had good grounds for the selection of this spot, I was unable
to arrive at his conclusion as to the necessity of a fissure.

Again, in the interesting volume recently published by the Swiss
Alpine Club, M. Desor informs us that the Swiss naturalists who met
last year at Samaden visited the end of the Morteratsch glacier, and
there convinced themselves that a glacier had no tendency whatever to
imbed itself in the soil. I scarcely think that the question of glacier
erosion, as applied either to lakes or valleys, is to be disposed of so
easily. Let me record here my experience of the Morteratsch glacier.
I took with me in 1864 a theodolite to Pontresina, and while there
had to congratulate myself on the invaluable aid of my friend Mr.
Hirst, who in 1857 did such good service upon the Mer de Glace and its
tributaries. We set out three lines across the Morteratsch glacier,
one of which crossed the ice-stream near the well-known hut of the
painter Georgei, while the two others were staked out, the one above
the hut and the other below it. Calling the highest line A, the line
which crossed the glacier at the hut B, and the lowest line C, the
following are the mean hourly motions of the three lines, deduced from
observations which extended over several days. On each line eleven
stakes were fixed, which are designated by the figures 1, 2, 3, &c. in
the Tables.


_Morteratsch Glacier, Line_ A.

  No. of Stake.    Hourly Motion.
      1               0.35 inch.
      2               0.49  „
      3               0.53  „
      4               0.54  „
      5               0.56  „
      6               0.54  „
      7               0.52  „
      8               0.49  „
      9               0.40  „
     10               0.29  „
     11               0.20  „

As in all other measurements of this kind, the retarding influence
of the sides of the glacier is manifest: the centre moves with the
greatest velocity.


_Morteratsch Glacier, Line_ B.

  No. of Stake.    Hourly Motion.
      1              0.05 inch.
      2              0.14  „
      3              0.24  „
      4              0.32  „
      5              0.41  „
      6              0.44  „
      7              0.44  „
      8              0.45  „
      9              0.43  „
     10              0.44  „
     11              0.44  „

The first stake of this line was quite close to the edge of the
glacier, and the ice was thin at the place, hence its slow motion.
Crevasses prevented us from carrying the line sufficiently far across
to render the retardation of the further side of the glacier fully
evident.


_Morteratsch Glacier, Line_ C.

  No of Stake.    Hourly Motion.
      1             0.05 inch.
      2             0.09  „
      3             0.18  „
      4             0.20  „
      5             0.25  „
      6             0.27  „
      7             0.27  „
      8             0.30  „
      9             0.21  „
     10             0.20  „
     11             0.16  „

Comparing the three lines together, it will be observed that the
velocity diminishes as we descend the glacier. In 100 hours the maximum
motion of the three lines respectively is as follows:


_Maximum Motion in 100 hours._

  Line A      56 inches
   „   B      45   „
   „   C      30   „

This deportment explains an appearance which must strike every observer
who looks upon the Morteratsch from the Piz Languard, or from the new
Bernina Road. A medial moraine runs along the glacier, commencing as
a narrow streak, but towards the end the moraine extending in width,
until finally it quite covers the terminal portion of the glacier.
The cause of this is revealed by the foregoing measurements, which
prove that a stone on the moraine where it is crossed by the line A
approaches a second stone on the moraine where it is crossed by the
line C with a velocity of twenty-six inches per one hundred hours.
The moraine is in a state of longitudinal compression. Its materials
are more and more squeezed together, and they must consequently move
laterally and render the moraine at the terminal portion of the glacier
wider than above.

The motion of the Morteratsch glacier, then, diminishes as we descend.
The maximum motion of the third line is thirty inches in one hundred
hours, or seven inches a day--a very slow motion; and had we run a line
nearer to the end of the glacier, the motion would have been slower
still. At the end itself it is nearly insensible. Now I submit that
this is not the place to seek for the scooping power of a glacier. The
opinion appears to be prevalent that it is the snout of a glacier that
must act the part of ploughshare; and it is certainly an erroneous
opinion. The scooping power will exert itself most where the weight,
and consequently (other things being equal) the motion, is greatest.
A glacier’s snout often _rests upon_ matter which has been scooped
from the glacier’s bed higher up. I therefore do not think that the
inspection of what the end of a glacier does or does not accomplish can
decide this question.

The snout of a glacier is potent to remove anything against which it
can fairly abut; and this power, notwithstanding the slowness of the
motion, manifests itself at the end of the Morteratsch glacier. A
hillock, bearing pine-trees, was in front of the glacier when Mr. Hirst
and myself inspected its end; and this hillock is being bodily removed
by the thrust of the ice. Several of the trees are overturned; and in a
few years, if the glacier continues its reputed advance, the mound will
certainly be ploughed away.

I will here record a few other measurements executed on the Rosegg
glacier: the line was staked out across the trunk formed by the
junction of the Rosegg proper with the Tschierva glacier, a short
distance below the rocky promontory called Agaliogs.


_Rosegg Glacier._

  No. of Stake.   Hourly Motion.
      1             0.01 inch.
      2             0.05  „
      3             0.07  „
      4             0.10  „
      5             0.11  „
      6             0.13  „
      7             0.14  „
      8             0.18  „
      9             0.24  „
     10             0.23  „
     11             0.24  „

This is an extremely slowly moving glacier; the maximum hardly amounts
to seven inches a day. Crevasses prevented us from continuing the line
quite across the glacier.

To return to the question of Alpine conformation: it stands, I think,
thus: We have, in the first place, great valleys, such as those of the
Rhine and the Rhone, which we might conveniently call valleys of the
first order. The mountains which flank these main valleys are also cut
by lateral valleys running into the main one, and which may be called
valleys of the second order. When these latter are examined, smaller
valleys are found running into them, which may be called valleys of
the third order. Smaller ravines and depressions, again, join the
latter, which may be called valleys of the fourth order, and so on
until we reach streaks and cuttings so minute as not to merit the name
of valleys at all. At the bottom of every valley we have a stream,
diminishing in magnitude as the order of the valley ascends, carving
the earth and carrying its materials to lower levels. We find that the
larger valleys have been filled for untold ages by glaciers of enormous
dimensions, always moving, grinding down and tearing away the rocks
over which they passed. We have, moreover, on the plains at the feet of
the mountains, and in enormous quantities, the very matter derived from
the sculpture of the mountains themselves.

The plains of Italy and Switzerland are cumbered by the _débris_ of
the Alps. The lower, wider, and more level valleys are also filled to
unknown depths with the materials derived from the higher ones. In
the vast quantities of moraine-matter which cumber many even of the
higher valleys we have also suggestions as to the magnitude of the
erosion which has taken place. This moraine-matter, moreover, can only
in small part have been derived from the falling of rocks _upon_ the
ancient glacier; it is in great part derived from the grinding and the
ploughing-out of the glacier itself. This accounts for the magnitude of
many of the ancient moraines, which date from a period when almost all
the mountains were covered with ice and snow, and when, consequently,
the quantity of moraine-matter derived from the naked crests cannot
have been considerable.

The erosion theory ascribes the formation of Alpine valleys to the
agencies here briefly referred to. It invokes nothing but true causes.
Its artificers are still there, though, it may be, in diminished
strength; and if they are granted sufficient time, it is demonstrable
that they are competent to produce the effects ascribed to them. And
what does the fracture theory offer in comparison? From no possible
application of this theory, pure and simple, can we obtain the slopes
and forms of the mountains. Erosion must in the long run be invoked,
and its power therefore conceded. The fracture theory infers from the
disturbances of the Alps the existence of fissures; and this is a
probable inference. But that they were of a magnitude sufficient to
determine the conformation of the Alps, and that they followed, as the
Alpine valleys do, the lines of natural drainage of the country, are
assumptions which do not appear to me to be justified either by reason
or by observation.

There is a grandeur in the secular integration of small effects implied
by the theory of erosion almost superior to that involved in the idea
of a cataclysm. Think of the ages which must have been consumed in the
execution of this colossal sculpture. The question may, of course, be
pushed to further limits. Think of the ages which the molten earth
required for its consolidation. But these vaster epochs lack sublimity
through our inability to grasp them. They bewilder us, but they fail
to make a solemn impression. The genesis of the mountains comes more
within the scope of the intellect, and the majesty of the operation is
enhanced by our partial ability to conceive it. In the falling of a
rock from a mountain-head, in the shoot of an avalanche, in the plunge
of a cataract, we often see more impressive illustrations of the power
of gravity than in the motions of the stars. When the intellect has
to intervene, and calculation is necessary to the building up of the
conception, the expansion of the feelings ceases to be proportional to
the magnitude of the phenomena.




XXI.

_SEARCH ON THE MATTERHORN: A PROJECT._


In July 1865 my excellent friend Hirst and myself visited Glarus,
intending, if circumstances favoured us, to climb the Tödi. We had,
however, some difficulty with the guides, and therefore gave the
expedition up. Crossing the Klausen pass to Altdorf, we ascended the
Gotthardt Strasse to Wasen, and went thence over the Susten pass to
Gadmen, which we reached late at night. We halted for a moment at
Stein, but the blossom of 1863[22] was no longer there, and we did not
tarry. On quitting Gadmen next morning I was accosted by a guide, who
asked me whether I knew Professor Tyndall. ‘He is killed, sir,’ said
the man--‘killed upon the Matterhorn.’ I then listened to a somewhat
detailed account of my own destruction, and soon gathered that, though
the details were erroneous, something serious if not shocking had
occurred. At Imhof the rumour became more consistent, and immediately
afterwards the Matterhorn catastrophe was in every mouth, and in all
the newspapers. My friend and myself wandered on to Mürren, whence,
after an ineffectual attempt to cross the Petersgrat, we went by
Kandersteg and the Gemmi to Zermatt.

[22] Page 167.

Of the four sufferers on the Matterhorn one remained behind. But
expressed in terms either of mental torture or physical pain, the
suffering in my opinion was _nil_. Excitement during the first moments
left no room for terror, and immediate unconsciousness prevented pain.
No death has probably less of agony in it than that caused by the shock
of gravity on a mountain-side. _Expected_, it would be terrible; but
unexpected, not. I had heard, however, of other griefs and sufferings
consequent on the accident, and this prompted a desire on my part to
find the remaining one and bring him down.

I had seen the road-makers at work between St. Nicholas and Zermatt,
and was struck by the rapidity with which they pierced the rocks for
blasting. One of these fellows could drive a hole a foot deep into hard
granite in less than an hour. I was therefore determined to secure in
aid of my project the services of a road-maker. None of the Zermatt
guides would second me, but I found one of the Lochmatters of St.
Nicholas willing to do so. Him I sent to Geneva to buy 3,000 feet of
rope, which duly came on heavily laden mules to Zermatt. Hammers and
steel punches were prepared; a tent was put in order, and the whole
was carried up to the chapel by the Schwarz See. But the weather would
by no means smile upon the undertaking. I waited in Zermatt for twenty
days, making excursions with pleasant friends, but they merely spanned
the brief intervals which separated one rain-gush or thunderstorm from
another. Bound by an engagement to my friend Professor De la Rive, of
Geneva, where the Swiss naturalists had their annual assembly in 1865,
I was forced to leave Zermatt. My notion was to climb to the point
where the men slipped, and to fix there suitable irons in the rocks. By
means of ropes attached to these I proposed to scour the mountain along
the line of the glissade. There were peculiarities in the notion which
need not now be dwelt upon, inasmuch as the weather rendered them all
futile.

       *       *       *       *       *

[I am not sure that the proposed search is practicable; it would
certainly require unusually good weather for its execution.--April
1871.]




XXII.

_THE TITLIS, FINSTERAARSCHLUCHT, PETERSGRAT, AND ITALIAN LAKES._


In the summer of 1866 I first went to Engsteln, one of the most
charming spots in the Alps. It had at that time a double charm, for the
handsome young widow who kept the inn supplemented by her kindness and
attention within doors the pleasures extracted from the outer world.
A man named Maurer, of Meyringen, was my guide for a time. We climbed
the Titlis, going straight up it from the Joch Pass, in the track of a
scampering chamois which showed us the way. The Titlis is a very noble
mass--one of the few which, while moderate in height, bear a lordly
weight of snow. The view from the summit is exceedingly fine, and on it
I repeated with a hand spectroscope the observations of M. Janssen on
the absorption-bands of aqueous vapour. On the day after this ascent I
quitted Engsteln, being drawn towards the Wellhorn and Wetterhorn, both
of which, as seen from Engsteln, came out with inexpressible nobleness.
The upper dome of heaven was of the deepest blue, while only the
faintest lightening of the colour towards the horizon indicated the
augmented thickness of the atmosphere in that direction. The sun was
very hot, but there was a clear rivulet at hand, deepening here and
there into pebbled pools, into which I plunged at intervals, causing my
guide surprise if not anxiety; for he shared the common superstition
that plunging, when hot, into cold water is dangerous. The danger, and
a very serious one it is, is to plunge into cold water when _cold_. The
strongest alone can then bear immersion without damage.

This year I subjected the famous Finsteraarschlucht to a closer
examination than ordinary. The earthquake theory already adverted to
was prevalent regarding it, and I wished to see whether any evidences
existed of aqueous erosion. It will be remembered that the Schlucht
or gorge is cut through a great barrier of limestone rock called
the Kirchet, which throws itself across the valley of Hasli, about
three-quarters of an hour’s walk above Meyringen. The plain beyond the
barrier, on which stands the hamlet of Imhof, is formed of the sediment
of a lake of which the Kirchet constituted the dam. This dam is now
cut through for the passage of the Aar, forming one of the noblest
gorges in Switzerland. Near the summit of the Kirchet is a house
with a signboard inviting the traveller to visit the _Aarenschlucht_,
a narrow lateral gorge which runs down to the very bottom of the
principal one. The aspect of this smaller chasm from its bottom to its
top proves to demonstration that water had in former ages worked there
as a navigator. It is scooped, rounded, and polished, so as to render
it palpable to the common eye that it is a gorge of erosion. But it was
regarding the sides of the great chasm that I needed instruction, and
from its edge I could see nothing to satisfy me. I therefore stripped
and waded into the river until a point was reached which commanded
an excellent view of both sides of the gorge. The water was cutting,
but I was repaid. Below me on the left-hand side was a jutting cliff,
which bore the thrust of the river and caused the Aar to swerve from
its direct course. From top to bottom this cliff was polished, rounded,
and scooped. There was no room for doubt. The river which now runs so
deeply down had once been above. It has been the delver of its own
channel through the barrier of the Kirchet.

I went on to Rosenlaui, proposing to climb the neighbouring mountains
in succession. In fact I went to Switzerland in 1866 with a particular
hunger for the heights. But the weather thickened before Rosenlaui was
reached, and on the night following the morning of my departure from
Engsteln I lay upon my plaid under an impervious pine, and watched
as wild a thunderstorm and as heavy a downpour of rain as I had ever
seen. Most extraordinary was the flicker on cliffs and trees, and most
tremendous was the detonation succeeding each discharge. The fine
weather came thus to an end, and next day I gave up the Wetterhorn for
the ignoble Faulhorn. Here the wind changed, the air became piercingly
cold, and on the following morning heavy snow-drifts buttressed the
doors, windows, and walls of the inn. We broke away, sinking at some
places to the hips in snow. A descent of a thousand feet carried us
from the bleakest winter into genial summer. My companion held on to
the beaten track, while I sought a rougher and more direct one to the
Scheinigeplatte, a resting-place which commands a noble view of the
precipices of the Jungfrau. We were solitary visitors there, and I
filled the evening with Miss Thackeray’s ‘Story of Elizabeth,’ which
some benevolent traveller had left at the hotel.

Thence we dropped down to Lauterbrunnen, went up the valley to the
little inn at Trechslawinen, and crossed the Petersgrat the following
day. The recent precipitation had cleared the heavens and reloaded the
heights. It was, perhaps, the splendour of the weather and the purity
of the snows, aided by the subjective effect due to contrast with a
series of most dismal days, that made me think the Petersgrat so
noble a standpoint for a view of the mountains. The horizontal extent
was vast, and the grouping magnificent. The undoubted monarch of this
unparagoned scene was the Weisshorn, and this may have rendered me
partial in my judgment, for men like to see what they love exalted.
At Platten we found shelter in the house of the curé. Next day we
crossed the Lotschsattel, and swept round by the Aletsch glacier to the
Æggischhorn.

Here I had the pleasure of meeting a very ardent climber, who
entertains peculiar notions regarding guides. He deems them, and
rightly so, very expensive, and he also feels pleasure in trying his
own powers. Very likely it is my habit of going alone that causes me
to sympathise with him. I would, however, admonish him that he may
go too far in this direction, and probably his own experience has
by this time forestalled the admonition. Still, if skill, strength,
and self-reliance are things to be cultivated in the Alps, they are,
within certain limits, best exercised and developed in the absence of
guides. And if the real climbers are ever to be differentiated from the
crowd who write and talk about the mountains, it is only to be done by
dispensing with professional assistance. But no man without natural
aptitude and due training would be justified in committing himself
to ventures of this kind, and it is an error to suppose that the
necessary knowledge can be obtained in one or two summers in the Alps.
Climbing is an art, and those who wish to cultivate it on their own
account ought to give themselves sufficient previous practice in the
company of first-rate guides. Here, moreover, as in every other sphere
of human action, whether intellectual or physical, as indeed among the
guides themselves, real eminence falls only to the lot of few. Whatever
be the amount of preparation, real climbers must still remain select
men.

From the Bel Alp, Mr. Girdlestone and I, without any guide, made an
attack upon the Aletschhorn. We failed. The weather as we started
was undecided, but we hoped the turn might be in our favour. We
first kept along the Alp, with the Jäggi glacier to our right, then
crossed its moraine, and made the trunk glacier our highway until we
reached the point of confluence of its branches. Here we turned to
the right, the Aletschhorn, from base to summit, coming into view. We
reached the true base of the mountain, and without halting breasted
its snow. But as we climbed the atmosphere thickened more and more.
About the Nesthorn the horizon deepened to pitchy darkness, and on
the Aletschhorn itself hung a cloud, which we at first hoped would
melt before the strengthening sun, but which instead of melting became
denser. Now and then an echoing rumble of the wind warned us that we
might expect rough handling above. We persisted, however, and reached
a considerable height, unwilling to admit that the weather was against
us, until a more savage roar and a ruder shake than ordinary caused
us to halt, and look more earnestly and anxiously into the darkening
atmosphere. We were forced to give in, and during our descent the air
was thick and dark with falling snow. Holding on in the dimness to the
medial moraine, we managed to get down the glacier, and to clear it at
a practicable point, whence, guided by the cliffs which flanked our
right, and which became visible only when we came almost into contact
with them, we hit the proper track to the Bel Alp hotel.

Though my visits to the Alps had already numbered thirteen, I had never
gone so far southward as the Italian lakes. The perfectly unmanageable
weather of July 1866 caused me to cross with Mr. Girdlestone into
Italy, in the hope that a respite of ten or twelve days might improve
the temper of the mountains. We walked over the Simplon to the village
of the same name, and took thence the diligence to Domo d’Ossola and
Baveno. The atmospheric change was wonderful; and still the clear
air which we enjoyed below was the self-same air that heaped clouds
and snow upon the mountains. It came across the heated plains of
Lombardy charged with moisture, but the moisture was in the transparent
condition of true vapour, and hence invisible. Tilted by the mountains,
the air rose, and as it expanded it became chilled, and as it became
chilled it discharged its vapour as visible cloud, the globules of
which swelled by coalescence into raindrops on the mountain-flanks, or
were frozen to snow upon the mountain-heads.

We halted on the margin of the Lago Maggiore. I could hear the lisping
of the waters on the shingle far into the night. My window looked
eastward, and through it could be seen the first warming of the sky
at the approach of dawn. I rose, and watched the growth of colour all
along the east. The mountains, from mere masses of darkness projected
against the heavens, became empurpled. It was not as a mere wash of
colour overspreading their surfaces. They blent with the atmosphere as
if they were part and parcel of the general purple of the air. Nobody
was stirring at the time, and the ‘lap’ of the lake upon its shore only
increased the sense of silence.

    The holy hour was quiet as a nun
    Breathless with adoration.

In my subsequent experience of the Italian lakes I met with nothing
which affected me so deeply as this morning scene on the Lago Maggiore.

From Baveno we crossed the lake to Luino, and went thence to Lugano.
At Belaggio, on the junction of the two branches of the Lake of
Como, we halted a couple of days. Como itself we reached in a small
sailing-boat, as a storm prevented the steamer from taking us. There
we saw the statue of Volta--a prophet justly honoured in his own
country. From Como we went to Milan. A climber, of course, could not
forego the pleasure of looking at Monte Rosa from the cathedral roof.
The distribution of the statues magnified the apparent vastness of
the pile; still the impression made on me by this great edifice was
one of disappointment. Its front seemed to illustrate an attempt to
cover meanness of conception by profusion of adornment. The interior,
however, notwithstanding the cheat of the ceiling, is exceedingly grand.

From Milan we went to Orta, where we had a plunge into the lake. We
crossed it subsequently, and walked on to Varallo: thence by Fobello
over a country of noble beauty to Ponte Grande in the Val Ansasca.
Thence again by Macugnaga, over the deep snow of the Monte Moro,
reaching Mattmark in drenching rain. The temper of the northern slopes
did not appear to have improved during our absence. We returned to the
Bel Alp, fitful triumphs of the sun causing us to hope that we might
still have fair play upon the Aletschhorn. But the day after our
arrival snow fell so heavily as to cover the pastures for 2,000 feet
below the hotel. Partial famine among the herds was the consequence.
They had eventually to be driven below the snow-line. Avalanches were
not unfrequent on slopes which a day or two previously had been covered
with grass and flowers. In this condition of things Mr. Milman, Mr.
Girdlestone, and I climbed the Sparrenhorn, and found its heavy-laden
Kamm almost as hard as that of Monte Rosa. Occupation out of doors was,
however, insufficient to fill the mind, so I wound my plaid around my
loins, and in my cold bedroom studied ‘Mozley upon Miracles.’




XXIII.

_ASCENT OF THE EIGER AND PASSAGE OF THE TRIFT._


Grindelwald was my first halting-place in the summer of 1867: I reached
it, in company with a friend, on Sunday evening the 7th of July. The
air of the glaciers and the excellent little dinners of the Adler
rendered me rapidly fit for mountain-work. The first day we made an
excursion along the lower glacier to the Kastenstein, crossing, in
returning, the Strahleck branch of the glacier above the ice-fall, and
coming down by the Zäsenberg. The second day was spent upon the upper
glacier. The sunset covered the crest of the Eiger with indescribable
glory that evening. It gave definition to a vague desire I had
previously entertained to climb the mountain, and I forthwith arranged
with excellent old Christian Michel, and with Peter Baumann, the
preliminaries of the ascent.

At half-past one o’clock on the morning of the 11th we started from the
Wengern Alp; no trace of cloud was visible in the heavens, which were
sown broadcast with stars. Those low down twinkled with extraordinary
vivacity, many of them flashing lights of different colours. When an
opera-glass was pointed to such a star, and shaken, the line of light
described by the image of the star resolved itself into a string of
richly coloured beads: rubies and emeralds hung thus together on the
same curve. The dark intervals between the beads corresponded to the
moments of extinction of the star. Over the summit of the Wetterhorn
the Pleiades hung like a diadem, while at intervals a solitary meteor
shot across the sky.

We passed along the Alp, and then over the balled snow and broken
ice cast down a glacier which fronted us. Here the ascent began; we
passed from snow to rock and from rock to snow by turns. The steepness
for a time was moderate, the only thing requiring caution being the
thin crusts of ice upon the rocks over which water had trickled the
previous day. The east gradually brightened, the stars become paler and
disappeared, and at length the crown of the adjacent Jungfrau rose out
of the twilight into the rose of the sun. The bloom crept gradually
downwards over the snows. At length the whole mountain-world partook
of the colour. It is not in the night nor in the day--it is not in any
statical condition of the atmosphere--that the mountains look most
sublime. It is during the few minutes of transition from twilight to
full day through the splendours of the dawn.

Seven hours’ climbing brought us to the higher slopes, which were for
the most part ice, and required deep step-cutting. The whole duty of
the climber on such slopes is to cut his steps properly, and to stand
in them securely. At one period of my mountain life I looked lightly on
the possibility of a slip, having full faith in the resources of him
who accompanied me, and very little doubt of my own. Experience has
qualified this faith in the power even of the best of climbers upon a
steep ice-slope. A slip under such circumstances must not occur.

The Jungfrau began her cannonade very early, five avalanches having
thundered down her precipices before eight o’clock in the morning.
Baumann, being the youngest man, undertook the labour of step-cutting,
which the hardness of the ice rendered severe. He was glad from time
to time to escape to the snow-cornice which, unsupported save by its
own tenacity, overhung the Grindelwald side of the mountain, checking
himself at intervals by looking over the edge of the cornice, to assure
himself that its strength was sufficient to bear our weight. A wilder
precipice is hardly to be seen than this wall of the Eiger, viewed
from the cornice at its top. It seems to drop sheer for eight thousand
feet down to Grindelwald. When the cornice became unsafe, the guide
retreated, and step-cutting recommenced. We reached the summit before
nine o’clock, and had from it an outlook over as glorious a scene as
this world perhaps affords.

       *       *       *       *       *

On the following day I went down to Lauterbrunnen, and afterwards
crossed the Petersgrat to Platten, where, the door of the curé being
closed against travellers, we were forced into dirty quarters in an
adjacent house. From Platten, instead of going as before over the
Lötschsattel, we struck obliquely across the ridge above the Nesthorn,
and got down upon the Jäggi glacier, making thus an exceedingly fine
excursion from Platten to the Bel Alp. Thence, after a day’s halt, I
pushed on to Zermatt.

I have already mentioned Carrel, the _bersaglier_, who accompanied
Bennen and myself in our attempt upon the Matterhorn in 1862, and who
in 1865 reached the summit of the mountain. With him I had been in
correspondence for some time, and from his letters an enthusiastic
desire to be my guide up the Matterhorn might be inferred. From the
Riffelberg I crossed the Theodule to Breuil, where I saw Carrel. He
had naturally and deservedly grown in his own estimation. But I was
discomfited by the form his self-consciousness assumed. His demands
were exorbitant, and he also objected to the excellent company of
Christian Michel. In fact my friend Carrel was no longer a reasonable
man. I believe he afterwards felt ashamed of himself, and sent his
friends Bich and Meynet to speak to me while he kept aloof. But the
weather was then too bad to permit of any definite arrangement being
made.

I waited at the Riffel for twelve days, making small excursions here
and there. But, though the weather was not so abominable as it had been
in the previous year, the frequent snow-discharges on the Matterhorn
kept it unassailable. In company with Mr. Crawfurd Grove, who had
engaged Carrel as his guide, Michel being mine, I made the pass of
the Trift from Zermatt to Zinal. I could understand and share the
enthusiasm experienced by Mr. Hinchliff in crossing this truly noble
pass. It is certainly one of the finest in the whole Alps. For that
one day, moreover, the weather was magnificent. Next day we crossed
to Evolena, going considerably astray, and thus converting a light
day into a rather heavy one. From Evolena we purposed crossing the
Col d’Érin back to Zermatt, but the weather would not let us. This
excursion had been made with the view of allowing the Matterhorn a
little time to arrange its temper; but the temper continued sulky, and
at length wearied me out. We went round by the valley of the Rhone
to Zermatt, and, finding matters worse than ever, both Mr. Grove and
myself returned to Visp, intending to quit Switzerland altogether.
Here he changed his mind and returned to Zermatt; on the same day the
weather changed also, and continued fine for a fortnight. He succeeded
in getting with Carrel to the top of the Matterhorn, and I succeeded in
joining the British Association at Dundee. A ramble in the Highlands,
including a visit to the Parallel Roads of Glenroy, concluded my
vacation in 1867.




XXIV.

_THE MATTERHORN--THIRD AND LAST ASSAULT._


The oil of life burnt rather low with me in 1868. Driven from London by
Dr. Bence Jones, I reached the Giessbach hotel on the Lake of Brientz
early in July. No pleasanter position could be found for an invalid.
My friend Hirst was with me, and we made various little excursions in
the neighbourhood. The most pleasant of these was to the Hinterburger
See, a small and lonely lake high up among the hills, fringed on one
side by pines, and overshadowed on the other by the massive limestone
buttresses of the Hinterburg. It is an exceedingly lovely spot,
but rarely visited. The Giessbach hotel is an admirably organised
establishment. The table is served by Swiss girls in Swiss costume,
fresh, handsome, and modest, well brought up, who come there, not as
servants, but to learn the mysteries of housekeeping. And among her
maidens moved like a little queen the daughter of the host--noiseless,
but effectual in her rule and governance. I went to the Giessbach
with a prejudice against the illumination of the fall. The crowd of
spectators may suggest the theatre, but the lighting up of the water
is fine. I liked the colourless light best; it merely intensified the
contrast revealed by ordinary daylight between the white foam of the
cascades and the black surrounding pines.

From the Giessbach we went to Thun, and thence up the Simmenthal
to Lenk. Over the sulphur spring a large hotel has been recently
erected, and here we found a number of Swiss and Germans, who thought
the waters did them good. In one large room the liquid gushes from
a tap into a basin, diffusing through the place the odour of rotten
eggs. The patients like this smell; indeed they regard its foulness
as a measure of their benefit. The director of the establishment is
intelligent and obliging, sparing no pains to meet the wishes and
promote the comfort of his guests. We wandered while at Lenk to the
summit of the Rawyl pass, visited the Siebenbrünnen, where the river
Simmen bursts full-grown from the rocks, and we should have clambered
up the Wildstrubel had the weather been tolerable. From Lenk we went
to Gsteig, a finely situated hamlet, but not celebrated for the peace
and comfort of its inn; and from Gsteig to the Diablerets hotel. While
there I clambered up the Diablerets mountain, and was amazed at the
extent of the snow-field upon its tabular top. The peaks, if they ever
existed, have been shorn away, and miles of flat _névé_, unseen from
below, overspread their section.

From the Diablerets we drove down to Aigle. The Traubenkur had not
commenced, and there was therefore ample space for us at the excellent
hotel. We were compelled to spend a night at Martigny. I heard the
trumpet of its famous mosquito, but did not feel its attacks. The
following night was more pleasantly spent on the cool col of the Great
St. Bernard. On Tuesday, July 21, we reached Aosta, and, in accordance
with previous telegraphic arrangement, met there the Chanoine Carrel.
Jean-Jacques Carrel, the old companion of Mr. Hawkins and myself,
and others at Breuil, were dissatisfied with the behaviour of the
_bersaglier_ last year, and this feeling the Chanoine shared. He had
written to me during the winter, stating that two new men had scaled
the Matterhorn, and that they were ready to accompany me anywhere. He
now drove, with Hirst and myself, to Chatillon, where at the noisy and
comfortless inn we spent the night. Here Hirst quitted me, and I turned
with the Chanoine up the valley to Breuil.

At Val Tournanche I saw a maiden niece of the Chanoine who had gone
high up the Matterhorn, and who, had the wind not assailed her
petticoats too roughly, might, it was said, have reached the top.
I can believe it. Her wrist was like a weaver’s beam, and her frame
seemed a mass of potential energy. The Chanoine had recommended to me
as guides the brothers Joseph and Pierre Maquignaz, of Val Tournanche,
his praises of Joseph as a man of unshaken coolness, courage, and
capacity as a climber being particularly strong. Previous to reaching
Breuil, I saw this Joseph, who seemed to divine by instinct my name and
aim.

Carrel was at Breuil, looking very dark, Bich petitioned for a porter’s
post, blaming Carrel bitterly for his greed in the previous year; but I
left the arrangement of these matters wholly in the hands of Maquignaz.
He joined me in the evening, and on the following day we ascended one
of the neighbouring summits, discussing as we went our chances on
the Matterhorn. In 1867 the chief precipitation took place in a low
atmospheric layer, the base of the mountain being heavily laden with
snow, while the summit and the higher rocks were bare. In 1868 the
distribution was inverted, the top being heavily laden and the lower
rocks clear. An additional element of uncertainty was thus introduced.
Maquignaz could not say what obstacles the snow might oppose to us
above, but he was resolute and hopeful. My desire was to finish for
ever my contest with the Matterhorn by making a pass over its summit
from Breuil to Zermatt. In this attempt my guide expressed his
willingness to join me, his interest in the project being apparently
equal to my own.

He, however, only knew the Zermatt side of the mountain through
inspection from below; and he acknowledged that a dread of it had
filled him the previous year. He now reasoned, however, that as Mr.
Whymper and the Taugwalds had managed to descend, we ought to be able
to do the same. On the Friday we climbed to the Col de la Furka,
examined from it the northern face of the pyramid, and discovered the
men who were engaged in building the cabin on that side. We worked
afterwards along the ridge which stretches from the Matterhorn to the
Theodule, crossing its gulleys and scaling all its heights. It was a
pleasant piece of discipline, on new ground, to both my guide and me.

On the Thursday evening a violent thunderstorm had burst over Breuil,
discharging new snow upon the heights, but also clearing the oppressive
air. Though the heavens seemed clear in the early part of Friday,
clouds showed a disposition to meet us from the south as we returned
from the col. I enquired of my companion whether, in the event of the
day being fine, he would be ready to start on Sunday. His answer was a
prompt negative. In Val Tournanche, he said, they always ‘sanctified
the Sunday.’ I mentioned Bennen, my pious Catholic guide, whom I
permitted and encouraged to attend his mass on all possible occasions,
but who, nevertheless, always yielded without a murmur to the demands
of the weather. The reasoning had its effect. On Saturday Maquignaz
saw his confessor, and arranged with him to have a mass at 2 A.M. on
Sunday; after which, unshaded by the sense of duties unperformed, he
would commence the ascent.

The claims of religion being thus met, the point of next importance,
that of money, was set at rest by my immediate acceptance of the tariff
published by the Chanoine Carrel. The problem being thus reduced to one
of muscular physics, we pondered the question of provisions, decided on
a bill of fare, and committed its execution to the industrious mistress
of the hotel.

A fog, impenetrable to vision, had filled the whole of the Val
Tournanche on Saturday night, and the mountains were half concealed
and half revealed by this fog when we rose on Sunday morning. The
east at sunrise was louring, and the light which streamed through the
cloud orifices was drawn in ominous red bars across the necks of the
mountains. It was one of those uncomfortable Laodicean days which
engender indecision--threatening, but not sufficiently so to warrant
postponement. Two guides and two porters were considered necessary
for the first day’s climb. A volunteer, moreover, attached himself to
our party, who carried a sheepskin as part of the furniture of the
cabin. To lighten their labour, the porters took a mule with them as
far as the quadruped could climb, and afterwards divided the load among
themselves. While they did so I observed the weather. The sun had risen
with considerable power, and had broken the cloud-plane to pieces. The
severed clouds gathered into masses more or less spherical, and were
rolled grandly over the ridges into Switzerland. Save for a swathe
of fog which now and then wrapped its flanks, the Matterhorn itself
remained clear, and strong hopes were raised that the progress of the
weather was in the right direction.

We halted at the base of the Tête du Lion, a bold precipice formed by
the sudden cutting down of the ridge which flanks the Val Tournanche
to the right. From its base to the Matterhorn stretches the Col du
Lion, crossed for the first time in 1860, by Mr. Hawkins, myself, and
our two guides. We were now beside a snow-gulley, which was cut by a
deep furrow along its centre, and otherwise scarred by the descent of
stones. Here each man arranged his bundle and himself so as to cross
the gulley in the minimum of time. The passage was safely made, a few
flying shingle only coming down upon us. But danger declared itself
where it was not expected. Joseph Maquignaz led the way up the rocks.
I was next, Pierre Maquignaz next, and last of all the porters.
Suddenly a yell issued from the leader: ‘_Cachez-vous!_’ I crouched
instinctively against the rock, which formed a by no means perfect
shelter, when a boulder buzzed past me through the air, smote the rocks
below me, and with a savage hum flew down to the lower glacier. Thus
warned, we swerved to an _arête_, and when stones fell afterwards they
plunged to the right or left of us.

In 1860 the great couloir which stretches from the Col du Lion
downwards was filled with a _névé_ of deep snow. But the atmospheric
conditions which have caused the glaciers of Switzerland to shrink so
remarkably during the last ten years[23] have swept away this _névé_.
We had descended it in 1860 hip-deep in snow, and I was now reminded of
its steepness by the inclination of its bed. Maquignaz was incredulous
when I pointed out to him the line of descent to which we had been
committed, in order to avoid the falling stones of the Tête du Lion.
Bennen’s warnings on the occasion were very emphatic, and I could
understand their wisdom now better than I did then.

[23] I should estimate the level of the Lower Grindelwald glacier, at
the point where it is usually entered upon to reach the Eismeer, to be
nearly one hundred feet vertically lower in 1867 than it was in 1856. I
am glad to find that the question of ‘Benchmarks’ to fix such changes
of level is now before the Council of the British Association.

When Mr. Hawkins and myself first tried the Matterhorn, a temporary
danger, sufficient to quell for a time the enthusiasm even of our
lion-hearted guide, was added to the permanent ones. Fresh snow had
fallen two days before; it had quite over-sprinkled the Matterhorn,
converting the brown of its crags into an iron-grey; this snow had
been melted and refrozen, forming upon the rocks an enamelling of
ice. Besides their physical front, moreover, in 1860, the rocks
presented a psychological one, derived from the rumour of their savage
inaccessibility. The crags, the ice, and the character of the mountain,
all conspired to stir the feelings. Much of the wild mystery has now
vanished, especially at those points which in 1860 were places of
virgin difficulty, but down which ropes now hang to assist the climber.
The intrinsic grandeur of the Matterhorn, however, cannot be effaced.

After some hours of steady climbing we halted upon a platform beside
the tattered remnant of one of the tents employed by me in 1862.
Here we sunned ourselves for an hour. We subsequently worked upward,
scaling the crags and rounding the bases of those wild and wonderful
rock-towers, into which the weather of ages has hewn the southern
ridge of the Matterhorn. The work required knowledge, but with a fair
amount of skill it is safe work. I can fancy nothing more fascinating
to a man given by nature and habit to such things than a climb alone
among these crags and precipices. He need not be _theological_, but,
if complete, the grandeur of the place would certainly fill him with
religious awe.

Looked at from Breuil, the Matterhorn presents two summits--the one,
the summit proper, a square rock-tower in appearance; the other, which
is really the end of a sharp ridge abutting against the rock-tower, an
apparently conical peak. On this peak Bennen and myself planted our
flagstaff in 1862. At some distance below it the mountain is crossed
by an almost horizontal ledge, always loaded with snow, which, from
its resemblance to a white necktie, has been called the _Cravate_.
On this ledge a cabin was put together in 1867. It stands above the
precipice where I quitted my rope in 1862. Up this precipice, by the
aid of a thicker--I will not say a stronger--rope, we now scrambled,
and, following the exact route pursued by Bennen and myself five years
previously, we came to the end of the Cravate. At some places the snow
upon the ledge fell steeply from its junction with the cliff; deep
step-cutting was also needed where the substance had been melted and
recongealed. The passage, however, was soon accomplished along the
Cravate to the cabin, which was almost filled with snow.

Our first need was water. We could, of course, always melt the snow,
but this would involve a wasteful expenditure of heat. The cliff at
the base of which the hut was built, overhung, and from its edge the
liquefied snow fell in showers beyond the cabin. Four ice-axes were
fixed on the ledge, and over them was spread the residue of a second
tent which I had left at Breuil in 1862. The water falling upon the
canvas flowed towards its centre. Here an orifice was made, through
which the liquid descended into vessels placed to receive it. Some
modification of this plan might probably be employed with profit for
the storing-up of water for droughty years in England.

I lay for some hours in the warm sunshine, in presence of the Italian
mountains, watching the mutations of the air. But when the sun sank
the air became chill, and we all retired to the cabin. We had no fire,
though warmth was much needed. A lover of the mountains, and of his
kind, had contributed an india-rubber mattrass, on which I lay down, a
light blanket being thrown over me, while the guides and porters were
rolled up in sheepskins. The mattrass was a poor defence against the
cold of the subjacent rock. I bore this for two hours, unwilling to
disturb the guides, but at length it became intolerable. On learning my
condition, however, the good fellows were soon alert, and, folding a
sheepskin round me, restored me gradually to a pleasant temperature. I
fell asleep, and found the guides preparing breakfast, and the morning
well advanced, when I opened my eyes.

It was past six o’clock when the two brothers and I quitted the cabin.
The porters deemed their work accomplished, but they halted for a
time to ascertain whether we were likely to be driven back or to push
forward. We skirted the Cravate, and reached the ridge at its western
extremity. This we ascended along the old route of Bennen and myself
to the conical peak already referred to, which, as seen from Breuil,
constitutes a kind of second summit of the Matterhorn. From this
point to the base of the final precipice of the mountain stretches an
_arête_, terribly hacked by the weather, but on the whole horizontal.
When I first made the acquaintance of this savage ridge--called by
Italians the Spalla--it was almost clear of snow. It was now loaded,
the snow being bevelled to an edge of exceeding sharpness. The slope
to the left, falling towards Zmutt, was exceedingly steep, while the
precipices on the right were abysmal. No other part of the Matterhorn
do I remember with greater interest than this. It was terrible, but
its difficulties were fairly within the grasp of human skill, and this
association is more ennobling than where the circumstances are such as
to make you conscious of your own helplessness. On one of the sharpest
teeth of the ridge Joseph Maquignaz halted, and, turning to me with a
smile, remarked, ‘There is no room for giddiness here, sir.’ In fact,
such possibilities, in such places, must be altogether excluded from
the chapter of accidents of the climber.

It was at the end of this ridge, where it abuts against the last
precipice of the Matterhorn, that my second flagstaff was left in 1862.
I think there must have been something in the light falling upon this
precipice that gave it an aspect of greater verticality when I first
saw it than it seemed to possess on the present occasion. We had,
however, been struggling for many hours previously, and may have been
dazed by our exertion. I cannot otherwise account for three of my party
declining flatly to make any attempt upon the precipice. It looks very
bad, but no real climber with his strength unimpaired would pronounce
it, without trial, insuperable. Fears of this rock-wall, however, had
been excited long before we reached it. It was probably the addition of
the psychological element to the physical--the reluctance to encounter
new dangers on a mountain which had hitherto inspired a superstitious
fear--that quelled further exertion.

Seven hundred feet, if the barometric measurement can be trusted, of
very difficult rock-work now lay above us. In 1862 this height had
been underestimated by both Bennen and myself. Of the 14,800 feet of
the Matterhorn, we then thought we had accomplished 14,600. If the
barometer speaks truly, we had only cleared 14,200.

Descending the end of the ridge, we crossed a narrow cleft, and
grappled with the rocks at the other side of it. Our ascent was
oblique, bearing to the right. The obliquity at one place fell to
horizontality, and we had to work on the level round a difficult
protuberance of rock. We cleared the difficulty without haste, and then
rose straight against the precipice. Above us a rope hung down the
cliff, left there by Maquignaz on the occasion of his first ascent. We
reached the end of this rope, and some time was lost by my guide in
assuring himself that it was not too much frayed by friction. Care in
testing it was doubly necessary, for the rocks, bad in themselves, were
here crusted with ice. The rope was in some places a mere hempen core
surrounded by a casing of ice, over which the hands slid helplessly.
Even with the aid of the rope in this condition it required an effort
to get to the top of the precipice, and we willingly halted there to
take a minute’s breath. The ascent was virtually accomplished, and a
few minutes more of rapid climbing placed us on the lightning-smitten
top. Thus ended the long contest between me and the Matterhorn.

The day thus far had swung through alternations of fog and sunshine.
While we were on the ridge below, the air at times was blank and chill
with mist; then with rapid solution the cloud would vanish, and open
up the abysses right and left of us. On our attaining the summit a fog
from Italy rolled over us, and for some minutes we were clasped by a
cold and clammy atmosphere. But this passed rapidly away, leaving above
us a blue heaven, and far below us the sunny meadows of Zermatt. The
mountains were almost wholly unclouded, and such clouds as lingered
amongst them only added to their magnificence. The Dent d’Érin, the
Dent Blanche, the Gabelhorn, the Mischabel, the range of heights
between it and Monte Rosa, the Lyskamm, and the Breithorn were all at
hand, and clear; while the Weisshorn, noblest and most beautiful of
all, shook out a banner towards the north, formed by the humid southern
air as it grazed the crest of the mountain.

The world of peaks and glaciers surrounding this immediate circlet
of giants was also open to us up to the horizon. Our glance over it
was brief, for it was eleven o’clock, and the work before us soon
claimed all our attention. I found the _débris_ of my former expedition
everywhere--below, the fragments of my tents, and on the top a piece
of my ladder fixed in the snow as a flagstaff. The summit of the
Matterhorn is a sharp horizontal _arête_, and along this we now moved
eastward. On our left was the roof-like slope of snow seen from the
Riffel and Zermatt; on our right were the savage precipices which fall
into Italy. Looking to the further end of the ridge, the snow there
seemed to be trodden down, and I drew my companions’ attention to the
apparent footmarks. As we approached the place it became evident that
human feet had been there two or three days previously. I think it
was Mr. Elliot of Brighton[24] who had made this ascent--the first
accomplished from Zermatt since 1865. On the eastern end of the ridge
we halted to take a little food--not that I seemed to need it: it was
the remonstrance of reason rather than the consciousness of physical
want that caused me to do so.

[24] Killed in 1869 upon the Schreckhorn.

We took our ounce of nutriment and gulp of wine (my only sustenance
during the entire day), and stood for a moment silently and earnestly
looking down towards Zermatt. There was a certain official formality
in the manner in which the guides turned to me and asked, ‘Êtes-vous
content d’essayer?’ A sharp responsive ‘Oui!’ set us immediately in
motion. It was nearly half-past eleven when we quitted the summit.
The descent of the roof-like slope already referred to offered no
difficulty; but the gradient very soon became more formidable.

One of the two faces of the Matterhorn pyramid, seen from Zermatt,
falls towards the Zmutt glacier, and has a well-known snow-plateau at
its base. The other face falls towards the Furgge glacier. We were
on the former. For some time, however, we kept close to the _arête_
formed by the intersection of the two faces of the pyramid, because
nodules of rock jutted from it which offered a kind of footing. These
rock protuberances helped us in another way: round them an extra rope
which we carried was frequently doubled, and we let ourselves down by
the rope as far as it could reach, liberating it afterwards (sometimes
with difficulty) by a succession of jerks. In the choice and use of
these protuberances the guides showed both judgment and skill. The
rocks became gradually larger and more precipitous, a good deal of
time being consumed in dropping down and doubling round them. Still we
preferred them to the snow-slope at our left as long as they continued
practicable.

This they at length ceased to be, and we had to commit ourselves to the
slope. It was in the worst possible condition. When snow first falls
at these great heights it is usually dry, and has no coherence. It
resembles, to some extent, flour, or sand, or sawdust. Shone upon by
a strong sun it partly melts, shrinks, and becomes more consolidated,
and when subsequently frozen it may be safely trusted. Even though
the melting of the snow and its subsequent freezing may be only very
partial, the cementing of the granules adds immensely to the safety of
the footing. Hence the advantage of descending such a slope before the
sun has had time to unlock the rigidity of the night’s frost. But we
were on the steepest Matterhorn slope during the two hottest hours of
the day, and the sun had done his work effectually. The layer of snow
was about fifteen inches thick. In treading it we came immediately
upon the rock, which in most cases was too smooth to furnish either
prop or purchase. It was on this slope that the Matterhorn catastrophe
occurred: it is on this slope that other catastrophes will occur, if
this mountain should ever become fashionable.

Joseph Maquignaz was the leader of our little party, and a brave, cool,
and competent leader he proved himself to be. He was silent, save when
he answered his brother’s anxious and oft-repeated question, ‘Es-tu
bien placé, Joseph?’ Along with being perfectly cool and brave, he
seemed to be perfectly truthful. He did not pretend to be ‘bien placé’
when he was not, nor avow a power of holding which he knew he did not
possess. Pierre Maquignaz is, I believe, under ordinary circumstances,
an excellent guide, and he enjoys the reputation of being never tired.
But in such circumstances as we encountered on the Matterhorn he is
not the equal of his brother. Joseph, if I may use the term, is a man
of high boiling point, his constitutional _sangfroid_ resisting the
ebullition of fear. Pierre, on the contrary, shows a strong tendency to
boil over in perilous places.

Our progress was exceedingly slow, but it was steady and continued. At
every step our leader trod the snow cautiously, seeking some rugosity
on the rock beneath it. This however was rarely found, and in most
cases he had to establish a mechanical attachment between the snow
and the slope which bore it. No semblance of a slip occurred in the
case of any one of us, and had it occurred I do not think the worst
consequences could have been avoided. I wish to stamp this slope of
the Matterhorn with the character that really belonged to it when I
descended it, and I do not hesitate to say that the giving way of any
one of our party would have carried the whole of us to ruin. Why, then,
it may be asked employ the rope? The rope, I reply, notwithstanding
all its possible drawbacks under such circumstances, is the safeguard
of the climber. Not to speak of the moral effect of its presence, an
amount of help upon a dangerous slope that might be measured by the
gravity of a few pounds is often of incalculable importance; and thus,
though the rope may be not only useless but disastrous if the footing
be clearly lost, and the glissade fairly begun, it lessens immensely
the chance of this occurrence.

With steady perseverance, difficulties upon a mountain, as elsewhere,
come to an end. We were finally able to pass from the face of the
pyramid to its rugged edge, where it was a great relief to feel that
honest strength and fair skill, which might have gone for little on the
slope, were masters of the situation.

Standing on the _arête_, at the foot of a remarkable cliff-gable seen
from Zermatt, and permitting the vision to range over the Matterhorn,
its appearance is exceedingly wild and impressive. Hardly two things
can be more different than the two aspects of the mountain from above
and below. Seen from the Riffel, or Zermatt, it presents itself as a
compact pyramid, smooth and steep, and defiant of the weathering air.
From above, it seems torn to pieces by the frosts of ages, while its
vast facettes are so foreshortened as to stretch out into the distance
like plains. But this underestimate of the steepness of the mountain is
checked by the deportment of its stones. Their discharge along the side
of the pyramid to-day was incessant, and at any moment, by detaching a
single boulder, we could let loose a cataract of them, which flew with
wild rapidity and with a thunderous clatter down the mountain. We once
wandered too far from the _arête_, and were warned back to it by a
train of these missiles sweeping past us.

As long as our planet yields less heat to space than she receives
from the bodies of space, so long will the forms upon her surface
undergo mutation, and as soon as equilibrium, in regard to heat,
has been established we shall have, as Thomson has pointed out, not
peace, but death. Life is the product and accompaniment of change,
and the self-same power that tears the flanks of the hills to pieces
is the mainspring of the animal and vegetable worlds. Still, there
is something chilling in the contemplation of the irresistible and
remorseless character of those infinitesimal forces, whose integration
through the ages pulls down even the Matterhorn. Hacked and hurt by
time, the aspect of the mountain from its higher crags saddened me.
Hitherto the impression that it made was that of savage strength, but
here we had inexorable decay.

This notion of decay, however, implied a reference to a period when
the Matterhorn was in the full strength of mountainhood. My thoughts
naturally ran back to its possible growth and origin. Nor did they
halt there, but wandered on through molten worlds to that nebulous
haze which philosophers have regarded, and with good reason, as the
proximate source of all material things. I tried to look at this
universal cloud, containing within itself the prediction of all that
has since occurred; I tried to imagine it as the seat of those forces
whose action was to issue in solar and stellar systems, and all that
they involve. Did that formless fog contain potentially the _sadness_
with which I regarded the Matterhorn? Did the _thought_ which now ran
back to it simply return to its primeval home? If so, had we not better
recast our definitions of matter and force? for if life and thought be
the very flower of both, any definition which omits life and thought
must be inadequate, if not untrue.

Questions like these, useless as they seem, may still have a practical
outcome. For if the final goal of man has not been yet attained, if his
development has not been yet arrested, who can say that such yearnings
and questionings are not necessary to the opening of a finer vision, to
the budding and the growth of diviner powers? Without this upward force
could man have risen to his present height? When I look at the heavens
and the earth, at my own body, at my strength and weakness of mind,
even at these ponderings, and ask myself, Is there no being or thing in
the universe that knows more about these matters than I do?--what is
my answer? Supposing our theologic schemes of creation, condemnation,
and redemption to be dissipated; and the warmth of denial which
they excite, and which, as a motive force, can match the warmth of
affirmation, dissipated at the same time; would the undeflected human
mind return to the meridian of absolute neutrality as regards these
ultra-physical questions? Is such a position one of stable equilibrium?
Such are the questions, without replies, which could run through
consciousness during a ten minutes’ halt upon the weathered spire of
the Matterhorn.

We shook the rope away from us, and went rapidly down the rocks. The
day was well advanced when we reached the cabin, and between it and the
base of the pyramid we missed our way. It was late when we regained
it, and by the time we reached the ridge of the Hörnli we were unable
to distinguish rock from ice. We should have fared better than we
did if we had kept along the ridge and felt our way to the Schwarz
See, whence there would have been no difficulty in reaching Zermatt,
but we left the Hörnli to our right, and found ourselves incessantly
checked in the darkness by ledges and precipices, possible and actual.
We were afterwards entangled in the woods of Zmutt, carving our way
wearily through bush and bramble, and creeping at times along dry and
precipitous stream-beds. But we finally struck the path and followed it
to Zermatt, which we reached between one and two o’clock in the morning.

Having work to do for the Norwich meeting of the British Association,
I remained several days at the Riffel, taking occasional breathings
with pleasant companions upon the Riffelhorn. I subsequently crossed
the Weissthor with Mr. Paris to Mattmark, and immediately afterwards
returned to England.

On the 4th of September, Signor Giordano, to whom we are indebted for
a very complete geological section of the Matterhorn, with Joseph
Maquignaz and Carrel as guides, followed my route over the mountain. In
a letter dated Florence, December 31, 1868, he writes to me thus:

‘Quant à moi, je dirai que vraiment, j’ai trouvé cette fois le pic
assez difficile.... J’ai surtout trouvé difficile la traversée de
l’arête qui suit le pic Tyndall du côté de l’Italie. Quant au versant
suisse, je l’ai trouvé moins difficile que je ne croyais, parce que la
neige y était un peu consolidée par la chaleur. En descendant le pic du
côté de Zermatt j’ai encouru un véritable danger par les avalanches de
pierres.... Un de mes deux guides a eu le havresac coupé en deux par un
bloc, et moi-même j’ai été un peu contusionné.’




XXV.

_ASCENT OF THE ALETSCHHORN._


The failure through bad weather of a former attempt upon the
Aletschhorn has been already recorded; but a succession of cloudless
days at the Bel Alp in August 1869 stirred up the desire to try again.
This was strengthened by the wish to make a series of observations from
the greatest accessible elevation on the colour and polarisation of the
sky. I had no guide of my own, but the Knecht at the hotel had been up
the mountain, and I thought that we two might accomplish the ascent
without any other assistance. It was the first time the mountain had
been attempted by a single guide, and I was therefore careful to learn
whether he was embarrassed by either doubt or fear. There was no doubt
or fear in the matter: he really wished to go with me. His master (the
proprietor of the hotel) had asked him whether he was not undertaking
too much. ‘I am undertaking no more than my companion,’ was his reply.

At twenty minutes past two we quitted the Bel Alp. The moon, which
seven hours previously had cleared the eastern mountain-tops with a
visible motion, was now sloping to the west. The light was white and
brilliant, and shadows of corresponding darkness were cast upon the
earth. The larger stars were out, those near the horizon especially
sparkling with many-coloured fires. The Pleiades were near the zenith,
while Orion hung his sword a few degrees above the eastern horizon. Our
path lay along the slope of the mountain, parallel to the Oberaletsch
glacier, the lateral moraine of which was close to us on our right.
After climbing sundry grass acclivities we mounted this moraine, and
made it our pathway for a time. At a certain point the shingly ridge
became depressed, opening a natural passage to the glacier. We found
the ice ‘hummocky,’ and therefore crossed it to a medial moraine
composed of granite _débris_ and loaded here and there with clean
granite blocks of enormous size. Beyond this moraine we found smoother
ice and better light, for we had previously journeyed in the shadow of
the mountains.

We marched upwards along the glacier chatting sociably at times, but at
times stilled into silence by the stillness of the night. ‘Es tagt!’
at length exclaimed my companion. It dawns! Orion had moved upwards,
leaving space between him and the horizon for the morning star. All the
east was belted by that ‘daffodil sky’ which in some states of the
atmosphere announces the approach of day in the Alps. We spun towards
the east. It brightened and deepened, but deeper than the orange of the
spectrum it did not fall. Amid this the mountains rose. Silently and
solemnly their dark and dented outlines rested against the dawn.

The mass of light thus thrown over the shaded earth long before the
sun appeared above the horizon came not from illuminated _clouds_, but
from matter far more attenuated than clouds--matter which maintains
comparative permanence in the atmosphere, while clouds are formed and
dissipated. It is not light reflected from concentric shells of air
of varying density, of which our atmosphere may be rightly assumed
to be made up; for the light reflected from these convex layers is
thrown, not upon the earth at all, but into space. The ‘rose of dawn’
is usually ascribed, and with sufficient correctness, to _transmitted_
light, the blue of the sky to _reflected_ light; but in each case
there is both transmission and reflection. No doubt the daffodil and
orange of the east this morning must have been transmitted through long
reaches of atmospheric air, and no doubt it was during this passage of
the rays that the selective winnowing of the light occurred which gave
the sky its tint and splendour. But if the distance of the sun below
the horizon when the dawn first appeared betaken into account, it will
become evident that the solar rays must have been caused to swerve
from their rectilineal course by _reflection_. The _refraction_ of
the atmosphere would be wholly incompetent to bend the rays round the
convex earth to the extent now under contemplation.

Thus the light which is reflected must be first transmitted to the
reflecting particles, while the transmitted light, except in the direct
line of the sun, must be reflected to reach the eyes. What mainly holds
the light in our atmosphere after the sun has retired behind the earth
is, I imagine, the suspended matter which produces the blue of the
sky and the morning and the evening red. Through the reverberation of
the rays from particle to particle, there must be at the very noon of
night a certain amount of illumination. Twilight must continue with
varying degrees of intensity all night long, and the visibility of the
nocturnal firmament itself may be due, not, as my excellent friend Dove
seems to assume, to the light of the stars, but in great part to the
light of the sun, scattered in all directions through the atmosphere by
the almost infinitely attenuated matter held there in suspension.

We had every prospect of a glorious day. To our left was the almost
full moon, now close to the ridge of the Sparrenhorn. The firmament was
as blue as ever I have seen it--deep and dark, and to all appearance
_pure_; that is to say, unmixed with any colour of a lower grade of
refrangibility than the blue. The lunar shadows had already become
weak, and were finally washed away by the light of the east. But while
the shadows were at their greatest depth, and therefore least invaded
by the dawn, I examined the firmament with a Nicol’s prism.[25] The
moonlight, as I have said, came from the left, and right in front of
me was a mountain of dark brown rock, behind which spread a heaven of
the most impressive depth and purity. I looked over the mountain-crest
through the prism. In one position of the instrument the blue was not
sensibly affected; in the rectangular position it was so far quenched
as to reduce the sky and the dark mountain beneath it to the same
uniform hue. The outline of the mountain could hardly be detached from
the sky above it. This was the direction in which the prism showed
its maximum quenching power; in no other direction was the extinction
of the light of the sky so perfect. And it was at right angles to the
lunar rays: so that, as regards the polarisation of the sky, the beams
of the moon behave exactly like those of the sun.

[25] Art. X. of ‘Fragments of Science’ is devoted to the sky.

The glacier along which we first marched was a trunk of many
tributaries, and consequently of many ‘medial moraines,’ such moraines
being always _one_ less in number than the tributaries.[26] But two
principal branches absorbed all the others as constituents. One of
these descended from the Great and Little Nesthorn and their spurs;
the other from the Aletschhorn. Up this latter branch we steered from
the junction. Hitherto the surface of the glacier, disintegrated by
the previous day’s sun, and again hardened by the night’s frost, had
crackled under our feet; but on the Aletschhorn branch the ice was
coated by a kind of fur, resembling the nap of velvet: it was as
soft as a carpet, but at the same time perfectly firm to the grip of
the boot. The sun was hidden behind the mountain; and, thus steeped
in shade, we could enjoy, with spirits unblunted by the heat, the
loveliness and grandeur of the scene.

[26] ‘Glaciers of the Alps,’ p. 264.

Right before us was the pyramid of the Aletschhorn, bearing its load
of glaciers, and thrusting above them its pinnacle of rock; while
right and left of us towered and fell to snowy cols such other peaks
as usually hang about a mountain of nearly 14,000 feet elevation. And
amid them all, with a calmness corresponding to the deep seclusion of
the place, wound the beautiful system of glaciers along which we had
been marching for nearly three hours. I know nothing which can compare
in point of glory with these winter palaces of the mountaineer, under
the opening illumination of the morning. And the best of it is, that no
right of property in the scene could enhance its value. To Switzerland
belongs the rock--to the early climber, competent to enjoy them, belong
the sublimity and beauty of mass, form, colour, and grouping. And still
the outward splendour is by no means all. ‘In the midst of a puddly
moor,’ says Emerson, ‘I am afraid to say how glad I am:’ which is a
strong way of affirming the influence of the inner man as regards the
enjoyment of external nature. And surely the inner man is a high factor
in the effect. The magnificence of the world outside suffices not. Like
light falling upon the polished plate of the photographer, the glory of
Nature, to be felt, must descend upon a soul prepared to receive its
image and superscription.

Mind, like force, is known to us only through matter. Take, then,
what hypothesis you will--consider matter as an instrument through
which the insulated mind exercises its powers, or consider both as so
inextricably mixed that they stand or fall together; from both points
of view the care of the body is equally important.[27] The morality
of clean blood ought to be one of the first lessons taught us by our
pastors and masters. The physical is the substratum of the spiritual,
and this fact ought to give the food we eat and to the air we breathe
a transcendental significance. Boldly and truly writes Mr. Ruskin,
‘Whenever you throw your window wide open in the morning, you let in
Athena, as wisdom and fresh air at the same instant; and whenever you
draw a pure, long, full breath of right heaven, you take Athena into
your heart, through your blood; and with the blood into thoughts of
the brain.’ No higher value than this could be assigned to atmospheric
oxygen.

[27] It will not be supposed that I here mean the stuffing or pampering
of the body. The shortening of the supplies, or a good monkish fast at
intervals, is often the best discipline for the body.

Precisely three hours after we had quitted our hotel the uniform
gradient of the Aletschhorn glacier came to an end. It now suddenly
steepened to run up the mountain. At the base we halted to have some
food, a huge slab of granite serving us for a table. It is not good to
go altogether without food in these climbing expeditions; nor is it
good to eat copiously. Here a little and there a little, as the need
makes itself apparent, is the prudent course. For, left to itself,
the stomach infallibly sickens, and the forces of the system ooze
away. Should the sickness have set in so as to produce a recoil from
nutriment, the stomach must be forced to yield. A small modicum of
food usually suffices to set it right. The strongest guides and the
sturdiest porters have sometimes to use this compulsion. ‘Sie müssen
sich zwingen.’ The guides refer the capriciousness of the stomach at
great elevations to the air. This may be _a_ cause, but I am inclined
to think that something is also due to the motion--the long-continued
action of the same muscles upon the diaphragm. The condition of things
antecedent to the journey must also be taken into account. There is
little, if any, sleep; the starting meal is taken at an unusual hour;
and if the start be made from a mountain cave or cabin, instead of
from the bed of an hotel, the deviation from normal conditions is
aggravated. It could not be the mere difference of height between
Mont Blanc and Monte Rosa which formerly rendered their effects upon
travellers so different. It is that, in the one case, you had the
melted snow of the Grands Mulets for your coffee, and a bare plank for
your bed; while in the other you had the comparative comforts of the
auberge on the Riffel. On the present occasion I had a bottle of milk,
which suits me better than anything else. That and a crust are all I
need to keep my vigour up and to ward off _le mal des montagnes_.

After half an hour’s halt we made ready for the peak, meeting first a
quantity of moraine matter mingled with patches of snow, and afterwards
the rifted glacier. We threaded our way among the crevasses, and here
I paid particular attention to the deportment of my guide. The want
of confidence, or rather the absence of that experience of a guide’s
powers, on which alone perfect reliance can be based, is a serious
drawback to the climber. This source of weakness has often come home to
me since the death of my brave friend Bennen. His loss to me was like
that of an arm to a fighter. But I was glad to notice that my present
guide was not likely to err on the score of rashness. He left a wider
margin between us and accident than I should have deemed necessary; he
sounded with his staff where I should have trod without hesitation;
and, knowing my own caution, I had good reason to be satisfied with
his. Still, notwithstanding all his vigilance, he once went into a
concealed fissure--only waist-deep, however, and he could certainly
have rescued himself without the tug of the rope which united us.

After some time we quitted the ice, striking a rocky shoulder of the
mountain. The rock had been pulled to pieces by the weather, and its
fragments heaped together to an incoherent ridge. Over the lichened
stones we worked our way, our course, though rough, being entirely
free from danger. On this ridge the sun first found us, striking us
at intervals, and at intervals disappearing behind the sloping ridge
of the Aletschhorn. We attained the summit of the rocks, and had now
the upper reaches of the _névé_ before us. To our left the glacier
was greatly torn, exposing fine vertical sections, deep blue pits
and chasms, which were bottomless to vision; and ledges, from whose
copings hung vaster stalactites than those observed below. The beauty
of the higher crevasses is mightily enhanced by the long transparent
icicles which hang from their eaves, and which, loosened by the
sun, fall into them with ringing sound. Above us was the customary
Bergschrund; but the spring avalanches had swept over it, and closed
it, and since the spring it had not been able to open its jaws. At this
schrund we aimed, reached it, and crossed it, and immediately found
ourselves at the base of the final cap of the mountain.

Looking at the Aletschhorn from the Sparrenhorn, or from any other
point which commands a similar view of the pyramid, we see upon the
ridge which falls from the summit to the right, and at a considerable
distance from the top, a tooth or pinnacle of rock, which encloses with
the ridge a deep indentation. At this gap we now aimed. We varied our
ascent from steep snow to rock, and from steep rock to snow, avoiding
the difficulties when possible, and facing them when necessary. We met
some awkward places, but none whose subjugation was otherwise than
pleasant, and at length surmounted the edge of the _arête_. Looking
over this, the facette of the pyramid fell almost sheer to the Middle
Aletsch glacier. This was a familiar sight to me, for years ago I had
strolled over it alone. Below it was the Great Aletsch, into which the
Middle Aletsch flows, and beyond both was the well-known ridge of the
Æggischhorn. We halted, but only for a moment. Turning suddenly to the
left, we ascended the rocky ridge to a sheltered nook which suggested a
brief rest and a slight renewal of that nutriment which, as stated, is
so necessary to the wellbeing of the climber.

From time to time during the ascent I examined the polarisation of the
sky. I should not have halted had not the fear of haze or clouds upon
the summit admonished me. Indeed, as we ascended, one thin, arrowy
cloud shot like a comet’s tail through the air above us, spanning
ninety degrees, or more, of the heavens. Never, however, have I
observed the sky of a deeper, darker, and purer blue. It was to examine
this colour that I ascended the Aletschhorn, and I wished to observe
it where the hue was deepest and the polarisation most complete. You
can look through very different atmospheric thicknesses at right angles
to the solar beams. When, for example, the sun is in the eastern
or western horizon, you can look across the sun’s rays towards the
northern or southern horizon, or you can look across them to the
zenith. In the latter direction the blue is deeper and purer than in
either of the former, the proportion of the polarised light of the sky
to its total light being also a maximum.

The sun, however, when I was on the Aletschhorn, was not in the
horizon, but high above it. I placed my staff upright on a platform of
snow. It cast a shadow. Inclining the staff _from_ the sun, the shadow
lengthened for a time, reached its major limit, and then shortened. The
simplest geometrical consideration will show that the staff when its
shadow was longest was perpendicular to the solar rays; the atmosphere
in this direction was shallower and the sky bluer than in any other
direction perpendicular to the same rays. Along this line I therefore
looked through the Nicol. The light, I found, could be quenched so as
to leave a residue as dark as the firmament upon a moonless night; but
still there _was_ a residue--the polarisation was not complete. Nor was
the colour, however pure its appearance, by any means a monochromatic
blue. A disc of selenite, gradually thickening from the centre to the
circumference, when placed between the Nicol and the sky, yielded vivid
_iris_ colours. The blue was very marked; but there was vivid purple,
which requires an admixture of red to produce it. There was also a
bright green, and some yellow. In fact, however purely blue the sky
might seem, it sent to the eye all the colours of the spectrum: it
owed its colour to the _predominance_ of blue, that is to say, to the
enfeeblement, and not to the extinction, of the other colours of the
spectrum. The green was particularly vivid in the portion of the sky
nearest to the mountains, where the light was ‘daffodil.’

A pocket spectroscope confirmed these results. Permitting the light
of an illuminated cloud to enter the slit of the instrument, a vivid
spectrum was observed; but on passing beyond the rim of the cloud to
the adjacent firmament, a sudden fall in the intensity of all the less
refrangible rays of the spectrum was observed. There was an absolute
shortening of the spectrum in the direction of the red, through the
total extinction of the extreme red. The fall in luminousness was also
very striking as far as the green; the blue also suffered, but not so
much as the other colours.

The scene as we ascended grew more and more superb, both as regards
grouping and expansion. Viewed from the Bel Alp the many-peaked Dom
is a most imposing mountain; it has there no competitor. The mass of
the Weisshorn is hidden, its summit alone appearing. The Matterhorn,
also, besides being more distant, has a portion of its pyramid cut
obliquely away by the slope of the same ridge that intercepts the
Weisshorn, and which is seen to our right when we face the valley of
the Rhone, falling steeply to the promontory called the Nessel. Viewed
from this promontory, the Dom finds its match, and more than its match,
in its mighty neighbour, whose hugeness is here displayed from top to
bottom. On the lower reaches of the Aletschhorn also the Dom maintains
its superiority, the Weisshorn being for a time wholly unseen, and
the Matterhorn but imperfectly. As we rise, however, the Dom steadily
loses its individuality, until from the ridge of the Aletschhorn it
is jumbled to a single leviathan heap with the mass of Monte Rosa.
The Weisshorn meanwhile as steadily gains in grandeur, rising like a
mountain Saul amid the congregated hills, until from the _arête_ it
distances all competitors. In comparison with this kingly peak, the
Matterhorn looks small and mean. It has neither the mass nor the form
which would enable it to compete, from a distant point of view, with
the Weisshorn.

The ridge of the Aletschhorn is of schistose gneiss; in many places
smooth, in all places steep, and sometimes demanding skill and strength
on the part of the climber. I thought we could scale it with greater
ease if untied, so I flung the rope away from me. My guide was in
front, and I carefully watched his action among the rocks. For some
time there was nothing to cause anxiety for his safety. There was no
likelihood of a slip, and if a slip occurred there was opportunity for
recovery. But after a time this ceased to be the case. The rock had
been scaled away by weathering parallel to the planes of foliation,
the surfaces left behind being excessively smooth, and in many cases
flanked by slopes and couloirs of perilous steepness. I saw that a slip
might occur here, and that its consequences would be serious. The rope
was therefore resumed.

A fair amount of skill and an absence of all precipitancy rendered our
progress perfectly secure. In every place of danger one of us planted
himself as securely as the rock on which he stood, and remained thus
fixed until the danger was passed by the other. Both of us were never
exposed to peril at the same moment. The bestowal of a little extra
time renders this arrangement possible along the entire ridge of the
Aletschhorn; in fact, the dangers of the Alps can be almost reduced to
the level of the dangers of the street by the exercise of skill and
caution. For rashness, ignorance, or carelessness the mountains leave
no margin; and to rashness, ignorance, or carelessness three-fourths
of the catastrophes which shock us are to be traced. Even those whose
faculties are ever awake in danger are sometimes caught napping when
danger seems remote; they receive accordingly the punishment of a tyro
for a tyro’s neglect.[28]

[28] See illustration at the end of this chapter.

While ascending the lower glacier we found the air in general crisp
and cool; but we were visited at intervals by gusts of Föhn--warm
breathings of the unexplained Alpine sirocco, which passed over
our cheeks like puffs from a gently heated stove. On the _arête_ we
encountered no Föhn; but the rocks were so hot as to render contact
with them painful. I left my coat among them, and went upward in my
shirt-sleeves. At our last bivouac my guide had allowed two hours for
the remaining ascent. We accomplished it in one, and I was surprised by
the shout which announced the passage of the last difficulty, and the
proximity of the top of the mountain. This we reached precisely eight
hours after starting--an ascent of fair rapidity, and without a single
mishap from beginning to end.

Rock, weathered to fragments, constitutes the crown of the Aletschhorn;
but against this and above it is heaped a buttress of snow, which
tapers, as seen from the Æggischhorn, to a pinnacle of surpassing
beauty. This snow was firm, and we readily attained its highest point.
Over this I leaned for ten minutes, looking along the face of the
pyramid, which fell for thousands of feet to the _névés_ at its base.
We looked _down_ upon the Jungfrau, and upon every other peak for miles
around us, one only excepted. The exception was the Finsteraarhorn, the
highest of the Oberland mountains, after which comes the Aletschhorn.
I could clearly track the course pursued by Bennen and myself eleven
years previously--the spurs of rock and slopes of snow, the steep and
weathered crest of the mountain, and the line of our swift glissade as
we returned.

Round about the dominant peak of the Oberland was grouped a crowd
of other peaks, retreating eastward to Graubünden and the distant
Engadin; retreating southward over Italy, and blending ultimately
with the atmosphere. At hand were the Jungfrau, Mönch, and Eiger. A
little further off the Blumlis Alp, the Weisse Frau, and the Great and
Little Nesthorn. In the distance the grim precipices of Mont Blanc,
rising darkly from the Allée Blanche, and lifting to the firmament
the snow-crown of the mountain. The Combin and its neighbours were
distinct; and then came that trinity of grandeur, with which the
reader is so well acquainted--the Weisshorn, the Matterhorn, and the
Dom--supported by the Alphubel, the Allaleinhorn, the Rympfischhorn,
the Strahlhorn, and the mighty Monte Rosa. From no other point in
the Alps have I had a greater command of their magnificence--perhaps
from none so great; while the blessedness of perfect health, on this
perfect day, rounded off within me the external splendour. The sun
seemed to take a pleasure in bringing out the glory of the hills.
The intermixture of light and shade was astonishing; while to the
whole scene a mystic air was imparted by a belt of haze, in which the
furthest outlines disappeared, as if infinite distance had rendered
them impalpable.

Two concentric shells of atmosphere, perfectly distinct in character,
clasped the earth this morning. That which hugged the surface was of
a deep neutral tint, too shallow to reach more than midway up the
loftier mountains. Upon this, as upon an ocean, rested the luminous
higher atmospheric layer, both being separated along the horizon by a
perfectly definite line. This higher region was without a cloud; the
arrowy streamer that had shot across the firmament during our ascent,
first reduced to feathery streaks, had long since melted utterly away.
Blue was supreme above, while all round the horizon the intrinsic
brilliance of the upper air was enhanced by contrast with the dusky
ground on which it rested. But this gloomier portion of the atmosphere
was also transparent. It was not a cloud-stratum cutting off the view
of things below it, but an attenuated mist, through which were seen,
as through a glass darkly, the lower mountains, and out of which the
higher peaks and ridges sprung into sudden glory.

Our descent was conducted with the same care and success that attended
our ascent. I have already stated it to be a new thing for one man
to lead a traveller up the mountain, and my guide in ascending had
informed me that his wife had been in a state of great anxiety about
him. But until he had cleared all dangers he did not let me know the
extent of her devotion, nor the means she had adopted to ensure his
safety. When we were once more upon the lower glacier, having left
all difficulties behind us, he remarked with a chuckle that she had
been in a terrible state of fear, and had informed him of her intention
to have a mass for his safety celebrated by the village priest. But
if he profited by this mediation, I must have done so equally; for in
all dangerous places we were tied together by a rope which was far too
strong to break had I slipped. My safety was, in fact, bound up in his,
and I therefore thought it right to pay my share of the expense. ‘How
much did the mass cost?’ I asked. ‘Oh, not much, sir,’ he replied;
‘only ninety centimes.’ Not deeming the expense worth dividing, I
let him pay for such advantage as I had derived from the priest’s
intercession.

       *       *       *       *       *

In 1868 I had been so much broken down on going to the Alps that
even amongst them I found it difficult to recover energy. In 1869,
however, after a severe discipline in bathing and climbing,[29] my
weariness disappeared, and before I attacked the Aletschhorn I felt
that my restoration was ensured. In my subsequent rambles it was a
great delight and refreshment to me, whenever I felt heated, to
choose a bubbling pool in some mountain stream, roll myself in it,
and afterwards dance myself dry in the sunshine. Each morning I had
a tub in a rivulet, a header in a lake, or a douche under a cascade.
The best of these was half a mile or more from the hotel, but there
was an inferior waterfall close at hand to which I resorted when time
was short. On a bright morning towards the end of August 1869 I was
returning from this cascade to my clothes, which were about twenty
yards off. They might have been reached by walking on the grass, but I
chose to walk on some slippery blocks of gneiss, and using no caution
I staggered and fell. My shin was urged with great force against the
sharp crystals, which inflicted three ugly wounds; but I sponged the
blood away, wrapped a cold bandage round the injured place, and limped
to the hotel. I was quite disabled, but felt sure of speedy recovery,
my health was so strong.

[29] In 1869 I tried to get to the top of the Wetterhorn in a single
day from Grindelwald, but the wildness of the storm and the bitterness
of the cold drove Peter Baumann and me back, when we were within a
quarter of an hour of the top. I was afterwards in the habit of taking
to the Riffel See when heavy snow was falling. It was at the Bel Alp,
however, that I found myself renewed.

For four or five days I remained quietly in bed. The wound had become
entirely painless; there was hardly any inflammation and no pus. I felt
so well that I thought a little exercise would do me less harm than
good. I abandoned my cold bandage and went out. That night inflammation
set in, pus appeared, and in trying to dislodge it I poisoned the
wound. It became worse and worse; erysipelas set in, and at last it
became evident that I might lose my foot or something more important.
After remaining nearly a fortnight at the Bel Alp without medical
advice I resolved to go to Geneva. I wrote accordingly to my friend
Professor De la Rive, with the view of securing the services of an able
surgeon. I was carried down to Brieg on a kind of bier, and midway on
the mountain-slope had the good fortune to meet Mr. Ellis of Sloane
Street. He examined my wound, and I have good reason to feel grateful
to him for his extreme kindness and his excellent advice. My friend
Soret met me at the railway station, and Dr. Gauthier was at my side a
few seconds after I entered my hotel.

But, despite all the care, kindness, and real skill bestowed upon me, I
was a month in bed at Geneva. A sinus about five inches long had worked
its channel from the wound down to the instep, which was undermined by
an abscess. This Dr. Gauthier discovered and by assiduous attention
cured. In her beautiful residence at Lammermor, on the margin of Lake
Leman, Lady Emily Peel had a bed erected for me as soon as I was
able to go there, and it was under her roof that the last traces of
the sinus disappeared. I was so emaciated, however, that it required
several months to restore the flesh and the strength that this paltry
accident cost me.

In 1870 I was again at the Bel Alp for several weeks, during which
my interest was continually kept awake by telegrams from the seat of
war; for the enterprising proprietors both at the Bel Alp and the
Æggischhorn had run telegraphic wires from the valley of the Rhone up
to their respective hotels. The most noteworthy occurrence among the
mountains in 1870 was a terrific thunderstorm, which set two forests on
fire by the same discharge. One fire near the Rieder Alp was speedily
quenched; the other, under the Nessel, burned for several successive
days and nights, and threatened to become a public calamity. A constant
fiery glow was kept up by the combustion of the underwood, which
formed the vehicle of transmission among the larger trees. Three or
four of these would often burst simultaneously into pyramids of flame,
which would last but a few minutes, leaving the trees with all their
branches as red-hot embers behind. Heavy and persistent rain at length
extinguished the conflagration.




XXVI.

_A DAY AMONG THE SÉRACS OF THE GLACIER DU GÉANT FOURTEEN YEARS AGO._


Having fixed my head-quarters at the Montanvert, I was engaged for
nearly six weeks during the summer of 1857 in making observations
on the Mer de Glace and its tributaries. Throughout this time I had
the advantage of the able and unremitting assistance of my friend
Mr. Hirst, who kindly undertook, in most cases, the measurement of
the motion of the glacier. My permanent guide, Édouard Simond, an
intelligent and trustworthy man, was assistant on these occasions, and
having arranged with Mr. Hirst the measurements required to be made,
it was my custom to leave the execution of them to him, and to spend
much of my time alone upon the glaciers. Days have thus been occupied
amid the confusion of the Glacier du Géant, at the base of the great
ice-fall of La Noire, in trying to connect the veined structure of
the glacier with the stratification of its _névé_; and often, after
wandering almost unconsciously from peak to peak and from hollow to
hollow, I have found myself, as the day was waning, in places from
which it required a sound axe and a vigorous stroke to set me free.

This practice gradually developed my powers of dealing with the
difficulties of the glacier. On some occasions, however, I found the
assistance of a companion necessary, and it was then my habit to take
with me a hardy boy named Balmat, who was attached to the hotel at the
Montanvert. He could climb like a cat, and one of our first expeditions
together was an ascent to a point above Trélaporte, from which a
magnificent view of the entire glacier is obtained. This point lies
under the Aiguille de Charmoz, and to the left of a remarkable cleft,
which is sure to attract the traveller’s attention on looking upwards
from the Montanvert. We reached the place through a precipitous couloir
on the Montanvert side of the mountain; and while two chamois watched
us from the crags above, we made our observations, and ended our survey
by pledging the health of Forbes and other explorers of the Alps.

We descended from the eminence by a different route; during both
ascent and descent I had occasion to admire the courage and caution
of my young companion, and the extraordinary cohesive force by
which he clung to the rock. He, moreover, evidently felt himself
responsible for my safety, and once when I asserted my independence
so far as to attempt descending a kind of ‘chimney,’ which, though
rather dangerous-looking, I considered to be practicable, he sprang
to my side, and, with outstretched arm and ringing voice, exclaimed,
‘Monsieur, je vous défends de passer par là!’

Anxious to avoid the inconvenience of the rules of the Chamouni guides,
my aim, from the first, was to render myself as far as possible
independent of their assistance. Wishing to explore the slopes of the
Col du Géant, not for the purpose of crossing into Piedmont, but to
examine the fine ice-sections which it exhibits, and to trace amid its
chasms the gradual conversion of the snow into ice, I at first thought
of attempting the ascent of the col alone; but ‘le petit Balmat,’ as
my host at the Montanvert always named him, acquitted himself so well
on the occasion referred to that I thought he would make a suitable
companion. On naming the project to him he eagerly embraced my
proposal; in fact, he said he was willing to try Mont Blanc with me if
I desired it.

On the morning of Friday, July 24, we accordingly set off for the
Tacul, I making, as we ascended, such few observations as lay in
our way. The sun shone gloriously upon the mountains, and gleamed
by reflection from the surface of the glacier. Looked at through a
pair of very dark spectacles, the scene was exceedingly striking and
instructive. Terraces of snow clung to the mountains, exposing, here
and there, high vertical sections, which cast dense shadows upon the
adjacent plateaux. The glacier was thrown into heaps and ‘hummocks,’
their tops glistening with white, silvery light, and their sides
intensely shaded. When the lateral light was quite shut out, and all
that reached the eyes had to pass through the spectacles, the contrast
between light and shade was much stronger than when the glacier was
viewed by the broad light of day. In fact, the shadows were no longer
grey merely, but black; to a similar augmentation of contrast towards
the close of the day is to be referred the fact that the ‘Dirt Bands’
of the Mer de Glace are best seen by twilight.

A gentleman had started in the morning to cross the col, accompanied
by two strong guides. We met a man returning from the Jardin, who
told us that he had seen the party that preceded us; that they had
been detained a long time amid the séracs, and that our ascending
without ladders was quite out of the question. As we approached the
Tacul, my lynx-eyed little companion ranged with the telescope over
the snowy slopes of the col, and at length exclaimed, ‘Je les vois,
tous les trois!’--the ‘Monsieur’ in the middle, and a guide before
and behind. They seemed like three black specks upon the shoulders of
the Giant; below them was the vast ice-cascade, resembling the foam
of ten Niagaras placed end to end and stiffened into rest, while the
travellers seemed to walk upon a floor as smooth as polished Carrara
marble. Here and there, however, its uniformity was broken by vertical
faults, exposing precipices of the stratified _névé_.

On an old moraine near the Tacul, piled up centuries ago by the
Glacier de Léchaud, immense masses of granite are thrown confusedly
together; and one enormous slab is so cast over a number of others
as to form a kind of sheltered grotto, which we proposed to make
our resting-place for the night. Having deposited our loads here, I
proceeded to the icefall of the Talèfre, while my companion set out
towards the Couvercle in search of firewood. I walked round the base
of the frozen cascade, and climbed up among its riven pinnacles,
examining the structure as I ascended. The hollow rumble of the rocks
as they fell into the crevasses was incessant. From holes in the
ice-cliffs clear cataracts gushed, coming I knew not whence, and going
I knew not whither. Sometimes the deep gurgle of sub-glacial water
was heard, far down in the ice. The resonance of the water as it fell
into shafts struck me suddenly at intervals on turning corners, and
seemed, in each case, as if a new torrent had bounded into life.
Streams flowed through deep channels which they themselves had worn,
revealing beautifully the ‘rib-boned structure.’ At the further end of
the Glacier de Léchaud the Capucin Rock stood, like a preacher; and
below him a fantastic group of granite pinnacles suggested the idea
of a congregation. The outlines of some of the ice-cliffs were also
very singular; and it needed but a slight effort of the imagination to
people the place with natural sculpture.

At six o’clock the shrill whistle of my companion announced that
our time of meeting was come. He had found some wood--dry twigs of
rhododendrons, and a couple of heavy stumps of juniper. I shouldered
the largest of the latter, while he strapped his twigs on his back, and
led the way to the Tacul. The sun shot his oblique rays against us over
the heights of Charmoz, and cast our shadows far up the glacier. We
filled our saucepan, which Balmat named ‘a machine,’ with clear water,
and bore it to our cavern, where the fire was soon crackling under the
machine. I was assailed by the smoke, which set my eyes dripping tears;
but this cleared away when the fire brightened, and we boiled our
chocolate and made a comfortable evening meal.

I afterwards clambered up the moraine to watch the tints of the setting
sun; clouds floated round the Aiguille de Charmoz, and were changed
from grey to red, and from red to grey, as their positions varied. The
shadows of the isolated peaks and pinnacles were drawn, at times, in
black bands across the clouds; and the Aiguille du Moine smiled and
frowned alternately. One high snow-peak alone enjoyed the unaltered
radiance of the sinking day; the sunshine never forsook it, but glowed
there, like the steady light of love, while a kind of coquetry was
carried on between the atmosphere and the surrounding mountains. The
notched summits of the Grande and Petite Jorasse leaned peacefully
against the blue firmament. The highest mountain-crags were cleft, in
some cases, into fantastic forms; single pillars stood out from all
else, like lonely watchers, over the mountain scene; while little red
clouds playfully embraced them at intervals, and converted them into
pillars of fire.

The sun at length departed, and all became cold and grey upon the
mountains; but a brief secondary glow came afterwards, and warmed up
the brown cliffs once more. I descended the moraine, the smell of the
smoke guiding me towards the rock under which I was to pass the night.
A fire was burning at the mouth of the grotto, reddening with its glare
the darkness of the interior. Beside the fire sat my little companion,
with a tall, conical, red night-cap drawn completely over his ears; our
saucepan was bubbling on the fire; he watched it meditatively, adding
at times a twig, which sprung immediately into flame, and strengthened
the glow upon his countenance. He looked, in fact, more like a demon
of the ice-world than a being of ordinary flesh and blood. I had been
recommended to take a bit of a tallow candle with me to rub my face
with, as a protection against the sun; by the light of this we spread
our rugs, lay down upon them, and wrapped them round us.

The countless noises heard upon the glacier during the day were
now stilled, and dead silence ruled the ice-world; the roar of an
occasional avalanche, however, shooting down the flanks of Mont Mallet
broke upon us with startling energy. I did not sleep till towards four
o’clock in the morning, when I dozed and dreamed, and mingled my actual
condition with my dream. When I awoke, I found my head weary enough
upon the clay of the old moraine, my ribs pressed closely against
a block of granite, and my feet amid sundry fragments of the same
material. It was nearly five o’clock on Saturday the 25th when I arose;
my companion quickly followed my example. He also had slept but little,
and once or twice during the night I fancied I could feel him shiver.
We were, however, well protected from the cold. The high moraine of the
Glacier du Léchaud was on one side, that of the Glacier du Géant on
the other, while the cliffs of Mont Tacul formed the third side of a
triangle, which sheltered us from the sharper action of the wind. At
times the calm was perfect, and I felt almost too warm; then again a
searching wind would enter the grotto, and cause the skin to shrink on
all exposed parts of the body. It had frozen hard, and to obtain water
for washing I had to break through a sheet of ice which coated one of
the pools upon the glacier.

In a few minutes our juniper fire was crackling cheerily; we made our
chocolate and breakfasted. My companion emptied the contents of a small
brandy bottle into my flask, which, however, was too small to hold it
all, and on the principle, I suppose, of avoiding waste, he drank what
remained. It was not much, but sufficient to muddle his brain, and to
make him sluggish and drowsy for a time. We put the necessary food in
our knapsacks and faced our task, first ascending the Glacier du Tacul
along its eastern side, until we came to the base of the séracs.

The vast mass of snow collected on the plateau of the Col du Géant, and
compressed to ice by its own weight, reaches the throat of the valley,
which stretches from the rocks called Le Rognon to the promontory of
the Aiguille Noire. Through this defile it is forced, falling steeply,
and forming one of the grandest ice-cascades in the Alps. At the
summit it is broken into transverse chasms of enormous width and depth;
the ridges between these break across again, and form those castellated
masses to which the name of _séracs_ has been applied. In descending
the cascade the ice is crushed and riven; ruined towers, which have
tumbled from the summit, cumber the slope, and smooth vertical
precipices of ice rise in succession out of the ruins. At the base of
the fall the fragments are again squeezed together, but the confusion
is still great, the glacier being tossed into billowy shapes, scooped
into caverns, and cut into gorges by torrents which expand here and
there into deep green lakes.

Across this portion of the glacier we proceeded westward, purposing to
attempt the ascent at the Rognon side.[30] Perils and difficulties soon
began to thicken round us. The confusion of ice-pinnacles, crags, and
chasms was very bewildering. Plates of ice jutted from the glacier
like enormous fins, up the sides of which we had to rise by steps, and
along the edges of which we had to walk. Often, while perched upon
these eminences, we were flanked right and left by crevasses, the depth
of which might be inferred from their impenetrable gloom. At some
places forces of extreme complexity had acted on the mass; the ridges
were broken into columns, and some of these were twisted half round;
while the chasms were cut up into shafts which resembled gigantic
honeycombs. Our work was very difficult, sometimes disheartening:
nevertheless, our inspiration was, that what man has done man may do,
and we accordingly persevered. My fellow-traveller was silent for a
time: the brandy had its effect upon him, and he confessed it; but
I thought that a contact with the cold ice would soon cause this to
disappear, after which I resolved not to influence his judgment in the
least.

[30] Standing here alone, on another occasion, I heard the roar of
what appeared to be a descending avalanche, but the duration of the
sound surprised me. I looked through my opera glass in the direction
from which the sound proceeded, and saw issuing from the end of one
of the secondary glaciers on the side of Mont Tacul a torrent of
what appeared to me to be stones and mud. I could see the rocks and
_débris_ jumping down the declivities, and forming singular cascades.
The noise continued for a quarter of an hour, when the descending
torrent diminished until the ordinary stream, due to the melting of the
glacier, alone remained. A sub-glacial lake had evidently burst its
bounds, and carried the _débris_ along with it in its rush downwards.

Looking now to the right, I suddenly became aware that, high above
us, a multitude of unstable crags and leaning columns of ice covered
the precipitous incline. We had reached a position where protecting
cliffs rose to our right, while in front of us was a space more open
than any we had yet passed. The reason was that the ice avalanches had
chosen it for their principal path. We had stepped upon this space when
a peal above us brought us to a stand. Crash! crash! crash! nearer
and nearer, the sound becoming more continuous and confused, as the
descending masses broke into smaller blocks. Onward they came! boulders
half a ton and more in weight, leaping down with a kind of maniacal
fury, as if their sole mission was to crush the séracs to powder. Some
of them on striking the ice rebounded like elastic balls, described
parabolas through the air, again smote the ice, and scattered its
dust like clouds in the atmosphere. Deflected by their collision with
the glacier, some blocks were carried past us within a few yards of
the spot where we stood. I had never before witnessed an exhibition
of force at all comparable to this, and its proximity rendered that
fearful which at a little distance would have been sublime.

My companion held his breath, and then exclaimed, ‘C’est terrible!
il faut retourner.’ In fact, while the avalanche continued we could
not at all calculate upon our safety. When we heard the first peal we
had instinctively retreated to the shelter of the ice bastions; but
what if one of these missiles struck the tower beside us! would it be
able to withstand the shock? We knew not. In reply to the proposal
of my companion, I simply said, ‘By all means, if you desire it; but
let us wait a little.’ I felt that fear was just as bad a counsellor
as rashness, and thought it but fair to wait until my companion’s
terror had subsided. We waited accordingly, and he seemed to gather
courage and assurance. I scanned the heights and saw that a little more
effort in an upward direction would place us in a much less perilous
position, as far as the avalanches were concerned. I pointed this out
to my companion, and we went forward. Once indeed, for a minute or
two, I felt anxious. We had to cross in the shadow of a tower of ice,
of a loose and threatening character, which quite overhung our track.
The freshly broken masses at its base, and at some distance below it,
showed that it must have partially given way some hours before. ‘Don’t
speak or make any noise,’ said my companion; and, although rather
sceptical as to the influence of speech in such a case, I held my
tongue and escaped from the dangerous vicinity as fast as my legs and
alpenstock could carry me.

Unbroken spaces, covered with snow, now began to spread between the
crevasses; these latter, however, became larger, and were generally
placed end to end _en échelon_. When, therefore, we arrived at the edge
of a chasm, by walking along it we usually soon reached a point where
a second one joined on it. The extremities of the chasms ran parallel
to each other for some distance, one being separated from the other,
throughout this distance, by a wall of incipient ice, coped at the top
by snow. At other places, however, the lower portion of the partition
between the fissures had melted away, leaving the chasm spanned by a
bridge of snow, the capacity of which to bear us was often a matter
of delicate experiment. Over these bridges we stepped as lightly as
possible: ‘Allez doucement ici,’ was the perpetual admonition of my
companion, ‘et il faut toujours sonder.’

In many cases, indeed, we could not at all guess at the state of
matters underneath the covering of snow. We had picked up a few hints
upon this subject, but neither of us was at this time sufficiently
experienced to make practical use of them. The ‘sounding’ too was
rather weary work, as, to make it of any value, the bâton must be
driven into the snow with considerable force. Further up in the _névé_
the fissures became less frequent, but some of them were of great
depth and width. On those silent heights there is something peculiarly
solemn in the aspect of the crevasses, yawning gloomily day and night,
as if with a never-satisfied hunger. We stumbled on the skeleton of
a chamois, which had probably met its death by falling into a chasm,
and been disgorged lower down. But a thousand chamois between these
cavernous jaws would not make a mouthful. I scarcely knew which to
choose--these pitfalls of the _névé_, or the avalanches. The latter are
terrible, but they are grand, outspoken things; the ice crags proclaim
from their heights, ‘Do not trust us; we are momentary and merciless.’
They wear the aspect of hostility undisguised; but these chasms of
the _névé_ are typified by the treachery of the moral world, hiding
themselves under shining coverlets of snow, and compassing their ends
by dissimulation.

After some time we alighted on the trace of those who had crossed the
day before. The danger was over when we made the discovery, but it
saved us some exploring amid the crevasses which still remained. We at
length got quite clear of the fissures and mounted zigzag to the summit
of the col. Clouds drove up against us from the valley of Courmayeur,
but they made no way over the col. At the summit they encountered a
stratum of drier air, mixing with which they were reduced, as fast as
they came, to a state of invisible vapour. Upon the very top of the col
I spread my plaid, and with the appetites of hungry eagles we attacked
our chicken and mutton. I examined the snow and made some experiments
on sound; but little Balmat’s feet were so cold that he feared being
frostbitten, and at his entreaty we started on our descent again as
soon as possible.

To the top of the séracs we retraced the course by which we had
ascended, but here we lost the track, for there was no snow to retain
it. A new lesson was before us. We kept nearer to the centre of the
glacier than when we ascended, thereby avoiding the avalanches, but
getting into ice more riven and dislocated. We were often utterly
at a loss how to proceed. My companion made several attempts to
regain the morning’s track, preferring to risk the avalanches rather
than be blocked and ditched up in an ice-prison from which we saw
no means of escape. Wherever we turned peril stared us in the face;
but the recurrence of danger had rendered us callous to it, and this
indifference gave a mechanical surety to the step in places where such
surety was the only means of avoiding destruction. Once or twice, while
standing on the summit of a peak of ice, and looking at the pits and
chasms beneath me, at the distance through which we had hewn our way,
and at the work still to be accomplished, I experienced an incipient
flush of terror. But this was immediately drowned in action. Indeed the
case was so bad, the necessity for exertion so paramount, that the will
acquired an energy which crushed out terror. We proceeded, however,
with the most steady watchfulness. When we arrived at a difficulty
which seemed insuperable, we calmly inspected it, looking at it on all
sides; and though we had often to retrace our steps amid cliffs and
chasms, still formidable obstacles repeatedly disappeared before our
cool and searching examination. We made no haste, we took no rest,
but ever tended downwards. With all our instincts of self-preservation
awake, we crossed places which, without the spur of necessity to drive
us, we should have deemed impassable.

Once, having walked for some distance along the edge of a high wedge of
ice, we had to descend its left face in order to cross a crevasse. The
ice was of that loose granular character which causes it to resemble an
aggregate of little polyhedrons jointed together more than a coherent
solid. I was not aware that the substance was so utterly disintegrated
as it proved to be. To aid me in planting my foot securely on the edge
of the crevasse, I laid hold of a projecting corner of the ice. It
crumbled to pieces in my hand; I tottered for a moment in the effort
to regain my balance, my footing gave way, and I went into the chasm.
I heard my companion scream, ‘O! mon Dieu, il est perdu!’ but a ledge
about two feet wide jutted from the side of the crevasse; and this
received me, my fall not amounting to more than three or four feet.
A block of ice which partially jammed up the chasm concealed me from
Balmat. I called to him, and he responded by another exclamation, ‘O!
mon Dieu, comme j’ai peur!’ He helped me up, and, looking anxiously in
my face, demanded ‘N’avez-vous pas peur?’ Afterwards the difficulties
lessened by degrees, and we began to gladden ourselves by mutual
expressions of ‘content’ with what we had accomplished. We at length
reached the base of the séracs; ordinary crevasses were trivial in
comparison with those from which we had escaped, so we hastened along
the glacier, without halting, to the Tacul.

Here a paltry accident caused me more damage than all the dangers of
the day. I was passing a rock, the snow beside it seemed firm, and I
placed my bâton upon it, leaning trustfully upon the staff. Through the
warmth of the rock, or some other cause, the snow had been rendered
hollow underneath; it yielded, I fell forward, and although a cat-like
capacity of helping myself in such cases saved me from serious hurt, it
did not prevent my knee from being urged with all my weight against an
edge of granite. I rested for half an hour in our grotto at the Tacul,
and afterwards struggled lamely along the Mer de Glace home to the
Montanvert. Bloodshot eyes, burnt cheeks, and blistered lips were the
result of the journey, but these soon disappeared, and fresh strength
was gained for further action.

The above account was written on the day following the ascent, and
while all its incidents were fresh in my memory. Last September, guided
by the tracks of previous travellers, I ascended nearly to the summit
of the ice-fall, along its eastern side, and to those acquainted only
with such dangers as I then experienced the account which I have just
given must appear exaggerated. I can only say that the track which I
pursued in 1858 bore no resemblance in point of difficulty to that
which I followed in 1857. The reason probably is, that in my first
expedition neither myself nor my companion knew anything of the route,
and we were totally destitute of the adjuncts which guides commonly use
in crossing the ‘Grand Col.’




NOTES AND COMMENTS

ON

ICE AND GLACIERS

AND OTHER SCRAPS.


VOYAGE TO ALGERIA TO OBSERVE THE ECLIPSE.




I.

_OBSERVATIONS ON THE MER DE GLACE._


The law established by Forbes and Agassiz, that the central portions
of a glacier moved faster than the sides, was amply illustrated and
confirmed by the deportment of lines of stakes placed across the
Mer de Glace and its tributaries in 1857. The portions of the trunk
glacier derived from these tributaries were easily traceable throughout
the glacier by means of the _moraines_. Thus, for example, the
portion of the trunk stream derived from the Glacier du Géant might
be distinguished in a moment from the other portions by the absence
of _débris_ upon its surface. Attention was drawn by Prof. Forbes
to the fact that the eastern side of the Mer de Glace in particular
is ‘excessively crevassed;’ and he accounted for this crevassing by
supposing that the Glacier du Géant moves most swiftly, and in its
effort to drag its more sluggish companions along with it tears them
asunder, thus producing the fissures and dislocation for which the
eastern side of the glacier is remarkable. Too much weight must not be
attached to this explanation. It was one of those suggestions which
are perpetually thrown out by men of science during the course of an
investigation, and the fulfilment or non-fulfilment of which cannot
materially affect the merits of the investigator. Indeed, the merits of
Forbes must be judged on far broader grounds. The qualities of mind and
the physical culture invested in his ‘Travels in the Alps’ are such as
to make it, in the estimation of the physical investigator at least,
outweigh all other books upon the subject.

While thus acknowledging its merits, however, let a free and frank
comparison of its statements with facts be instituted. To test whether
the Glacier du Géant moved more quickly than its fellows, _five
different lines_ were set out across the Mer de Glace, in the vicinity
of the Montanvert. In each case it was found that the point of swiftest
motion did not lie upon the Glacier du Géant at all, but was displaced
so as to bring it comparatively close to the eastern side of the
glacier. But though the special opinion of Forbes just referred to here
falls to the ground, the deviation of the point of swiftest motion from
the centre of the glacier will probably, when its cause is pointed out,
be regarded as of special importance to his theory.

At the place where these five lines were run across it the glacier
turns its convex curvature to the eastern side of the valley, being
concave towards the Montanvert. Let us then take a bolder analogy than
even that suggested in the explanation of Forbes, where he compares the
Glacier du Géant to a strong and swiftly flowing river. Let us enquire
how a river, would behave in sweeping round a curve similar to that
here existing. The point of swiftest motion would undoubtedly lie on
that side of the centre of the stream towards which it turns its convex
curvature. Can this be the case with the trunk of the Mer de Glace? If
so, then we ought to have a shifting of the point of maximum motion
towards the eastern side of the valley, when the curvature of the
glacier so changes as to turn its convexity to the western side.

Now, such a change of flexure actually occurs opposite the passages
called _Les Ponts_, and at this place the view just enunciated was
tested. It was immediately ascertained that the point of swiftest
motion here lay at a different side of the axis from that observed
lower down. But to confer strict numerical accuracy upon the result,
stakes were fixed at certain distances from the western side of the
glacier, and others _at equal distances_ from the eastern side. The
velocities of these stakes were compared with each other, two by two,
a stake on the western side being always compared with a second one
which stood at the same distance from the eastern side. The results of
this measurement are given in the following table, the numbers denoting
inches:

           1st pair   2nd pair   3rd pair   4th pair   5th pair

  West      15         17-1/4     22-1/4     23-3/4     23-3/4
  East      12-1/2     15-1/4     15-1/2     18-1/4     19-1/2

It is here seen that in each case the _western_ stake moved more
swiftly than its eastern fellow stake; thus proving, beyond a doubt,
that opposite the Ponts the western side of the Mer de Glace moves
swiftest--a result precisely the reverse of that observed where the
curvature of the valley was different.

But an additional test of the explanation is possible. Between the
Ponts and the promontory of Trélaporte the glacier passes another
point of contrary flexure, its convex curvature opposite to Trélaporte
being turned towards the base of the Aiguille du Moine, on the eastern
side. A series of stakes was placed across the glacier here; and the
velocities of those placed at certain distances from the western side
were compared, as before, with those of stakes placed at the same
distances from the eastern side. The following table shows the result
of these measurements; the numbers, as before, denote inches:

           1st pair   2nd pair   3rd pair

  West      12-3/4     15         17-1/4
  East      14-3/4     17-1/2     19

Here we find that in each case the _eastern_ stake moved faster than
its fellow. The point of maximum motion has therefore once more crossed
the axis of the glacier.

Determining the point of maximum motion for a great number of
transverse sections of the Mer de Glace, and uniting these points, we
have what is called the _locus_ of the point. The dotted line in the
annexed figure represents the centre of the Mer de Glace; the hard
line which crosses the axis of the glacier at the points A A is then
the locus of the point of swiftest motion. It is a curve more deeply
sinuous than the valley itself, and it crosses the central line of the
valley at each point of contrary flexure. The position of towns upon
the banks of rivers is usually on the convex side of the stream, where
the rush of the water renders silting-up impossible; and the same law
which regulated the flow of the Thames, and determined the position
of the towns upon its banks, is at this moment operating with silent
energy among the Alpine glaciers.

[Illustration: Fig. 1.]

Another peculiarity of glacier motion is now to be noticed.

Before any observations had been made upon the subject, it was surmised
by Prof. Forbes that the portions of a glacier near its bed were
retarded by friction against the latter. This view was afterwards
confirmed by his own observations, and by those of M. Martins.
Nevertheless the state of our knowledge upon the subject rendered
further confirmation of the fact highly desirable. A rare opportunity
for testing the question was furnished in 1857 by an almost vertical
precipice of ice, constituting the side of the Glacier du Géant,
exposed near the Tacul. The precipice was about 140 feet in height.
At the top and near the bottom stakes were fixed, and by hewing steps
in the ice I succeeded in fixing a stake in the face of the precipice
at a point about forty feet above the base.[31] After the lapse of
a sufficient number of days, the progress of the three stakes was
measured; reduced to the diurnal rate, the motion was as follows:

[31] It was here that my prudent guide, Édouard Simon, demanded,
‘Est-ce que vous avez une femme?’ and, when I replied in the negative,
added, ‘Vous serez tué tout de même.’

  Top stake          6.00 inches.
  Middle stake       4.59   „
  Bottom stake       2.56   „

We thus see that the top stake moved with more than twice the velocity
of the bottom one, while the velocity of the middle stake lies between
the two. But it also appears that the augmentation of velocity upwards
is not proportional to the distance from the bottom, but increases
in a quicker ratio. At a height of 100 feet from the bottom, the
velocity would undoubtedly be practically the same as at the surface.
Measurements made upon an adjacent ice-cliff proved this. We thus see
the perfect validity of the reason assigned by Forbes for the continued
verticality of the walls of transverse crevasses. Indeed a comparison
of the result with his anticipations and reasonings will prove alike
their sagacity and their truth.

The most commanding view of the Mer de Glace and its tributaries is
obtained from a point above the remarkable cleft in the mountain-range
underneath the Aiguille de Charmoz, which is sure to attract the
attention of an observer standing at the Montanvert. This point, marked
G on the map of Forbes, I succeeded in attaining. A Tübingen Professor
once visited the glaciers of Switzerland, and seeing these apparently
rigid masses enclosed in sinuous valleys, went home and wrote a book,
flatly denying the possibility of their motion. An inspection from
the point now referred to would have doubtless confirmed him in his
opinion; and indeed nothing can be more calculated to impress the mind
with the magnitude of the forces brought into play than the squeezing
of the three tributaries of the Mer de Glace through the neck of the
valley at Trélaporte.

But let me state numerical results. Previous to its junction with its
fellows, the Glacier du Géant measures 1,134 yards across. Before it
is influenced by the thrust of the Talèfre, the Glacier de Léchaud has
a width of 825 yards; while the width of the Talèfre branch across the
base of the cascade, before it joins the Léchaud, is approximately
638 yards. The sum of these widths is 2,597 yards. At Trélaporte
those three branches are forced through a gorge 893 yards wide, with
a central velocity of 20 inches a day! The result is still more
astonishing if we confine our attention to one of the tributaries--that
of the Léchaud. This broad ice-river, which before its junction with
the Talèfre has a width of 825 yards, at Trélaporte is squeezed to
a driblet of less than 88 yards in width, that is to say, to about
one-tenth of its previous horizontal transverse dimension.

Whence is the force derived which drives the glacier through the
gorge? No doubt pressure from behind. Other facts also suggest that
the Glacier du Géant is throughout its length in a state of forcible
longitudinal compression. Taking a series of points along the axis of
this glacier--if these points, during the descent of the glacier,
preserved their distances asunder perfectly constant, there could be
no longitudinal compression. The mechanical meaning of this term, as
applied to a substance capable of yielding like ice, must be that the
hinder points are incessantly advancing upon the forward ones. I was
particularly anxious to test this view, which first occurred to me on
_à priori_ grounds. Three points, A, B, C, were therefore fixed upon
the axis of the Glacier du Géant, A being the highest up the glacier.
The distance between A and B was 545 yards, and that between B and C
was 487 yards. The daily velocities of these three points, determined
by the theodolite, were as follows:

  A       20.55 inches.
  B       15.43   „
  C       12.75   „

The result completely corroborates the foregoing anticipation. The
hinder points are incessantly advancing upon those in front, and
that to an extent sufficient to shorten a segment of this glacier,
measuring 1,000 yards in length, at the rate of 8 inches a day. Were
this rate uniform at all seasons, the shortening would amount to 240
feet in a year. When we consider the compactness of this glacier, and
the uniformity in the width of the valley which it fills, this result
cannot fail to excite surprise; and the exhibition of force thus
rendered manifest must be mainly instrumental in driving the glacier
through the jaws of the granite vice at Trélaporte.

When the Glacier du Géant is observed from a sufficient distance, a
remarkable system of seams of white ice appears to sweep across it,
in the direction of the ‘dirt-bands.’ These seams are more resistant
than the ordinary ice of the glacier, and sometimes protrude above
the surface to a height of three or four feet. Their origin was for
some time a difficulty, and it was at the base of the ice-cascade
which descends from the basin of the Talèfre that the key to their
solution first presented itself. It was well known that the ice of a
glacier is not of homogeneous structure, but that the general more
or less milky mass is traversed by blue veins of a more compact and
transparent texture. In the upper portions of the Mer de Glace these
veins sweep across the glacier in gentle curves, leaning forward--to
which leaning forward Prof. Forbes gave the name of the ‘frontal dip.’
A case of ‘backward dip’ has never been described. But at the base of
the ice-cascade referred to I had often noticed the veins exposed upon
the walls of a longitudinal crevasse leaning backwards and forwards on
both sides of a vertical line, like the joints of stones used to turn
an arch.

This fact was found to connect itself in the following way with the
general state of the glacier. At the base of the ice-fall a succession
of protuberances, with steep frontal slopes, followed each other, and
were intersected by crevasses. Let the hand be placed flat upon the
table, with the palm downwards; let the fingers be bent so as to render
the space between the joints nearest the nails and the ends of the
fingers nearly vertical. Let the second hand be now placed upon the
back of the first, with its fingers bent as in the former case, and
their ends resting upon the roots of the first fingers. The crumpling
of the hands fairly represents the crumpling of the ice, and the spaces
between the fingers represent the crevasses by which the protuberances
are intersected. On the walls of these crevasses the change of dip of
the veined structure above referred to was always observed, and _at the
base of each protuberance a vein of white ice was found firmly wedged
into the mass of the glacier_.

The next figure represents a series of these crumples with the veins of
white ice _i i i_ at their bases.

[Illustration: FIG 2.]

It was soon observed that the water which trickled down the
protuberances, and gushed here and there from glacier orifices,
collected at the bases of the crumples, and formed streams which cut
for themselves deep channels in the ice. These streams seemed to be the
exact matrices or moulds of the veins of white ice, and the latter
were finally traced to the gorging up of the channels of glacial
rivulets by winter snow. The same explanation applies to the system
of bands upon the Glacier du Géant. I was enabled to trace the little
arms of white ice which once were the tributaries of the streams, to
see a trunk vein of the ice dividing into branches, and uniting again
so as to enclose glacial islands. I finally traced them to the region
of their formation, and by sketches of existing streams taken near the
base of the _séracs_, and of bands of white ice taken lower down, a
resemblance so striking was exhibited as to leave no doubt of their
relationship. On the walls of some deep crevasses, moreover, which
intersected the white ice-seams, I found that the latter penetrated the
glacier only to a limited depth, having the appearance of a kind of
glacial ‘trap’ intruded from above.

[Illustration: FIG. 3.]

But how is the backward dip of the blue veins to be accounted for?
Doubtless in the following way: At the base of the cascade the glacier
is forcibly compressed by the thrust of the mass behind it; besides
this, it changes its inclination suddenly and considerably; it is
bent upwards, and the consequence of this bending is a system of
wrinkles, such as those represented in the next figure. The interior
of a bent umbrella-handle sometimes presents wrinkles which are the
representatives, in little, of the protuberances upon the glacier. The
coat-sleeve is an equally instructive illustration: when the arm is
bent at the elbow the sleeve wrinkles, and as the places where these
wrinkles occur in the cloth are determined, to some extent, by the
previous creasing, so also the places where the wrinkles are formed
upon the glacier are determined by the previous scarring of the ice
during its descent down the cascade. The manner in which these crumples
tend to _scale off_ speaks strongly in favour of the explanation
given. The following figure represents a type of numerous instances
of scaling off. By means of a hydraulic press it is easy to produce
a perfectly similar scaling in small masses of ice. One consequence
of this crumpling of the glacier would be the backward and forward
inclination of the veins as actually observed. The same appearance was
noticed on the wrinkles of the Glacier du Géant. It was also proved, by
measurements, that these wrinkles _shorten_ as they descend.

[Illustration: FIG. 4.]

In virtue of what quality, then, can ice be bent and squeezed, and have
its form changed in the manner indicated in the foregoing observations?
The only theory worthy of serious consideration at the present day is
the celebrated Viscous Theory of glacial motion. Numerous appearances,
as we have seen, favour the idea that ice is a viscous or ‘semi-fluid’
substance, and that it flows as such in the glaciers of the Alps.
The aspect of many glaciers, as a whole--their power of closing
up crevasses, and of reconstructing themselves after having been
precipitated down glacial gorges--the obvious bendings and contortions
of various portions of the ice, are all in harmony with the notion.
The laminar structure of the glacier has also been regarded by eminent
authorities as a crucial test in favour of the viscous theory, and
affirmed to be impossible of explanation on any other hypothesis.

Nevertheless, this theory is so directly opposed to our ordinary
experience of the nature of ice as to leave upon the mind a lingering
doubt of its truth. Can we imitate the phenomena without invoking the
explanation? We can. Moulds of various forms were hollowed out in
boxwood, and pieces of ice were placed in these moulds and subjected
to pressure. In this way spheres of ice were flattened into cakes, and
cakes formed into transparent lenses. A straight bar of ice, six inches
long, was passed through a series of moulds augmenting in curvature,
and was finally bent into a semiring. A small block of ice was placed
in a hemispherical cavity, and was pressed upon by a hemispherical
protuberance, not large enough to fill the cavity; the ice yielded and
filled the space between both, thus forming itself into a transparent
cup. The specimens of ice here employed were so exceedingly brittle
that a pricker driven into the ice was competent to split blocks of the
substance eight cubic feet in volume, the surface of fracture being in
all cases as clean and sharp as that of glass.

These experiments, then, demonstrate a capacity on the part of small
masses of ice which they have not been hitherto known to possess. They
prove, to all appearance, that the substance is much more plastic than
it was ever imagined to be. But the real germ from which these results
have sprung is to be found in a lecture given at the Royal Institution
in June 1850, and reported in the ‘Athenæum’ and ‘Literary Gazette’
for that year. Faraday then showed that when two pieces of ice, at a
temperature of 32° Fahr., are placed in contact with each other, they
freeze together, by the conversion of the film of moisture between
them into ice. The case of a snowball is a familiar illustration of
the principle. When the snow is below 32°, and therefore _dry_, it
will not cohere, whereas when it is in a thawing condition it can be
squeezed into a hard mass. During one of the hottest days of July 1857,
when the thermometer was upwards of 100° Fahr. in the sun, and more
than 80° in the shade, I observed a number of blocks of ice, which had
been placed in a heap, frozen together at their places of contact; and
I afterwards caused them to freeze together under water as hot as the
hand could bear. Facts like these suggested the thought that if a piece
of ice--a straight prism, for example--were placed in a bent mould and
subjected to pressure it would break, but that the force would also
bring its ruptured surfaces into contact, and thus the continuity
of the mass might be re-established. Experiment, as we have seen,
completely confirmed this surmise: the ice passed from a continuous
straight bar to a continuous bent one, the transition being effected,
not by a viscous movement of the particles, but _through fracture and
regelation_.

Let the transition from curve to curve be only gradual enough, and we
have the exact case of a transverse slice of a glacier.

All the phenomena of motion, on which the idea of viscosity has been
based, are brought by such experiments as the above into harmony with
the demonstrable properties of ice. In virtue of this property, the
glacier accommodates itself to its bed while preserving its general
continuity, crevasses are closed up, and the broken ice of a cascade,
such as that of the Talèfre or the Rhone, is recompacted to a solid
continuous mass.

       *       *       *       *       *

The very essence of viscosity is the ability of yielding to a force
of tension, _the texture of the substance, after yielding, being in a
state of equilibrium_, so that it has no strain to recover from; and
the substances chosen by Prof. Forbes as illustrative of the physical
condition of a glacier possess this power of being drawn out in a very
eminent degree. But it has been urged, and justly urged, that we
ought not to conclude that viscosity is absent because hand specimens
are brittle, any more than we ought to conclude that ice is not blue
because small fragments of the substance do not exhibit this colour.
To test the question of viscosity, then, we must appeal to the glacier
itself. Let us do so.

An analogy between the motion of a glacier through a sinuous valley
and of a river in a sinuous channel has been already pointed out. But
the analogy fails in one important particular: the river, and much
more so a mass of flowing treacle, honey, tar, or melted caoutchouc,
sweeps round its curves without rupture of continuity. The viscous
mass _stretches_, but the icy mass _breaks_, and the ‘excessive
crevassing’ pointed out by Prof. Forbes himself is the consequence.
The inclinations of the Mer de Glace and its three tributaries were,
moreover, taken, and the association of transverse crevasses with the
changes of inclination were accurately noted. Every traveller knows
the utter dislocation and confusion produced by the descent of the Mer
de Glace from the Chapeau downwards. A similar state of things exists
in the ice-cascade of the Talèfre. Descending from the Jardin, as the
ice approaches the fall, great transverse chasms are formed, which
at length follow each other so speedily as to reduce the ice-masses
between them to mere plates and wedges, along which the explorer has to
creep cautiously. These plates and wedges are in some cases bent and
crumpled by the lateral pressure, and some large pyramids are turned
90° round, so as to have their veins at right angles to the normal
position. The ice afterwards descends the fall, the portions exposed
to view being a fantastic assemblage of frozen boulders, pinnacles,
and towers, some erect, some leaning, falling at intervals with a
sound like thunder, and crushing the ice-crags on which they fall to
powder. The descent of the ice through this fall has been referred to
as a proof of its viscosity; but the description just given does not
harmonise with our ideas of a viscous substance.

But the proof of the non-viscosity of the substance must be sought
at places where the change of inclination is very small. Nearly
opposite l’Angle there is a change from four to nine degrees, and the
consequence is the production of transverse fissures which render the
glacier here perfectly impassable. Further up the glacier transverse
crevasses are produced by a change of inclination from three to five
degrees. This change of inclination is protracted in fig. 5; the bend
occurs at the point B; it is scarcely perceptible, and still the
glacier is unable to pass over it without breaking across.

[Illustration: Fig. 5.

B]

Again, the crevasses being due to a state of strain from which the
ice relieves itself by breaking, the rate at which they widen may be
taken as a measure of the amount of relief demanded by the ice. Both
the suddenness of their formation and the slowness with which they
widen are demonstrative of the non-viscosity of the ice. For were the
substance capable of stretching, even at the small rate at which they
widen, there would be no necessity for their formation.

Further, the marginal crevasses of a glacier are known to be a
consequence of the swifter flow of its central portions, which throws
the sides into a state of strain from which they relieve themselves by
breaking. Now it is easy to calculate the amount of stretching demanded
of the ice in order to accommodate itself to the speedier central flow.
Take the case of a glacier half a mile wide. A straight transverse
element, or slice, of such a glacier, is bent in twenty-four hours to
a curve. The ends of the slice move a little, but the centre moves
more: let us suppose the versed side of the curve formed by the slice
in twenty-four hours to be a foot, which is a fair average. Having the
chord of this arc, and its versed side, we can calculate its length.
In the case of the Mer de Glace, which is about half a mile wide, the
amount of stretching demanded would be about the eightieth of an inch
in twenty-four hours. Surely, if the glacier possessed a property which
could with any propriety be called viscosity, it ought to be able to
respond to this moderate demand; but it is not able to do so: instead
of stretching as a viscous body, in obedience to this slow strain, it
breaks as an eminently fragile one, and marginal crevasses are the
consequence. It may be urged that it is not fair to distribute the
strain over the entire length of the curve: but reduce the distance
as we may, a residue must remain, which is demonstrative of the
non-viscosity of the ice.

To sum up, then, two classes of facts present themselves to the glacier
investigator--one class in harmony with the idea of viscosity, and
another as distinctly opposed to it. Where _pressure_ comes into
play we have the former; where _tension_ comes into play we have the
latter. Both classes of facts are reconciled by the assumption, or
rather the experimental verity, that the fragility of ice and its power
of regelation render it possible for it to change its form without
prejudice to its continuity.

       *       *       *       *       *

[Very interesting experiments upon the bending of ice have been
recently made by Mr. Matthews and Mr. Froude. In these experiments the
temperature of the ice, I believe, was some degrees below the freezing
point: it would be important to repeat these experiments with ice at
the temperature which it actually possesses in glaciers, namely, at
32°.--April 1871.]




II.

_STRUCTURE AND PROPERTIES OF ICE._


Being desirous of examining how the interior of a mass of ice is
affected by a beam of radiant heat sent through it, I availed myself
of the sunny weather of September and October 1857. The sunbeams,
condensed by a lens, were sent in various directions through slabs of
ice. The path of every beam was observed to be instantly studded with
lustrous spots, which increased in magnitude and number as the action
continued. On examining the spots more closely, they were found to be
flattened spheroids, and around each of them the ice was so liquefied
as to form a beautiful flower-shaped figure possessing six petals. From
this number there was no deviation. At first the edges of the liquid
leaves were unindented; but a continuance of the action usually caused
the edges to become serrated like those of ferns. When the ice was
caused to move across the beam, or when the beam was caused to traverse
different portions of the ice in succession, the sudden generation and
crowding together of these liquid flowers, with their central spots
shining with more than metallic brilliancy, was exceedingly beautiful.

In almost all cases the flowers were formed in planes parallel to the
surface of freezing; it mattered not whether the beam traversed the
ice parallel to this surface or perpendicular to it. Some apparent
exceptions to this rule were found, which will form the subject of
future investigation.

The general appearance of the shining spots at the centres of the
flowers was that of the bubbles of air entrapped in the ice; to examine
whether they contained air or not, portions of ice containing them
were immersed in warm water. When the ice surrounding the cavities had
completely melted, the latter instantly collapsed, and no trace of air
rose to the surface of the water. A vacuum, therefore, had been formed
at the centre of each spot, due, doubtless, to the well-known fact that
the volume of water in each flower was less than that of the ice, by
the melting of which the flower was produced.

The associated air-and-water cells, found in such numbers in the ice
of glaciers, and also observed in lake ice, were next examined. Two
hypotheses have been started to account for these cells. One attributes
them to the absorption of the sun’s heat by the air of the bubbles,
and the consequent melting of the ice which surrounds them. The other
hypothesis supposes that the liquid in the cells never has been
frozen, but has continued in the liquid condition from the _névé_ or
origin of the glacier downwards. Now if the water in the cells be due
to the melting of the ice, the associated air must be _rarefied_,
because the volume of the liquid is less than that of the ice which
produced it; whereas if the air be simply that entrapped in the snow of
the _névé_, it will not be thus rarefied. Here, then, we have a test as
to whether the water-cells have been produced by the melting of the ice.

Portions of ice containing these compound cells were immersed in hot
water, the ice around the cavities being thus gradually melted away.
When a liquid connexion was established between the bubble and the
atmosphere, the former collapsed to a smaller bubble. In many cases the
residual bubble did not reach the hundredth part of the magnitude of
the primitive one. There was no exception to this rule, and it proves
that the water of these particular cavities, at all events, is really
due to the melting of the adjacent ice.

But how was the ice surrounding the bubbles melted? The hypothesis
that the melting is due to the absorption of the solar rays by the air
of the bubbles is that of M. Agassiz, which has been reproduced and
subscribed to by the Messrs. Schlagintweit, and accepted generally as
the true one. Let us pursue it to its consequences.

Comparing equal _weights_ of air and water, experiment proves that to
raise a given weight of water one degree in temperature, as much heat
would be needed as would raise the same weight of air four degrees.

Comparing equal _volumes_ of air and water, the water is known to be
770 times heavier than the air; consequently, for a given volume of air
to raise an equal volume of water one degree in temperature, it must
part with 770 × 4 = 3080 degrees.

Now the quantity of heat necessary to melt a given weight of ice would
raise the same weight of water 142.6 Fahr. degrees in temperature.
Hence to produce, by the melting of ice, an amount of water equal to
itself in bulk, a bubble of air must yield up 3080 × 142.6, or upwards
of four hundred thousand degrees Fahrenheit.

This is the amount of heat which, according to the hypothesis of M.
Agassiz and the Messrs. Schlagintweit, is absorbed by the bubble of air
under the eyes of the observer. That is to say, the air is capable of
absorbing an amount of heat which, had it not been communicated to the
surrounding ice, would raise the bubble to a temperature 160 times that
of fused cast iron. Did air possess this enormous power of absorption
it would not be without inconvenience for the animal and vegetable life
of our planet.

The fact is, that a bubble of air at the earth’s surface is unable,
in the slightest appreciable degree, to absorb the sun’s rays; for
those rays before they reach the earth have been perfectly sifted by
their passage through the atmosphere. I made the following experiment
illustrative of this point: The rays from an electric lamp were
condensed by a lens, and the concentrated beam sent through the bulb
of a differential thermometer. The heat of the beam was intense; still
not the slightest effect was produced upon the thermometer. In fact,
all the rays that _air_ could absorb had been absorbed before the
thermometer was reached, while the rays that glass could absorb had
been _absorbed by the lens_. The heat consequently passed through the
thin glass envelope of the thermometer, and the air within it, without
imparting the slightest sensible heat to either.

The liquid bubbles observed in lake ice, and those which occur in the
deeper portions of glacier ice, are produced by heat which has been
_conducted_ through the substance without melting it. Regarding heat as
a mode of motion, it seems natural to infer, that inasmuch as within
the mass each molecule is controlled in its motion by the surrounding
molecules, the liberty of liquidity must be attained by the molecules
at the surface of ice before the molecules in the interior can attain
this liberty. But if a cavity exist in the interior, the molecules
surrounding that cavity are in a condition similar to those at the
surface; and they may be liberated by an amount of motion which has
been transmitted through the ice without prejudice to its solidity. The
conception is helped when we call to mind the transmission of motion
through a series of elastic balls, by which the last ball of the series
is detached, while the others do not suffer visible separation. It
may indeed be proved, by actual experiment, that the interior portion
of a mass of ice can be liquefied by an amount of heat which has been
conducted through the exterior portions without melting them.

Now precisely the converse of this takes place when two pieces of
ice, at 32° Fahr., with moist surfaces, are brought into contact.
Superficial portions are by this act transferred to the centre where a
temperature of 32° is not quite sufficient to produce liquefaction. The
motion of liquidity which the surfaces possessed before contact is now
checked, and the pieces of ice freeze together. This appears to furnish
a satisfactory explanation of all the cases of this nature which have
hitherto been observed.

The particles of a crushed mass of ice at 32°, or a ball of moist snow,
may, it is now well known, be squeezed into slabs or cups of ice. That
moisture is necessary here, and that the same agent is necessary in
the conversion of snow into glacier ice, was proved by the following
experiment. A ball of ice was cooled in a bath of solid carbonic acid
and ether, and thus rendered perfectly dry. Placed in a suitable mould,
and subjected to hydraulic pressure, the ball was crushed; but the
crushed fragments remained as _white and opaque_ as those of crushed
glass. The particles, while thus dry, could not be squeezed so as to
form pellucid ice, which is so easily obtained when the compressed mass
is at a temperature of 32° Fahr.




III.

_STRUCTURE OF GLACIERS._


If a transparent colourless solid be reduced to powder, the powder is
white. Thus rock crystal, rock salt, and glass in powder are all white.
A glass jar, partially filled with a solution of carbonate of soda,
with a little gum added to give it tenacity, presents, on the addition
of a little tartaric acid, the appearance of a tall white column of
foam. In all these cases, the whiteness and the opacity are due to
the intimate and irregular admixture of a solid or a liquid with air;
in like manner the whiteness of snow is due to the mixture of air and
transparent particles of ice.

The snow falls upon mountain eminences, and, above the snow-line, each
year leaves a residue; the substance thus collects in layers, forming
masses of great depth. The lower portions are squeezed by the pressure
of those above them, and a gradual approach to ice is the consequence.
The air being gradually expelled, the transparency of the substance
augments in proportion.

But even after the snow has been squeezed to hard ice in the upper
glacier region, it always contains a large amount of the air originally
entrapped in the snow. The air is distributed through the solid in
the form of bubbles, which give the ice a milky appearance. At the
lower extremity of a glacier the ice, as everybody knows, is blue and
transparent. The transition from one state to the other is not, in all
cases, a gradual change which takes place uniformly throughout the
entire mass. The white ice, on the contrary, of the middle glacier
region is usually striped by veins of a more transparent character,
the air which gives to the ice its whiteness having been, by some
means or other, wholly or partially ejected from the veins. These
veins sometimes give the ice of many glaciers a beautiful laminated
appearance; vast portions, indeed, of various glaciers consist of this
laminated ice.

The theory of the veins which perhaps first presents itself to the
mind, and which is still entertained by many intelligent Alpine
explorers, is that the veining of the middle glaciers is simply a
continuation of the _bedding_ of the _névé_; that not only do the
annual snow-falls produce beds of great thickness, but every successive
fall tends to produce a layer of less thickness, which layers, or the
surfaces separating them, ultimately appear as the blue veins. This
theory demands respectful consideration: on the exposed sections of
the _névé_ the lines of stratification are very manifest, exhibiting
in many cases appearances strongly resembling that of the veined
structure. Indeed, it was with a view to examine this subject more
closely that I withheld my observations on the structure of the Mer
de Glace in 1857, and betook myself once more to the mountains during
the summer of 1858. My desire at that time was to settle once for all
the rival claims of the only two theories which then deserved serious
attention--namely, those of pressure and of stratification.

In pursuance of this idea, I first visited the Lower glacier of
Grindelwald, one of the most accessible, and at the same time most
instructive, in the entire range of the Alps. Ascending the branch of
this glacier which descends from the Schreckhorn, the Strahleck, and
the Finsteraarhorn, I came to the base of an ice-fall which forbade
further advance. Quitting the glacier here, I ascended the side of the
flanking mountain, so as to reach a point from which the fall, and
the glacier below it, are distinctly visible; and from this position
I observed the gradual development and perfecting of the structure at
the base of the fall. On the middle of the fall itself no trace of the
structure was manifest; but where the glacier changed its inclination
at the bottom, being bent upwards so as throw its surface into a state
of intense longitudinal compression, the blue veins first made their
appearance. The base of the fall was a true _structure mill_, where
the transverse veins were manufactured, being afterwards sent forward,
giving a character to portions of the glacier which had no share in
their formation.

I afterwards examined the fall from the opposite side of the valley,
and corroborated the observations. It is difficult, in words, to convey
the force of the evidence which this glacier presents to the observer
who _sees_ it; it seems in fact like a grand laboratory experiment made
by Nature herself with especial reference to the point in question. The
squeezing of the mass, its yielding to the force brought to bear upon
it, its wrinkling and scaling off, and the appearance of the veins at
the exact point where the pressure begins to manifest itself, leave no
doubt on the mind that pressure and structure stand to each other in
the relation of cause and effect, and that the stratification could
have nothing to do with the phenomenon.

I subsequently crossed the Strahleck, descended the glaciers of the
Aar, crossed the Grimsel, and examined the glacier of the Rhone. This
glacier has also its grand ice-fall. In company with Prof. Ramsay, I
climbed in 1858 the precipices flanking the fall at the Grimsel side.
What has been stated regarding the Grindelwald ice-fall is true of
that of the Rhone; the base of the cascade is _the manufactory of the
structure_; and, as all the ice has to pass through this mill, the
entire mass of the glacier from the base of the fall downwards is
beautifully laminated.

Descending the valley of the Rhone to Viesch, I went thence to the
Æggischhorn, and remained for eight days in the vicinity of the
Great Aletsch glacier--the noblest ice-stream of the Alps. A highly
intelligent explorer had adduced certain phenomena of this glacier
as an evidence against the pressure theory of the veined structure;
and I did not think myself justified in quitting the place until I
had perfectly satisfied myself that the Aletsch not only presented no
phenomena at variance with the pressure theory, but exhibited some
which seemed fatal to the theory of the stratification.

I subsequently proceeded to Zermatt, and spent ten days on the
Riffelberg, exploring the entire system of glaciers between Monte Rosa
and the Mont Cervin. These glaciers exhibit, perhaps in a more striking
manner than any others in the Alps, the yielding of glacier ice when
subjected to intense pressure. The great western glacier of Monte
Rosa, the Schwartze glacier, the Trifti glacier, and the glaciers of
St. Theodule, are first spread out as wide and extensive _névés_ over
the breasts of the mountains. They move down, and are finally forced
into the valley containing the trunk, or Görner glacier. Here they are
squeezed to narrow strips, which gradually dwindle in width until they
form driblets not more than a few yards across. From the Görner Grat,
or from the summit of the Riffelhorn, these parallel strips of glacier,
each separated from its neighbour by a medial moraine, present a most
striking and instructive appearance.

The structure of these glaciers was carefully examined, and in all
cases as I travelled from regions where the pressure was feeble to
others where it was intense, the ice changed from a state almost, if
not entirely, structureless, to one in which the veining was exhibited
in great perfection. Each glacier, for example, where it met the
opposing mass in the trunk valley, and was pressed against the latter
by the thrust from behind, exhibited a beautifully developed structure.

Proofs have been already adduced that the Glacier du Géant is in a
state of longitudinal compression; it has also been shown that the
seams of white ice which intersect this glacier are due to the filling
up of the channels of glacier streams by snow, and the subsequent
compression of the substance. Here, then, we have a vast ice-press
which furnishes us with a test of the pressure theory. Both in 1857
and 1858 I found many of these seams of white ice intersected by
blue veins of the finest and most distinct character, their general
direction being at right angles to the direction of pressure.

But the notions of M. Agassiz as to the turning up of the strata so
as to expose their edges at the surface, and the acute remarks and
arguments of Mr. John Ball on the same subject, might still cast a
doubt upon the pressure theory, by suggesting a possible, though
extremely improbable, explanation of the structure in accordance with
the theory of stratification.

Hence my strong desire to discover some crucial phenomenon which should
set this question for ever at rest, and leave no room for doubt, even
on the minds of those who never saw a glacier. On Wednesday, August 18,
I was fortunate enough to make this discovery upon the Furgge glacier.

This ice-field spreads out as an almost level plain at the base of
Mont Cervin. The strata pile themselves one above the other without
disturbance, and hence with great regularity. The ice at length reaches
a brow, over which it is precipitated, forming in its descent four
great terraces, and shutting up the lower valley as a _cul de sac_.
When I reached this place huge blocks of ice stood, like rocking
stones, upon the topmost ledge, and numbers, which had fallen, had been
caught by the other ledges, and occupied very threatening positions:
the base of the fall was cumbered with crushed ice, and large boulders
of the substance had been cast a considerable way down the glacier.

On the faces of the terraces horizontal lines of stratification were
shown in the most perfect manner. Here and there the exertion of a
powerful lateral squeeze was manifest, causing the beds to crumple,
and producing numerous faults. Examining the fall from a distance
through an opera-glass, I thought I could discover lines of veining
running _through_ the strata, at a high angle, exactly as the planes
of cleavage often run at a high angle to the bedding of slate rocks.
The surface of the ice was, however, weathered; and I was unwilling
to accept an observation upon such a cardinal point with a shade of
doubt attached to it. Leaving my field-glass with my guide, who was to
give me warning should the blocks overhead give way, I advanced to the
wall of ice, and at several places cut away with my axe the weathered
superficial portions. Underneath I found the true veined structure,
_running nearly at right angles to the planes of stratification_.

I afterwards climbed the glacier to the right, and, as I ascended,
still better illustrations of the coexistence of the structure and the
strata than those observed upon the terraces exhibited themselves. The
ice was greatly dislocated, and on the faces of the crevasses the
beds were distinctly shown, _with the veins crossing them_. The idea
that the veins could be due to the turning up of the strata is plainly
irreconcileable with these observations.

The same year I visited the Mer de Glace and its tributaries, and found
the pressure key applicable to their phenomena also. The transverse
structure of the Glacier du Géant is formed at the base of the séracs;
that of the Talèfre branch of the Mer de Glace at the base of the
Talèfre ice-fall, where the change of inclination and the thrust from
behind produce the requisite longitudinal compression. I have already
had occasion to remark upon the peculiar dipping of the structure,
and the scaling-off of the protuberances, which are effects of the
same cause. These phenomena are exhibited at the base of all the
ice-cascades.

The principal kinds of structure may be divided into three; as follows:

1st, _Marginal structure_, developed by pressure due to the swifter
motion of the centre of the glacier.

2nd, _Longitudinal structure_, due to mutual pressure of two tributary
glaciers; the structure here is parallel to the medial moraine which
divides the tributaries.

3rd, _Transverse structure_, produced by pressure due to the change of
inclination, and to the longitudinal thrust endured by the glacier at
the base of an ice-fall.

The lamination of a glacier is a peculiarly interesting case of
cleavage. It is produced in the same manner as the lamination of slate
rock, which is known, through the distortion of its fossils, to have
suffered great pressure at right angles to the planes of cleavage.




IV.

_HELMHOLTZ ON ICE AND GLACIERS._


Switzerland has attractions for the scientific philosophers of Germany,
and around the Titlis, Bunsen, Helmholtz, Kirchhoff, and Wiedemann
are not unfamiliar names. Nor have their visits to the Alps been
unproductive of results. Some time ago I was favoured by Professor
Helmholtz with the First Part of his ‘Popular Scientific Lectures.’
It contains four of them--the first, ‘On the Relation of the Natural
Sciences to Science in general;’ the second, ‘On Goethe’s Labours in
Natural Science;’ the third, ‘On the Physiological Origin of Musical
Harmony;’ and the fourth, ‘On Ice and Glaciers.’ The lectures are in
German, and it is much to be desired that some competent person should
undertake their translation into English.[32]

[32] I have reason to believe that a translation of the two parts
hitherto published will soon be forthcoming.--J. T., 1871.

I turned with natural interest to the last-mentioned discourse, to see
how my notions and experiments on the formation and motion of glaciers
were regarded by so eminent a man. I will here endeavour to give a
summary of the scientific portion of the lecture.

Professor Helmholtz refers the cold of the upper regions of the
atmosphere to the causes generally assigned; but he adds a remark
important at the present moment, when the origin of the hot wind called
Föhn in Switzerland is the subject of so much discussion. This wind,
as Helmholtz justly observes, may not only be a cold wind upon the
mountain-summits, but a _wet_ one, and it may deposit its moisture
there. A wind thus dried upon the heights, and warmed by its subsequent
fall into the valleys, would possess the heat and dryness of the
Föhn. These qualities are, therefore, no proof that the origin of the
Föhnwind is Sahara.

[Illustration: Fig. 6.]

It will probably be remembered that I deduced the formation of
glaciers, and their subsequent motion through valleys of varying width
and flexure, from the fact that when two pieces of ice are pressed
together they freeze together at their places of contact. This fact
was first mentioned to me verbally by its discoverer, Faraday. Soon
afterwards, and long before I had occasion to reflect upon its cause,
the application of the fact to the formation and motion of glaciers
flashed upon me. Snow was in the yard of the Royal Institution at
the time; stuffing a quantity of it into a steel mould, which I
had previously employed to demonstrate the influence of pressure on
magnetic phenomena, I squeezed the snow, and had the pleasure of
seeing it turn out from the mould as a cylinder of translucent ice.
I immediately went to Faraday, and expressed the conviction that his
little outlying experiment would be found to constitute the basis of
a true theory of glaciers. It became subsequently known to me that
the Messrs. Schlagintweit had made a similar experiment with snow;
but they did not connect with it the applications which suggested
themselves to me, and which have since been developed into a theory of
glacier-motion.

A section of the mould used in the experiment above referred to is
given in the foregoing figure. A B is the solid base of the mould; C
D E F a hollow cylinder let into the base; P is the solid plug used
to compress the snow. When sufficiently squeezed, the bottom, A B, is
removed, and the cylinder of ice is pushed out by the plug. The mould
closely resembles one of those employed by Professor Helmholtz.

The subsequent development of the subject by the moulding of ice into
various forms by pressure is too well known to need dwelling upon here.
In applying these results to glaciers, I dwelt with especial emphasis
upon the fact that while the power of being moulded by _pressure_
belonged in an eminent degree to glacier ice, the power of yielding,
by stretching, to a force of _tension_, was sensibly wanting. On
this point Prof. Helmholtz speaks as follows: ‘Tyndall in particular
maintained, and proved by calculation and measurement, that the ice
of a glacier does not stretch in the smallest degree when subjected
to tension--that when sufficiently strained it always breaks;’ and he
adds, in another place, that the property thus revealed establishes
‘an essential difference between a stream of ice, and one of lava, tar,
honey, or mud.’

[Illustration: Fig. 7]

[Illustration: Fig. 8.]

In the beautiful experiments of M. Tresca recently executed, the
power of ice to mould itself under pressure has been very strikingly
illustrated. Professor Helmholtz also, in the presence of his audiences
at Heidelberg and Frankfort, illustrated this property in various ways.
From snow and broken fragments of ice he formed cakes and cylinders;
and uniting the latter, end to end, he permitted them to freeze
together to long sticks of ice. Placing, moreover, in a suitable mould
a cylinder of ice of the shape represented in fig. 7, he squeezed
it into the cake represented in fig. 8. In fact he corroborated, by
a series of striking experimental devices of his own the results
previously obtained by myself.

With regard to the application of these results to the phenomena
of glaciers, Professor Helmholtz, after satisfying himself of the
insufficiency of other hypotheses, thus finally expresses his
conviction: ‘I do not doubt that Tyndall has assigned the essential
and principal cause of glacier-motion, in referring it to fracture and
regelation.’

It is perhaps worth stating that the term ‘regelation’ was first
introduced in a paper published by Mr. Huxley and myself more than
seven years after the discovery of the fact by Faraday, and that it was
suggested to us by our friend Dr. Hooker, Director of the Royal Gardens
at Kew. As already remarked, the formation and motion of glaciers,
and other points of a kindred nature, had been referred to regelation
long before I occupied myself with the cause of regelation itself.
This latter question is not once referred to in the memoir in which
the regelation theory was first developed.[33] The enquiries, though
related, were different. In referring the motion of glaciers to a fact
experimentally demonstrated, I referred it to its _proximate_ cause. To
refer that cause to _its_ physical antecedents formed the subject of
a distinct enquiry, in which, because of my belief in the substantial
correctness of Faraday’s explanation, I took comparatively little part.

[33] Phil. Trans. vol. cxlvii. p. 327.

Five persons, however, mingled more or less in the enquiry--viz.
Professor Faraday, Principal Forbes, Professor James Thomson, Professor
(now Sir) William Thomson, and myself.[34] Professor James Thomson
explained regelation by reference to an important deduction, first
drawn by him,[35] and almost simultaneously by Professor Clausius,[36]
from the mechanical theory of heat. He had shown it to be a consequence
of this theory that the freezing-point of water must be lowered by
pressure; that is to say, water when subjected to pressure will remain
liquid at a temperature below that at which it would freeze if the
pressure were removed. This theoretic deduction was confirmed in a
remarkable manner by the experiments of his brother.[37] Regelation,
according to James Thomson’s theory, was thus accounted for: ‘When two
pieces of ice are pressed together, or laid the one upon the other,
their compressed parts liquefy. The water thus produced has rendered
latent a portion of the heat of the surrounding ice, and must therefore
be lower than 0° C. in temperature. On escaping from the pressure this
water refreezes and cements the pieces of ice together.’

[34] Proc. Roy. Soc. vol. ix. p. 141; and vol. x. p. 152. Phil. Mag. S.
4, vol. xvi. pp. 347 and 544; and vol. xvii. p. 162.

[35] Proc. Roy. Soc. Edinb. February 1850.

[36] Pogg. Ann. vol. lxxxi. p. 168.

[37] Phil. Mag. August 1850.

I always admitted that this explanation dealt with a ‘true cause.’
But considering the infinitesimal magnitude of the pressure sufficient
to produce regelation, in common with Professor Faraday and Principal
Forbes, I deemed the cause an insufficient one. Professor James
Thomson, moreover, grounded upon the foregoing theory of regelation
a theory of glacier-motion, in which he ascribed the changes of form
which a glacier undergoes to the incessant liquefaction of the ice at
places where the pressure is intense, and the refreezing, in other
positions, of the water thus produced.[38] I endeavoured to show that
this theory was inapplicable to the facts. Professor Helmholtz has
recently subjected it to the test of experiment, and the conclusions
which he draws from his researches are substantially the same as mine.

[38] Proc. Roy. Soc. vol. viii. p. 455.

Thus, then, as regards the incapacity of the ice on which my
observations were made to stretch in obedience to tension, and its
capacity to be moulded to any extent by pressure--as regards the
essential difference between a glacier, and a stream of lava, honey,
or tar--as regards the sufficiency of pressure and regelation to
account for the formation of glaciers, and of fracture and regelation
to account for their motion--as regards, finally, the insufficiency of
the theory which refers the motion to liquefaction by pressure, and
refreezing, the views of Professor Helmholtz and myself appear to be
identical.

But the case is different with regard to the cause of regelation
itself. Here Professor Helmholtz, like M. Jamin,[39] accepts the
clear and definite explanation of Professor James Thomson as the most
satisfactory that has been advanced; and he supports this view by an
experiment so beautiful that it cannot fail to give pleasure even to
those against whose opinions it is adduced. But before passing to the
experiment, which is described in the Appendix to the lecture, it will
be well to give in the words of Professor Helmholtz the views which he
expresses in the body of his discourse.

[39] ‘Traité de Physique,’ vol. ii. p. 105.

‘You will now ask with surprise,’ he says, ‘how it is that ice, the
most fragile and brittle of all known solid substances, can flow in a
glacier like a viscous mass; and you may perhaps be inclined to regard
this as one of the most unnatural and paradoxical assertions that
ever was made by a natural philosopher. I will at once admit that the
enquirers themselves were in no small degree perplexed by the results
of their investigations. But the facts were there, and could not be
dissipated by denial. How this kind of motion on the part of ice was
possible remained long an enigma--the more so as the known brittleness
of ice also manifested itself in glaciers by the formation of numerous
fissures. This, as Tyndall rightly maintained, constituted an essential
difference between the ice-stream, and a stream of lava, tar, honey, or
mud.

‘The solution of this wonderful enigma was found--as is often the
case in natural science--in an apparently remote investigation on the
nature of heat, which forms one of the most important conquests of
modern physics, and which is known under the name of the mechanical
theory of heat. Among a great number of deductions as to the relations
of the most diverse natural forces to each other, the principles of
the mechanical theory of heat enable us to draw certain conclusions
regarding the dependence of the freezing-point of water on the pressure
to which the ice and water are subjected.’

Professor Helmholtz then explains to his audience what is meant by
latent heat, and points out that, through the circulation of water in
the fissures and capillaries of a glacier, its interior temperature
must remain constantly at the freezing-point.

‘But,’ he continues, ‘the temperature of the freezing-point of water
can be altered by pressure. This was first deduced by James Thomson,
and almost simultaneously by Clausius, from the mechanical theory of
heat; and by the same deductions even the magnitude of the change may
be predicted. For the pressure of every additional atmosphere, the
freezing-point sinks 0°.0075 C. The brother of the gentleman first
named, William Thomson, the celebrated Glasgow physicist, verified
experimentally the theoretic deduction by compressing a mixture of ice
and water in a suitable vessel. The mixture became colder and colder
as the pressure was augmented, and by the exact amount which the
mechanical theory of heat required.

‘If, then, by pressure a mixture of ice and water can be rendered
colder without the actual abstraction of heat, this can only occur by
the liquefaction of the ice and the rendering of heat latent. And this
is the reason why pressure can alter the point of congelation....

‘In the experiment of William Thomson just referred to ice and water
were enclosed in a solid vessel from which nothing could escape. The
case is somewhat different when, as in the case of a glacier, the
water of the compressed ice can escape through fissures. In this case
the ice is compressed, but not the water which escapes. The pressed
ice will become colder by a quantity corresponding to the lowering
of its freezing-point by the pressure. But the freezing-point of the
uncompressed water is not lowered. Here, then, we have ice colder than
0° C. in contact with water at 0° C. The consequence is, that round the
place of pressure the water will freeze and form new ice, while, on
the other hand, a portion of the compressed ice continues to be melted
(während dafür ein Theil des gepressten Eises fortschmilzt).

‘This occurs, for instance, when two pieces of ice are simply pressed
together. By the water which freezes at the points of contact they are
firmly united to a continuous mass. When the pressure is considerable,
and the chilling consequently great, the union occurs quickly, but
it may also be effected by a very slight pressure if sufficient time
be afforded. Faraday, who discovered this phenomenon, named it the
_regelation of ice_.[40] Its explanation has given rise to considerable
controversy: I have laid that explanation before you which I consider
to be the most satisfactory.’

[40] I have corrected this slight inadvertence. We owe the name to
Hooker.

In the Appendix, Professor Helmholtz returns to the subject thus
handled in the body of his discourse. ‘The theory of the regelation of
ice,’ he observes, ‘has given rise to a scientific discussion between
Faraday and Tyndall on the one hand, and James and William Thomson on
the other. In the text of this lecture I have adopted the theory of
the latter, and have therefore to justify myself for so doing.’ He
then analyses the reasonings on both sides, points out the theoretic
difficulties of Faraday’s explanation, shows what a small pressure can
accomplish if only sufficient time be granted to it, draws attention to
the fact that when one piece of ice is placed upon another the pressure
is not distributed over the whole of the two appressed surfaces,
but is concentrated on a few points of contact. He also holds, with
Professor James Thomson, that in an experiment devised by Principal
Forbes even the capillary attraction exerted between two plates of ice
is sufficient, in due time, to produce regelation. To illustrate the
slow action of the small differences of temperature which here come
into play Professor Helmholtz made the following experiment, to which
reference has been already made.

‘A glass flask with a drawn-out neck was half filled with water, which
was boiled until all the air above it was driven out. The flask was
then hermetically sealed. When cooled, the flask was void of air, and
the water within it freed from the pressure of the atmosphere. As the
water thus prepared can be cooled considerably below 0° C. before the
first ice is formed, while when ice is in the flask it freezes at 0° C.
[why? J. T.], the flask was in the first instance placed in a freezing
mixture until the water was changed into ice. It was afterwards
permitted to melt slowly in a place the temperature of which was +2°
C., until the half of it was liquefied.

‘The flask thus half filled with water having a disk of ice swimming
upon it was placed in a mixture of ice and water, being quite
surrounded by the mixture. After an hour the disk within the flask was
frozen to the glass. By shaking the flask the disk was liberated, but
it froze again. This occurred as often as the shaking was repeated.
The flask was permitted to remain for eight days in the mixture, which
was preserved throughout at a temperature of 0° C. During this time a
number of very regular and sharply defined ice-crystals were formed,
and augmented very slowly in size. This is perhaps the best method of
obtaining beautifully formed crystals of ice.

‘While, therefore, the outer ice which had to support the pressure
of the atmosphere slowly melted, the water within the flask, whose
freezing-point, on account of a defect of pressure, was 0°.0075 C.
higher, deposited crystals of ice. The heat abstracted from the water
in this operation had, moreover, to pass through the glass of the
flask, which, together with the small difference of temperature,
explains the slowness of the freezing process.’

A single additional condition in connection with this beautiful
experiment I should like to have seen fulfilled--namely, that the water
in which the flask was immersed, as well as that within it, should be
purged of its air by boiling. It is just possible that the point of
congelation may not be entirely independent of the presence of air in
the water.

[Illustration: Fig. 9.]

[Illustration: Fig. 10.]

The revival of this subject by Professor Helmholtz has caused me to
make a few additional experiments on the moulding and regelation of
ice. The following illustrates both: A quantity of snowy powder was
scraped from a block of clear ice and placed in a boxwood mould having
a shape like the foot of a claret-glass. The ice-powder being squeezed
by a hydraulic press, a clear mass of ice of the shape shown in section
at the bottom of fig. 9 was the result. In another mould the same
powder was squeezed so as to form small cylinders, three of which are
shown separate in fig. 9. A third mould was then employed to form a
cup of ice, which is shown at the top of fig. 9. Bringing all the
parts into contact, they were cemented through regelation to form the
claret-glass sketched in fig. 10, from which several draughts of wine
might be taken, if the liquid were cooled sufficiently before pouring
it into the cup of ice.

[Illustration: Fig. 11.]

There are brass shapes used for the casting of flowers and other
objects which answer admirably for experiments on the regelation
of ice. One of them was purchased for me by Mr. Becker. Ice-powder
squeezed into it regelated to a solid mass and came from the mould in
the sharply defined form sketched in fig. 11.

       *       *       *       *       *

I placed a small piece of ice in warm water and pressed it underneath
the water by a second piece. The submerged morsel was so small
that the vertical pressure was almost infinitesimal. It froze,
notwithstanding, to the under surface of the superior piece of ice.
Two pieces of ice were placed in a basin of warm water, and allowed
to come together. They froze as soon as they touched each other. The
parts surrounding the place of contact rapidly melted away, but the
two pieces continued for a time united by a narrow bridge of ice. The
bridge finally melted away, and the pieces were for a moment separated.
But bodies which water wets, and against which it rises by capillary
attraction, move spontaneously together upon water. The ice morsels did
so, and immediately regelation again set in. A new bridge was formed,
which in its turn was dissolved, and the pieces closed up as before.
Thus a kind of pulsation was kept up by the two pieces of ice. They
touched, froze, a bridge was formed and melted, leaving an interval
between the pieces. Across this they moved, touched, froze, the same
process being repeated over and over again.

We have here the explanation of the curious fact that when several
large lumps of ice are placed in warm water and allowed to touch each
other, regelation is maintained among them as long as they remain
undissolved. The final fragments may not be the one-hundredth part of
the original ones in size; but through the process just described,
they incessantly lock themselves together until they finally disappear.

According to Professor James Thomson’s theory, to produce regelation
the pieces of ice have to exercise pressure, in order to draw from
the surrounding ice the heat necessary for the liquefaction of the
compressed part; and then this water must escape and be refrozen. All
this requires time. In the foregoing experiments, moreover, the water
liquefied by the pressure issued into the surrounding warm water, but
notwithstanding this the floating fragments regelated in a moment. It
is not necessary that the touching surfaces should be flat; for in this
case a film of water might be supposed to exist between them of the
temperature 0° C. The surfaces in contact may be convex: they may be
virtual _points_ that are about to touch each other, clasped all round
by the warm liquid, which is rapidly dissolving them as they approach.
Still they freeze immediately when they touch.

There are two points urged by Helmholtz--one in favour of the view he
has adopted, and the other showing a difficulty associated with the
view of Faraday--on which a few words may be said. ‘I found,’ says
Helmholtz, ‘the strength and rapidity of the union of the pieces of ice
in such complete correspondence with the amount of pressure employed,
that I cannot doubt that the pressure is actually the sufficient cause
of the union.’

But, according to Faraday’s explanation, the strength and quickness
of the regelation must also go hand in hand with the magnitude of the
pressure employed. Helmholtz rightly dwells upon the fact that the
appressed surfaces are usually not perfectly congruent--that they
really touch each other in a few points only, the pressure being,
therefore, concentrated. Now the effect of pressure exerted on two
pieces of ice at a temperature of 0° C. is not only to lessen the
thickness of the liquid film between the pieces, but also to flatten
out the appressed points, and thus to spread the film over a greater
space. On both theories, therefore, the strength and quickness of the
regelation ought to correspond to the magnitude of the pressure.

The difficulty referred to above is thus stated by Helmholtz: ‘In
the explanation given by Faraday, according to which the regelation
is caused by a contact action of ice and water, I find a theoretic
difficulty. By the freezing of the water a very sensible quantity
of heat would be set free; and it does not appear how this is to be
disposed of.’

On the part of those who accept Faraday’s explanation, the answer here
would be that the free heat is diffused through the adjacent ice.
But against this it will doubtless be urged that ice already at a
temperature of 0° C. cannot take up more heat without liquefaction.
If this be true under all circumstances, Faraday’s explanation must
undoubtedly be given up. But the essence of that explanation seems
to be that the interior portions of a mass of ice require a higher
temperature to dissolve them than that sufficient to cause fusion
at the surface. When therefore two moist surfaces of ice at the
temperature 0° are pressed together, and when, in virtue of the contact
action assumed by Faraday, the film of water between them is frozen,
the adjacent ice (which is now in the interior, and not at the surface
as at first) is in a condition to withdraw by conduction, and without
prejudice to its own solidity, the small amount of heat set free. Once
granting the contact action claimed by Faraday, there seems to be no
difficulty in disposing of the heat rendered sensible by the freezing
of the film.

When the year is advanced, and after the ice imported into London
has remained a long time in store, if closely examined, parcels of
liquid water will be found in the interior of the mass. I enveloped
ice containing such water-parcels in tinfoil, and placed it in a
freezing mixture until the liquid parcels were perfectly congealed.
Removing the ice from the freezing mixture, I placed it, covered by
its envelope, in a dark room, and found, after a couple of hours’
exposure to a temperature somewhat over 0° C., the frozen parcels
again liquid. _The heat which fused this interior ice passed through
the firmer surrounding ice without the slightest visible prejudice to
its solidity._ But if the freezing temperature of the ice-parcels be 0°
C., then the freezing temperature of the mass surrounding them must be
higher than 0° C., which is what the explanation of Faraday requires.

In a quotation at p. 389 I have attached to the description of a
precaution taken by Professor Helmholtz the query ‘why?’ He states
that water freed of its air sinks, without freezing, to a temperature
far below 0° C.; while when a piece of ice is in the water it cannot
so sink in temperature, but is invariably deposited in the solid
form at 0° C. This surely proves ice to possess a special power of
solidification over water. It is needless to say that the fact is
general--that a crystal of any salt placed in a saturated solution of
the salt always provokes crystallisation. Applying this fact to the
minute film of water enclosed between two appressed surfaces of ice, it
seems to me in the highest degree probable that the contact action of
Faraday will set in, that the film will freeze and cement the pieces of
ice together.[41]

[41] Both Professor Helmholtz and I have since agreed to consider the
physical cause of regelation an open question.

Apart from the present discussion, the following observation is
perhaps worth recording: It is well known that ice during a thaw
disintegrates so as to form rude prisms whose axes are at right angles
to the planes of freezing. I have often observed this action on a large
scale during the winters that I spent as a student on the banks of the
Lahn. The manner in which these prisms are in some cases formed is
extremely interesting. On close inspection, a kind of cloudiness is
observed in the interior of a mass of apparently perfect ice. Looked at
through a strong lens, this cloudiness appears as striæ at right angles
to the planes of freezing, and when the direction of vision is across
these planes the ends of the striæ are apparent. The spaces between the
striæ are composed of clear unclouded ice. When duly magnified, the
objects which produce the striæ turn out to be piles of minute liquid
flowers, whose planes are at right angles to the direction of the striæ.

       *       *       *       *       *

Since writing the above, I have been favoured with a copy of a
discourse delivered by Professor De la Rive, at the opening of the
forty-ninth meeting of the Société Helvétique, which assembled in
1865 at Geneva. From this admirable _résumé_ of our present knowledge
regarding glaciers I make the following extract, which, together with
those from the lecture of Helmholtz, will show sufficiently how the
subject is now regarded by scientific men: ‘Such, gentlemen,’ says M.
De la Rive, ‘is a description of the phenomena of glaciers, and it
now remains to explain them, to consult observation, and deduce from
it the fundamental character of the phenomena. Observation teaches us
that gravity is the motive force, and that this force acts upon a solid
body--ice--imparting to it a slow and continuous motion. What are we to
conclude from this? That ice is a solid which possesses the property
of flowing like a viscous body--a conclusion which appears very
simple, but which was nevertheless announced for the first time hardly
five-and-twenty years ago by one of the most distinguished philosophers
of Scotland, Professor James D. Forbes. This theory, for it truly is a
theory, basing itself on facts as numerous as they are well observed,
enunciates the principle that ice possesses the characteristic
properties which belong to plastic bodies. Although he did not directly
prove it, to Professor Forbes belongs not the less the great merit of
insisting on the plasticity of ice, before Faraday, in discovering the
phenomenon of regelation, enabled Tyndall to prove that the plasticity
was real, at least partially.

‘The experiment of Faraday is classical in connexion with our
subject. It consists, as you know, in this, that if two morsels of
ice be brought into contact in water, which may be even warm, they
freeze together. Tyndall immediately saw the application of Faraday’s
experiment to the theory of glaciers; he comprehended that, since
pieces of ice could thus solder themselves together, the substance
might be broken, placed in a mould, compressed, and thus compelled to
take the form of the cavity which contained it. A wooden mould, for
example, embraces a spherical cavity; placing in it fragments of ice
and squeezing them, we obtain an ice sphere; placing this sphere in a
second mould with a lenticular cavity and pressing it, we transform the
sphere into a lens. In this way we can impart any form whatever to ice.

‘Such is the discovery of Tyndall, which may well be thus named,
particularly in view of its consequences. For all these moulds
magnified become the borders of the valley in which a glacier flows.
Here the action of the hydraulic press which has served for the
experiments of the laboratory is replaced by the weight of the masses
of snow and ice collected on the summits, and exerting their pressure
on the ice which descends into the valley. Supposing, for example,
between the spherical mould and the lenticular one, a graduated series
of other moulds to exist, each of which differs very little from the
one which precedes and from that which follows it, and that a mass of
ice could be made to pass through all these moulds in succession, the
phenomenon would then become continuous. Instead of rudely breaking,
the ice would be compelled to change by insensible degrees from the
spherical to the lenticular form. It would thus exhibit a plasticity
which might be compared to that of soft wax. But ice is only plastic
under _pressure_; it is not plastic under _tension_: and this is the
important point which the vague theory of plasticity was unable to
explain. While a viscous body, like bitumen or honey, may be drawn out
in filaments by tension, ice, far from stretching in this way, breaks
like glass under this action. These points well established by Tyndall,
it became easy for him to explain the mechanism of glaciers, and by
the aid of an English geometer, Mr. William Hopkins, to show how the
direction of the crevasses of a glacier are the necessary consequences
of its motion.’

       *       *       *       *       *

[Illustration: Fig. 12.]

I have quite recently had a mould constructed for me by Mr. Becker,[42]
and yesterday (November 16, 1865) made with it an experiment which, on
account of the ease with which it may be performed, will interest all
those who care about exhibiting in a striking and instructive manner
the effects of regelation. The mould is shown in fig. 12. It consists
of two pieces of cast iron, A B C and D F G, slightly wedge-shaped
and held together by the iron rectangle R E which is slipped over
them. The inner face of A B C is shown in fig. 13. In it is hollowed
out a semiring M N, with a semicylindrical passage O leading into it.
The inner face of D F G is similarly hollowed out, so that when both
faces are placed together, as in fig. 12, they enclose a ring 4 inches
in external diameter, from M to N, and 3/4 of an inch in thickness,
with the passage O, 1 inch in diameter, into which fits the polished
iron plug P. At _q_ and _r_, fig. 13, are little pins which, fitting
into holes corresponding to them, keep the slabs A B C and D F G from
sliding over each other.

[42] I am continually indebted to this able mechanism for prompt and
intelligent aid in the carrying out of my ideas.

[Illustration: Fig. 13.]

[Illustration: Fig. 14.]

The mould being first cooled by placing it for a short time in a
mixture of ice and water, fragments of ice are stuffed into the orifice
O and driven down with a hammer by means of the plug P. The bruised and
broken ice separates at _x_, one portion going to the right, the other
to the left. Driving the ice thus into the mould, piece after piece,
it is finally filled. By removing the rectangle R E, the two halves
of the mould are then separated, and a perfect ring of ice is found
within. Two such rings soldered by regelation at _a_ are shown in fig.
14. It would be easy thus to construct a chain of ice. An hydraulic
press may of course be employed in this experiment, but it is not
necessary; with the hammer and plug beautiful rings of ice are easily
obtained by the regelation of the crushed fragments.

I have now to add the description of an experiment which suggested
itself to my ingenious friend Mr. Duppa, when he saw the ice-rings
just referred to, and which was actually executed by him yesterday
(the 16th) in the laboratory of the Royal Institution. Pouring a
quantity of plaster of paris into a proper vessel, an ice-ring was laid
upon the substance, an additional quantity of the cement being then
poured over the ring. The plaster ‘set,’ enclosing the ring within it:
the ring soon melted, leaving its perfect matrix behind. The mould
was permitted to dry, and, molten lead being poured into the space
previously occupied by the ice, a leaden ring was produced. Now ice can
be moulded into any shape: statuettes, vases, flowers, and innumerable
other ornaments can be formed from it. These enclosed in cement, in
the manner suggested by Mr. Duppa, remain intact sufficiently long
to enable the cement to set around them; they afterwards melt and
disappear, leaving behind them perfect plaster moulds, from which casts
can be taken.




V.

_CLOUDS._


From every natural fact invisible relations radiate, the apprehension
of which imparts a measure of delight; and there is a store of pleasure
of this kind ever at hand for those who have the capacity to turn
natural appearances to account. It is pleasant, for example, to lie
on one’s back upon a dry green slope and watch the clouds forming
and disappearing in the blue heaven. A few days back the firmament
was mottled with floating cumuli, from the fringes of which light of
dazzling whiteness was reflected downwards, while the chief mass of
the clouds lay in dark shadow. From the edge of one large cloud-field
stretched small streamers, which, when attentively observed, were
seen to disappear gradually, and finally to leave no trace upon the
blue sky. On the opposite fringe of the same cloud, and beyond it,
small patches of milky mist would appear, and curdle up, so as to form
little cloudlets as dense apparently as the large mass beside which
they were formed. The counter processes of production and consumption
were evidently going on at opposite sides of the cloud. Even in the
midst of the serene firmament, where a moment previously the space
seemed absolutely void, white cloud-patches were formed, their sudden
appearance exciting that kind of surprise which might be supposed to
accompany the observation of a direct creative act.

These clouds were really the indicators of what was going on in the
unseen air. Without them no motion was visible; but their appearance
and disappearance proved not only the existence of motion, but also
the want of homogeneity in the atmosphere. Though we did not see them,
currents were mingling, possessing different temperatures and carrying
different loads of invisible watery vapour. We know that clouds are
not true vapour, but vapour precipitated by cold to water. We know
also that the amount of water which the air can hold in the invisible
state depends upon its temperature; the higher the temperature of the
air, the more water will it be able to take up. But, when a portion
of warm air, carrying its invisible charge, is invaded by a current
of low temperature, the chilled vapour is precipitated, and a cloud
is the consequence. In this way two parcels of moist air, each of
which taken singly may be perfectly transparent, can produce by their
mixture an opaque cloud. In the same way a body of clear humid air,
when it strikes the cold summit of a mountain, may render that mountain
‘cloud-capped.’

An illustration of this process, which occurred some years ago in a
Swedish ball-room, is recounted by Professor Dove. The weather was
clear and cold, and the ball-room was clear and warm. A lady fainted,
and air was thought necessary to her restoration. A military officer
present tried to open the window, but it was frozen fast. He broke the
window with his sword, the cold air entered, and _it snowed in the
room_. A minute before this all was clear, the warm air sustaining
a large amount of moisture in a transparent condition. When the
colder air entered, the vapour was first condensed and then frozen.
The admission of cool air even into our London ball-rooms produces
mistiness. Mountain-chains are very effective in precipitating the
vapour of our south-westerly winds; and this sometimes to such an
extent as to produce totally different climates on the two sides of
the same mountain-group. This is very strikingly illustrated by the
observations of Dr. Lloyd on the rainfall of Ireland. Stations situated
on the south-west side of a mountain-range showed a quantity of rain
far in excess of that observed upon the north-east side. The winds in
passing over the mountains were drained of their moisture, and were
afterwards comparatively dry.

Two or three years ago I had an opportunity of witnessing a singular
case of condensation at Mortain in Normandy. The tourist will perhaps
remember a little chapel perched upon the highest summit in the
neighbourhood. A friend and I chanced to be at this point near the hour
of sunset. The air was cloudless, and the sun flooded the hillsides and
valleys with golden light. We watched him as he gradually approached
the crest of a hill, behind which he finally disappeared. Up to this
point a sunny landscape of exquisite beauty was spread before us, the
atmosphere being very transparent; but now the air seemed suddenly to
curdle into mist. Five minutes after the sun had departed, a dense
fog filled the valleys and drifted in fleecy masses up the sides of
the hills. In an incredibly short time we found ourselves enveloped
in local clouds so dense as to render our retreat a matter of some
difficulty.

In this case, before the sun had disappeared the air was evidently
nearly saturated with transparent vapour. But why did the vapour curdle
up so suddenly when the sun departed? Was it because the withdrawal of
his beams rendered the _air_ of the valleys colder, and thus caused the
precipitation of the moisture diffused through the air? No. We must
look for an explanation to a more direct action of the sun upon the
atmospheric moisture. Let me explain. The beams which reach us from the
sun are of a very composite character. A sheaf of white sunbeams is
composed of an infinitude of coloured rays, the resultant effect of all
upon the eye being the impression of whiteness. But though the colours,
and shades of colour, which enter into the composition of a sunbeam are
infinite, for the sake of convenience we divide them into seven, which
are known as the prismatic colours.

The beams of the sun, however, produce _heat_ as well as light, and
there are different _qualities_ of heat in the sunbeam as well as
different qualities of light--nay, there are copious rays of heat in
a sunbeam which give no light at all, some of which never even reach
the retina at all, but are totally absorbed by the humours of the eye.
Now, the same substance may permit rays of heat of a certain quality
to pass freely through it, while it may effectually stop rays of heat
of another quality. But in all cases the heat stopped is expended in
heating the body which stops it. Now, water possesses this _selecting
power_ in an eminent degree. It allows the blue rays of the solar beam
to pass through it with facility, but it slightly intercepts the red
rays, and absorbs with exceeding energy the _obscure rays_; and those
are the precise rays which possess the most intense heating power.

We see here at once the powerful antagonism of the sun to the
formation of visible fog, and we see, also, how the withdrawal of his
beams may be followed by sudden condensation, even before the air
has had any time to cool. As long as the solar beams swept through
the valleys of Mortain, every particle of water that came in their
way was reduced to transparent vapour by the heat which the particle
itself absorbed; or, to speak more strictly, in the presence of this
antagonism precipitation could not at all occur, and the atmosphere
remained consequently clear.[43] But the moment the sun withdrew, the
vapour followed, without opposition, its own tendency to condense, and
its sudden curdling up was the consequence.

[43] At this time I was brooding over experiments on the absorption of
radiant heat by aqueous vapour.

With regard to the _air_, its temperature may not only have remained
sensibly unchanged for some time after the setting of the sun, but it
may have actually become warmer through the heat set free by the act of
condensation. It was not, therefore, the action of cold air upon the
vapour which produced the effect, but it was the withdrawal of that
solar energy which water has the power to absorb, and by absorbing to
become dissipated in true vapour.

I once stood with a friend upon a mountain which commands a view of
the glacier of the Rhone from its origin to its end. The day had
been one of cloudless splendour, and there was something awful in the
darkness of the firmament. This deepening of the blue is believed by
those who know the mountains to be an indication of a humid atmosphere.
The transparency, however, was wonderful. The summits of Mont Cervin
and the Weisshorn stood out in clear definition, while the mighty mass
of the Finsteraarhorn rose with perfect sharpness of outline close at
hand. As long as the sun was high there was no trace of fog in the
valleys, but as he sloped to the west the shadow of the Finsteraarhorn
crept over the snow-fields at its base. A dim sea of fog began to form,
which after a time rose to a considerable height, and then rolled down
like a river along the flanks of the mountain. On entering the valley
of the Rhone, it crossed a precipitous barrier, down which it poured
like a cataract; but long before it reached the bottom it escaped from
the shadow in which it had been engendered, and was hit once more by
the direct beams of the sun. Its utter dissipation was the consequence,
and though the billows of fog rolled on incessantly from behind, the
cloud-river made no progress, but disappeared, as if by magic, where
the sunbeams played upon it. The conditions were analogous to those
which hold in the case of a glacier. Here the ice-river is incessantly
nourished by the mountain snow: it moves down its valley, but does
not advance in front. At a certain point the consumption by melting is
equal to the supply, and here the glacier ceases. In the case before
us the cloud-river, nourished by the incessant condensation of the
atmospheric vapour, moved down its valley, but ceased at the point
where the dissipating action of the sunbeams equalled the supply from
the cloud-generator behind.




VI.

_KILLARNEY._


The total amount of heat which the sun sends annually to the earth is
invariable, and hence if any portion of the earth’s surface during
any given year be colder than ordinary, we may infer with certainty
that some other portion of the surface is then warmer than ordinary.
The port of Odessa owes its importance to a case of atmospheric
compensation of this kind. Forty or fifty years ago, Western Europe
received less than its normal amount of heat; the missing sunbeams
fell upon the East, and Odessa became, to some extent, the granary
from which the hungry West was fed. The position it then assumed it
has since maintained. The atmosphere is the grand distributor of heat.
It has its cold and warm currents--vast aërial rivers, which chill or
cheer according to the proximate sources from which they are derived.
In this present year 1860 the British Isles appear to lie near the
common boundary of two such currents--the limit, however, shifting
so as to cause both to pass over us in swift succession. Near this
boundary line the atmospheric currents mingle, and the copious aqueous
precipitation which we now observe is the result.

Superadded to this source of general rain, we have at Killarney local
condensers in the neighbouring mountains. Round the cool crests of
Carrantual and his peaked and craggy brothers the moist and tilted
south-west wind curdles ceaselessly into clouds, which nourish the
moss and heather whose decomposition produces the peat which clothes
the disintegrated rocks. Grandly the vast cumuli build themselves
in the atmosphere, hanging at times lazily over the mountains and
mottling with their shadows the brown sides of the hills. Reddened
by the evening sun, these clouds cast their hues upon the lakes, the
crisped surface of which breaks up their images into broad spaces of
diffused crimson light. On other days the cumuli seem whipped into
dust, and scattered through the general air, mixing therewith as the
smoke of London mingles with the supernatant atmosphere. Day by day the
guides prophesy fine weather--the blackest cloud is ‘all for hate.’
You are assured that if you start to-day you will not get ‘a single
dhrop’ of rain; you go, and are drenched; but the guide’s purpose is
accomplished, the moderate sum of three and sixpence being added to his
private store.

In ages past these mountain condensers acted differently. The wet winds
of the ocean, which now descend in liquid showers upon the hills, once
discharged their contents as snow. And a famous deposit they must have
made. In addition to the charms which this region presents to every
eye, the mind of him who can read the rocks aright is carried back to a
time when deep snowbeds cumbered the mountain-slopes, and vast glaciers
filled the vales. In neither England nor Wales do the traces of glacial
action reach the magnitude which they exhibit here.

The Gap of Dunloe is the channel of an ancient glacier; and all through
it the scratching and polishing may be traced. The flanks of the
Purple Mountain have been planed down by the moving ice, and the rocky
amphitheatre which the guides choose for the production of echoes has
been scooped and polished by the same agency. Near the point where the
road from the Gap joins that up the Black Valley is a slab of rock,
which rivals the famous _Höllen Platte_ in Haslithal. The Black Valley,
indeed, was the mould through which a great glacier from the adjacent
mountains moved, ‘unhasting, unresting,’ grinding the rocks right and
left, and filling the entire basin now occupied by the waters of the
Upper Lake. All the islands of this lake are glacier domes. The shapes,
moreover, which have suggested the fanciful names given to some of the
rocks are entirely due to the planing of the ice. The ‘Cannon Rock,’
the ‘Giant’s Coffin,’ the ‘Man-of-War,’ and others, owe their forms to
the mighty moulding-plane which in bygone ages passed over them.

I have spoken of the echoes in the Gap of Dunloe. They are very fine,
and are usually awakened by a guide who plays a bugle, and to whom
extra wages are paid on this account. The man times his operations so
that the echo and the original sound shall not overlap, and he usually
places his guests behind a hill-brow, which partially cuts away the
direct sound, but offers no impediment to the echoes. He flourishes his
trumpet, and pauses; the rocks respond, the first return of the sound
being almost as strong as the blast itself; the sonorous pulses leap
from crag to crag, and from them to the listener’s ear, diminishing in
intensity and augmenting in softness the oftener they are reflected.
Moore’s melody of ‘The Meeting of the Waters,’ suitably played, is thus
returned with exquisite sweetness by the reflecting rocks.

The rain here is pitiless, but the march of the showering clouds over
the mountains is sometimes very grand. One really good day is all that
I have been able to number out of six spent on the banks of the Lower
Lake, and even that day was ushered in by heavy rain. Afterwards,
however, the cloud field broke, and the condensed vapours rolled
themselves up into sphered masses, which sailed majestically through
the ether. With some other visitors I rowed to the Upper Lake, landed
at the base of the Purple Mountain, and with one companion climbed the
latter to its crest. This is covered by loose masses of stone of a
purplish hue, from which the mountain derives its name.

A few days previously I had been on the top of Mangerton, a spot
selected by the guides as affording a prospect of the entire region
of the Lakes. But Mangerton is a stupid mountain, and it is climbed
by a wearisome pony track. It is incomparably inferior to the Purple
Mountain. From the latter, on one side, we look into the heart of
Magillicuddy’s Reeks, and shake hands with Carrantual across the
Gap of Dunloe. It commands a splendid mountain panorama, and on the
occasion of my visit showed the Reeks in their true character, as
cloud-generators. A light wind swept across them. Far to westward,
towards the sea, the air was cloudless; but over the Reeks its moisture
was densely precipitated, and formed there a canopy which threw an
inky gloom upon the mountains. The clouds sometimes descended so as
to touch the summits, but for the most part they floated a little way
above them, leaving the jagged outlines clear. From the Reeks the
clouds were wafted westward; but here, meeting with warmer air, they
diminished in size, the smaller ones melting quite away. Below us
gleamed the Upper Lake, running in and out amid the mountains, fringed
with woods and studded with islands covered with sunny foliage. From
this lake a long, sinuous, and narrow outlet, called the Long Range,
runs to the Middle Lake. The suddenness with which this lovely sheet of
water opens on quitting the Long Range constitutes perhaps the greatest
surprise which the traveller here encounters.

We walked along the ridge of the Purple Mountain ankle deep in elastic
moss, with glorious views at either side. Arrived at the end of its
greatest spur, the Middle and Lower Lakes with their islands, and the
wooded and tortuous peninsula between them, lay before us. No view of
the English lakes known to me could compete in loveliness with this
one. We passed onward through the heather to the brow above the Bay of
Glena, and there clambered down the mountain, helping ourselves by the
trees which grasped with gnarled roots the mossed and slippy crags.
At Glena we met our boat, and were rowed over the jerking waves to
the island of Innisfallen, and thence to our hotel. Various bits of
climbing were accomplished during my stay, and almost in every case
in opposition to the guides. The Eagle Rock, for example, a truly
noble mass, and others, were climbed, amid emphatic enunciations of
‘impossible.’ Yet these guides and boatmen are fine, hardy fellows, and
of great endurance, but they appear averse to trying their strength
under new conditions.

I write on a drenching day, and a strong wind which wails dismally
round the house has roused the Lower Lake to foam and fury. Innisfallen
looms feebly through the grey haze, but the opposite Toumies mountains
are plunged in impenetrable gloom. All round the horizon is built a
black cloud-wall, but the zenithal heaven is clear. Over the coping
of this thunderous bulwark the sun shoots his rays, which, meeting
the dropping cloud of the opposite heaven, paint upon it a complete
and magnificent bow. Here the white beam enters the front of the
falling drop, and is reflected at its back, emerging unravelled to its
component hues. But the condition is, that after being thus unravelled,
the coloured rays shall not diverge on quitting the drop. If they did,
they would be lost immediately to the senses; but they are squeezed
together to parallel sheaves, and thus their intensity is preserved
through long aërial distances. Above the vivid bow hangs its spectral
secondary brother, in which a double reflection within each raindrop
enfeebles the colours, and inverts the order of succession.

Touched by the wand of law, the dross of facts becomes gold, the
meanest being raised thereby to brotherhood with the highest. Thus the
smoke of an Irish cabin lifts our speculations to the heavenly dome.
We look through the cloudless air at the darkness of infinite space,
and are met by the azure of the firmament--we look through a long reach
of the same atmosphere at the bright sun or moon and see them orange
or red. We look through the peat-smoke at a black rock, or at the dark
branches of a yew, and see the smoke blue--we look through the same
smoke at a cloud illuminated to whiteness by the sun and find the smoke
red. The selfsame column of smoke may be projected against a bright
and a dark portion of the same cloud, and thus made to appear blue
and red at the same time. The blue belongs to the light _reflected_
from the smoke; the red to the light _transmitted_ through it. In like
manner, the hues of the atmosphere are not due to colouring matter, but
to the fact of its being a turbid medium. Through this we look at the
blackness of unillumined space and see the blue; at the western heaven
at sunset, and meet that light which steeps the clouds of evening in
orange and crimson dyes.




VII.

_SNOWDON IN WINTER._


Tainted by the city air, and with gases not natural even to the
atmosphere of London, I gladly chimed in with the proposal of an
experienced friend to live four clear days at Christmas on Welsh mutton
and mountain air. On the evening of the 26th of December 1860 Mr. Busk,
Mr. Huxley, and I found ourselves at the Penryhn Arms Hotel in Bangor.
Next morning we started betimes. The wind had howled angrily during
the night. It now swept over the frozen road, carrying the looser snow
along with it, shooting the crystals with projectile force against our
faces, and compelling us to lean forward at a considerable angle to
keep upon our feet. Our destination was Capel Curig, with a prospective
design upon Snowdon; but we had no bâtons fit for the ascent. At
Bethesda, however, after many vain enquiries in Welsh and English about
walking-sticks, we found a shop which embraced among its multitudinous
contents a sheaf of rake-handles. Two of these we purchased at
fourpence each, and had them afterwards furnished with rings and iron
spikes, at the total cost of one shilling. Thus provided, we hoped that
‘old Snowdon’s craggy chaos’ might be invaded with a hope of success.

On the morning of the 28th we issued from our hotel. A pale blue,
dashed with ochre, and blending to a most delicate green, overspread a
portion of the eastern sky. Grey cumuli, tinged ruddily here and there
as they caught the morning light, swung aloft, but melted more and more
as the day advanced. The eastern mountains were all thickly covered
with newly fallen snow. The effect was unspeakably lovely. In front of
us was Snowdon; over it and behind it the atmosphere was closely packed
with dense brown haze, the lower filaments of which reached almost
half-way down the mountain, but still left all its outline clearly
visible through the attenuated fog. No ray of sunlight fell upon the
hill, and the face which it turned towards us, too steep to hold the
snow, exhibited a precipitous slope of rock, faintly tinted by the
blue grey of its icy enamel. Below us was Llyn Mymbyr, a frozen plain;
behind us the hills were flooded with sunlight, and here and there from
the shaded slopes, which were illuminated chiefly by the light of the
firmament, shimmered a most delicate blue.

This beautiful effect deserves a word of notice; many doubtless have
observed it during the late snow. Ten days ago, in driving from
Kirtlington to Glympton, the window of my cab became partially opaque
by the condensation of the vapour of respiration. With the finger-ends
little apertures were made in the coating, and when viewed through
these the snow-covered landscape flashed incessantly with blue gleams.
They rose from the shadows of objects along the road, which shadows
were illuminated by the light of the sky. The blue light is best seen
when the eye is in motion, thus causing the images of the shadows to
pass over different parts of the retina. The whole shadow of a tree
may thus be seen with stem and branches of the most delicate blue.
I have seen similar effects upon the fresh _névés_ of the Alps, the
shadow being that of the human body looked at through an aperture in a
handkerchief thrown over the face. The same splendid effect was once
exhibited in a manner never to be forgotten by those who witnessed it,
on the sudden opening of a tent-door at sunrise on the summit of Mont
Blanc.

At Pen-y-Gwrid Busk halted, purposing to descend to Llanberis by the
road, while Huxley and I went forward to the small public-house known
as Pen Pass. Here our guide, Robert Hughes, a powerful but elderly
man, refreshed himself, and we quitted the road and proceeded for a
short distance along a car-track which seemed to wind round a spur of
Snowdon. ‘Is there no shorter way up?’ we demanded. ‘Yes; but I fear it
is now impracticable,’ was the reply. ‘Go straight on,’ said Huxley,
‘and do not fear us.’

Up the man went with a spurt, suddenly putting on all his steam. The
whisky of Pen Pass had given him a flash of energy, which we well
knew could not last. In fact, the guide, though he acquitted himself
admirably during the day, had at first no notion that we should reach
the summit; and this made him careless of preserving himself at the
outset. Toning him down a little, we went forward at a calmer pace.
Crossing the spur, we came upon a pony-track on the opposite side. It
was rendered conspicuous by the unbroken layer of snow which rested on
it. Huxley took the lead, wading knee-deep for nearly an hour.

I, wishing to escape this labour, climbed the slopes to the right,
and sought a way over the less loaded bosses of the mountain. On our
remarking to Hughes that he had never assailed Snowdon under such
conditions, he replied that he had, and under worse. The 12th of April
last, he affirmed, was a worse day, and he had led a lady on that day
almost to the summit. Unluckily for him, there was a smack of ‘bounce’
in the reply. It caused us to conclude that the same energy which had
led the lady could lead us, and hence, when Huxley fell back, the
guide was sent to the front, to break the way. He did this manfully for
nearly an hour, at the end of which he seemed very jaded, and as he sat
resting on a corner of rock I asked him whether he was tired. ‘I am,’
was his reply. Huxley gave him a sip of brandy, and I came for a short
time to the front.

I had no gaiters, and my boots were incessantly filled with snow. My
own heat sufficed for a time to melt the snow; but this clearly could
not go on for ever. My left heel first became numbed and painful; and
this increased till both feet were in great distress. I sought relief
by quitting the track and trying to get along the impending shingle
to the right. The high ridges afforded me some relief, but they were
separated by couloirs in which the snow had accumulated, and through
which I sometimes floundered waist-deep. The pain at length became
unbearable; I sat down, took off my boots and emptied them; put them
on again, tied Huxley’s pocket handkerchief round one ankle, and
my own round the other, and went forward once more. It was a great
improvement--the pain vanished, and did not return.

The scene was grand in the extreme. Before us were the buttresses of
Snowdon, crowned by his conical peak; while below us were three llyns,
black as ink, and contracting additional gloom from the shadow of the
mountain. The lines of weathering had caused the frozen rime to deposit
itself upon the rocks, as on the tendrils of a vine, the crags being
fantastically wreathed with runners of ice. The summit, when we looked
at it, damped our ardour a little; it seemed very distant, and the day
was sinking fast. From the summit the mountain sloped downward to a col
which linked it with a bold eminence to our right. At the col we aimed,
and half an hour before reaching it we passed the steepest portion
of the track. This I quitted, seeking to cut off the zig-zags, but
gained nothing but trouble by the attempt. This difficulty conquered,
the col was clearly within reach; on its curve we met a fine snow
cornice, through which we broke at a plunge, and gained safe footing on
the mountain-rim. The health and gladness of that moment were a full
recompense for the entire journey into Wales.

We went upward along the edge of the cone with the noble sweep of
the snow cornice at our left. The huts at the top were all cased in
ice, and from their chimneys and projections the snow was drawn into
a kind of plumage by the wind. The crystals had set themselves so as
to present the exact appearance of feathers, and in some cases these
were stuck against a common axis, so as accurately to resemble the
plumes in soldiers’ caps. It was 3 o’clock when we gained the summit.
Above and behind us the heavens were of the densest grey; towards the
western horizon this was broken by belts of fiery red, which nearer the
sun brightened to orange and yellow. The mountains of Flintshire were
flooded with glory, and later on, through the gaps in the ranges, the
sunlight was poured in coloured beams, which could be tracked through
the air to the places on which their radiance fell. The scene would
bear comparison with the splendours of the Alps themselves.

Next day we ascended the pass of Llanberis. The waterfalls, stiffened
into pillars of blue ice, gave it a grandeur which it might not
otherwise exhibit. The wind, moreover, was violent, and shook clouds
of snow-dust from the mountain-heads. We descended from Pen-y-Gwrid
to Beddgelert. What splendid skating surfaces the lakes presented--so
smooth as scarcely to distort the images of the hills! A snow-storm
caught us before we reached our hotel. This melted to rain during
the night. Next day we engaged a carriage for Carnarvon, but had
not proceeded more than two miles when we were stopped by the snow.
Huge barriers of it were drifted across the road; and not until the
impossibility of the thing was clearly demonstrated did we allow the
postilion to back out of his engagement. Luckily our luggage was
portable. Strapping our bags and knapsacks on our shoulders, partly
through the fields, and partly along the less encumbered portions of
the road, we reached Carnarvon on foot, and the evening of the 31st of
December saw us safe in London.




VIII.

_VOYAGE TO ALGERIA TO OBSERVE THE ECLIPSE._


The opening of the Eclipse Expedition was not propitious. Portsmouth,
on the 5th of December 1870, was swathed by a fog, which was
intensified by smoke, and traversed by a drizzle of fine rain. At
six P.M. I was on board the ‘Urgent.’ On Tuesday morning the weather
was too thick to permit of the ship’s being swung and her compasses
calibrated. The Admiral of the port, a man of very noble presence, came
on board. Under his stimulus the energy which the weather had damped
appeared to become more active, and soon after his departure we steamed
down to Spithead. Here the fog had so far lightened as to enable the
officers to swing the ship.

At three P.M. on Tuesday the 6th of December we got away, gliding
successively past Whitecliff Bay, Bembridge, Sandown, Shanklin,
Ventnor, and St. Catherine’s Lighthouse. On Wednesday morning we
sighted the Isle of Ushant, on the French side of the Channel. The
northern end of the island has been fretted by the waves into detached
tower-like masses of rock of very remarkable appearance. In the
Channel the sea was green, and opposite Ushant it was a brighter green.
On Wednesday evening we committed ourselves to the Bay of Biscay.
The roll of the Atlantic was full, but not violent. There had been
scarcely a gleam of sunshine throughout the day, but the cloud-forms
were fine, and their apparent solidity impressive. On Thursday morning
I rose refreshed, and found the green of the sea displaced by a deep
indigo blue. The whole of Thursday we steamed across the bay. We had
little blue sky, but the clouds were again grand and varied--cirrus,
stratus, cumulus, and nimbus, we had them all. Dusky hairlike trails
were sometimes dropped from the distant clouds to the sea. These were
falling showers, and they sometimes occupied the whole horizon, while
we steamed across the rainless circle which was thus surrounded.
Sometimes we plunged into the rain, and once or twice, by slightly
changing course, avoided a heavy shower. From time to time perfect
rainbows spanned the heavens from side to side. At times a bow would
appear in fragments, showing the keystone of the arch midway in air,
and its two buttresses on the horizon. In all cases the light of the
bow could be quenched by a Nicol’s prism, with its long diagonal
tangent to the arc. Sometimes gleaming patches of the firmament were
seen amid the clouds. When viewed in the proper direction, the gleam
could be quenched by a Nicol prism, a dark aperture being thus opened
into stellar space.

At sunset on Thursday the denser clouds were fiercely fringed, while
through the lighter ones seemed to issue the glow of a conflagration.
On Friday morning we sighted Cape Finisterre, the extreme end of the
arc which sweeps from Ushant round the Bay of Biscay. Calm spaces of
blue, in which floated quietly scraps of cumuli, were behind us, but
in front of us was a horizon of portentous darkness. It continued thus
threatening throughout the day. Towards evening the wind strengthened
to a gale, and at dinner it was difficult to preserve the plates
and dishes from destruction. Our thinned company hinted that the
rolling had other consequences. It was very wild when we went to bed.
I slumbered and slept, but after some time was rendered actively
conscious that my body had become a kind of projectile, which had the
ship’s side for a target. I gripped the edge of my berth to save myself
from being thrown out. Outside, I could hear somebody say that he had
been thrown from his berth, and sent spinning to the other side of the
saloon. The screw laboured violently amid the lurching; it incessantly
quitted the water, and, twirling in the air, rattled against its
bearings, and caused the ship to shudder from stem to stern. At times
the waves struck us, not with the soft impact which might be expected
from a liquid, but with the sudden solid shock of battering-rams. ‘No
man knows the force of water,’ said one of the officers, ‘until he has
experienced a storm at sea.’ These blows followed each other at quicker
intervals, the screw rattling after each of them, until, finally,
the delivery of a heavier stroke than ordinary seemed to reduce the
saloon to chaos. Furniture crashed, glasses rang, and alarmed enquiries
immediately followed. Amid the noises I heard one note of forced
laughter; it sounded very ghastly. Men tramped through the saloon, and
busy voices were heard aft, as if something there had gone wrong.

I rose, and not without difficulty got into my clothes. In the
after-cabin, under the superintendence of the able and energetic
navigating lieutenant, Mr. Brown, a group of blue-jackets were working
at the tiller-ropes. These had become loose, and the helm refused to
answer the wheel. High moral lessons might be gained on shipboard by
observing what steadfast adherence to an object can accomplish, and
what large effects are heaped up by the addition of infinitesimals. The
tiller-rope, as the blue-jackets strained in concert, seemed hardly to
move; still it did move a little, until finally, by timing the pull to
the lurching of the ship, the mastery of the rudder was obtained. I had
previously gone on deck. Round the saloon-door were a few members of
the eclipse party, who seemed in no mood for scientific observation.
Nor did I; but I wished to see the storm. I climbed the steps to the
poop, exchanged a word with Captain Toynbee, the only member of the
party to be seen on the poop, and by his direction made towards a
cleat not far from the wheel.[44] Round it I coiled my arms. With the
exception of the men at the wheel, who stood as silent as corpses, I
was alone.

[44] The cleat is a T-shaped mass of metal employed for the fastening
of ropes.

I had seen grandeur elsewhere, but this was a new form of grandeur to
me. The ‘Urgent’ is long and narrow, and during our expedition she
lacked the steadying influence of sufficient ballast. She was for
a time practically rudderless, and lay in the trough of the sea. I
could see the long ridges, with some hundreds of feet between their
crests, rolling upon the ship perfectly parallel to her sides. As
they approached they so grew upon the eye as to render the expression
‘mountains high’ intelligible. At all events, there was no mistaking
their mechanical might, as they took the ship upon their shoulders, and
swung her like a pendulum. The poop sloped sometimes at an angle which
I estimated at over forty-five degrees; wanting my previous Alpine
practice, I should have felt less confidence in my grip of the cleat.
Here and there the long rollers were tossed by interference into heaps
of greater height. The wind caught their crests, and scattered them
over the sea, the whole surface of which was seething white. The aspect
of the clouds was a fit accompaniment to the fury of the ocean. The
moon was almost full--at times concealed, at times revealed, as the
scud flew wildly over it. These things appealed to the eye, while the
ear was filled by the whistle and boom of the storm and the groaning of
the screw.

Nor was the outward agitation the only object of interest to me. I
was at once subject and object to myself, and watched with intense
interest the workings of my own mind. The ‘Urgent’ is an elderly ship.
She had been built, I was told, by a contracting firm for some foreign
Government, and had been diverted from her first purpose when converted
into a troop-ship. She had been for some time out of work, and I had
heard that one of her boilers, at least, needed repair. Our scanty but
excellent crew, moreover, did not belong to the ‘Urgent,’ but had been
gathered from other ships. Our three lieutenants were also volunteers.
All this passed swiftly through my mind as the ship shook under the
blows of the waves, and I thought that probably no one on board could
say how much of this thumping and straining the ‘Urgent’ would be able
to bear. This uncertainty caused me to look steadily at the worst, and
I tried to strengthen myself in the face of it.

But at length the helm laid hold of the water, and the ship was got
gradually round to face the waves. The rolling diminished, a certain
amount of pitching taking its place. Our speed had fallen from eleven
knots to two. I went again to bed. After a space of calm, when we
seemed crossing the vortex of a storm, heavy tossing recommenced. I
was afraid to allow myself to fall asleep, as my berth was high, and
to be pitched out of it might be attended with bruises, if not with
fractures. From Friday at noon to Saturday at noon we accomplished
sixty-six miles, or an average of less than three miles an hour. I
overheard the sailors talking about this storm. The ‘Urgent,’ according
to those that knew her, had never previously experienced anything like
it.[45]

[45] There is, it will be seen, a fair agreement between these
impressions and those so vigorously described by a scientific
correspondent of the ‘Times.’

All through Saturday the wind, though somewhat sobered, blew dead
against us. The atmospheric effects were exceedingly fine. The
cumuli resembled mountains in shape, and their peaked summits shone
as white as Alpine snows. At one place this resemblance was greatly
strengthened by a vast area of cloud, uniformly illuminated, and lying
like a _névé_ below the peaks. From it fell a kind of cloud-river,
strikingly like a glacier. The horizon at sunset was remarkable--spaces
of brilliant green between clouds of fiery red. Rainbows had been
frequent throughout the day, and at night a perfectly continuous lunar
bow spanned the heavens from side to side. Its colours were feeble;
but, contrasted with the black ground against which it rested, its
luminousness was extraordinary.

Sunday morning found us opposite to Lisbon, and at midnight we rounded
Cape St. Vincent, where the lurching seemed disposed to recommence.
Through the kindness of Lieutenant Walton, a cot had been slung for me.
It hung between a tiller-wheel and a flue, and at one A.M. I was roused
by the banging of the cot against its boundaries. But the wind was
now behind us, and we went along at a speed of eleven knots. We felt
certain of reaching Cadiz by three. But a new lighthouse came in sight,
which some affirmed to be Cadiz lighthouse, while the surrounding
houses were declared to be Cadiz itself. Out of deference to these
statements, the navigating lieutenant changed his course, and steered
for the place. A pilot came on board, and he informed us that we were
before the mouth of the Guadalquivir, and that the lighthouse was that
of Cipiòna. Cadiz was still some eighteen miles distant.

We steered towards the city, hoping to get into the harbour before
dark. But the pilot was snapped up by another vessel, and we did not
get in. We beat about during the night, and in the morning found
ourselves about fifteen miles from Cadiz. The sun rose behind the city,
and we steered straight into the light. The three-towered cathedral
stood in the midst, round which swarmed apparently a multitude of
chimney-stacks. A nearer approach showed the chimneys to be small
turrets. A pilot was taken on board; for there is a dangerous shoal
in the harbour. The appearance of the town as the sun shone upon its
white and lofty walls was singularly beautiful. We cast anchor; some
officials arrived and demanded a clean bill of health. We had none.
They would have nothing to do with us; so the yellow quarantine flag
was hoisted, and we waited for permission to land the Cadiz party.
After some hours of delay the English consul and vice-consul came
on board, and with them a Spanish officer, ablaze with gold lace
and decorations. Under slight pressure the requisite permission had
been granted. We landed our party, and in the afternoon weighed
anchor. Thanks to the kindness of our excellent paymaster, I was here
transferred to a roomier berth.

Cadiz soon sank beneath the sea, and we sighted in succession Cape
Trafalgar, Tarifa, and the revolving light of Ceuta. The water was
very calm, and the moon rose in a quiet heaven. She swung with her
convex surface downwards, the common boundary between light and
shadow being almost horizontal. A pillar of reflected light shimmered
up to us from the slightly rippled sea. I had already noticed the
phosphorescence of the water, but to-night it was stronger than usual,
especially among the foam at the bows. A bucket let down into the sea
brought up a number of the little sparkling organisms which cause
the phosphorescence. I caught some of them in my hand. And here an
appearance was observed which was new to most of us, and strikingly
beautiful to all. Standing at the bow and looking forwards, at a
distance of forty or fifty yards from the ship a number of luminous
streamers were seen rushing towards us. On nearing the vessel they
rapidly turned, like a comet round its perihelion, placed themselves
side by side, and, as parallel trails of light, kept up with the ship.
One of them placed itself right in front of the bow as a pioneer.
These comets of the sea were joined at intervals by others. Sometimes
as many as six at a time would rush at us, bend with extraordinary
rapidity round a sharp curve, and afterwards keep us company. Leaning
over the bow, and scanning the streamers closely, the frontal portion
of each revealed the outline of a porpoise. The rush of the creatures
through the water had started the phosphorescence, every spark of which
was converted by the motion of the retina into a line of light. Each
porpoise was thus wrapped in a luminous sheath. The phosphorescence did
not cease at the creature’s tail, but was carried many porpoise-lengths
behind it.

To our right we had the African hills, illuminated by the moon.
Gibraltar Rock at length became visible, but the town remained long
hidden by a belt of haze. Through this at length the brighter lamps
struggled. It was like the gradual resolution of a nebula into stars.
As the intervening depth became gradually less the mist vanished more
and more, and finally all the lamps shone through it. They formed a
bright foil to the sombre mass of rock above them. The sea was so calm
and the scene so lovely that Mr. Huggins and myself stayed on deck till
the ship was moored, near midnight. During our walking to and fro a
striking enlargement of the disc of Jupiter was observed whenever the
heated air of the funnels came between us and the planet. On passing
away from the heated air, the flat dim disc would immediately shrink
to a luminous point. The effect was one of retinal persistence. The
retinal image of the planet was set quivering in all azimuths by the
streams of heated air, describing in quick succession minute lines of
light, which summed themselves to a disc of sensible area.

At six o’clock next morning the gun at the signal station on the
summit of the rock boomed. At eight the band on board the ‘Trafalgar’
training-ship, which was in the harbour, struck up the national anthem;
and immediately afterwards a crowd of mite-like cadets swarmed up the
rigging. After the removal of the apparatus belonging to the Gibraltar
party we went on shore. Winter was in England when we left, but here
we had the warmth of summer. The vegetation was luxuriant--palm-trees,
cactuses, and aloes, all ablaze with scarlet flowers. A visit to
the Governor was proposed, as an act of necessary courtesy, and
I accompanied Admiral Ommaney and Mr. Huggins to the Convent, or
Government House. We sent in our cards, waited for a time, and were
then conducted by an orderly to his Excellency. He is a fine old man,
over six foot high, and of frank military bearing. He received us
and conversed with us in a very genial manner. He took us to see his
garden, his palms, his shaded promenades, and his orange-trees loaded
with fruit, in all of which he took manifest delight. Evidently ‘the
hero of Kars’ had fallen upon quarters after his own heart. He appeared
full of good nature, and engaged us on the spot to dine with him that
day.

We sought the town-major for a pass to visit the lines. While awaiting
his arrival I purchased a stock of white glass bottles, with a view
to experiments on the colour of the sea. Mr. Huggins and myself,
who wished to see the rock, were taken by Captain Salmond to the
library, where a model of Gibraltar is kept, and where we had a capital
preliminary lesson. At the library we met Colonel Maberly, a courteous
and kindly man, who gave us good advice regarding our excursion. He
sent an orderly with us to the entrance of the lines. The orderly
handed us over to an intelligent Irishman, who was directed to show
us everything that we desired to see, and to hide nothing from us.
We took the ‘upper lines,’ traversed the galleries hewn through the
limestone, looked through the embrasures, which opened like doors in
the precipice, over the hills of Spain, reached St. George’s Hall, and
went still higher, emerging on the summit of one of the noblest cliffs
I have ever seen.

Beyond were the Spanish lines, marked by a line of white sentry-boxes;
nearer were the English lines, less conspicuously marked out; and
between both was the neutral ground. Behind the Spanish lines was the
conical hill called the Queen of Spain’s Chair. The general aspect
of Spain from the rock is bold and rugged. Doubling back from the
galleries, we struck upwards towards the crest, reached the signal
station, where we indulged in shandy-gaff and bread and cheese. Thence
to O’Hara’s Tower, the highest point of the rock. It was built by a
former Governor, who, forgetful of the laws of terrestrial curvature,
thought he might look from the tower into the port of Cadiz. The tower
is riven, and may be climbed along the edges of the crack. We got to
the top of it; thence descended the curious Mediterranean Stair--a
zigzag, mostly of steps down a steeply falling slope, amid palmetto
brush, aloes, and prickly pear.

Passing over the Windmill Hill, we were joined at the ‘Governor’s
Cottage’ by a car, and drove afterwards to the lighthouse at Europa
Point. The tower was built, I believe, by Queen Adelaide, and it
contains a fine dioptric apparatus of the first order, constructed by
the Messrs. Chance of Birmingham. At the appointed hour we were at the
Convent. During dinner the same genial traits which appeared in the
morning were still more conspicuous. The freshness of the Governor’s
nature showed itself best when he spoke of his old antagonist in arms,
Mouravieff. Chivalry in war is consistent with its stern prosecution.
These two men were chivalrous, and after striking the last blow became
friends for ever. Our kind and courteous reception at Gibraltar is a
thing to be remembered with pleasure.

On the 15th of December we committed our selves to the Mediterranean.
The views of Gibraltar with which we are most acquainted represent it
as a huge ridge; but its aspect, end on, both from the Spanish lines
and from the other side, is truly noble. There is a sloping bank of
sand at the back of the rock, which I was disposed to regard simply as
the _débris_ of the limestone. I wished to let myself down upon it, but
had not the time. My friend Mr. Busk, however, assures me that it is
silica, and that the same sand constitutes the adjacent neutral ground.
There are theories afloat as to its having been blown from Sahara.
The Mediterranean throughout this first day, and indeed throughout
the entire voyage to Oran, was of less deep a blue than the Atlantic.
Possibly the quantity of organisms may have modified the colour. At
night the phosphorescence was delicious, breaking with the suddenness
of a snapped spring along the crests of the waves formed by the port
and starboard bows. Its strength was not uniform. Having flashed
brilliantly for a time, it would in part subside, and afterwards regain
its vigour. Several large phosphorescent masses of weird appearance
also floated past.

On the morning of the 16th we sighted the fort and lighthouse of Marsa
el Kibir, and beyond them the white walls of Oran lying in the bight
of a bay, sheltered by dominant hills. The sun was shining brightly;
during our whole voyage we had not had so fine a day. The wisdom
which had led us to choose Oran as our place of observation seemed
demonstrated. A rather excitable pilot came on board, and he guided us
in behind the Mole, which had suffered much damage last year from an
unexplained outburst of waves from the Mediterranean. Both port and bow
anchors were cast into deep water. With three huge hawsers the ship’s
stern was made fast to three gun-pillars fixed in the Mole; and here
for a time the ‘Urgent’ rested from her labours.

M. Janssen, who had rendered his name celebrated by his observations
of the eclipse in India in 1868, when he showed the solar flames to
be eruptions of incandescent hydrogen, was already encamped in the
open country about eight miles from Oran. On the 2nd of December he
had quitted Paris in a balloon, with a strong young sailor as his
assistant, had descended near the mouth of the Loire, seen M. Gambetta,
and received from him encouragement and aid. On the day of our arrival
his encampment was visited by Mr. Huggins, and the kind and courteous
Engineer of the Port drove me subsequently in his own phaeton to the
place. It bore the best repute as regards freedom from haze and fog,
and commanded an open outlook, but it was inconvenient for us on
account of its distance from the ship. The place next in repute was the
railway station, between two and three miles distant from the Mole. It
was inspected, but, being enclosed, was abandoned for an eminence in
an adjacent garden, the property of Mr. Hinshelwood, a Scotchman who
had settled some years previously as an esparto merchant in Oran,[46]
and who in the most liberal manner placed his ground at the disposition
of the party. Here the tents were pitched on the Saturday by Captain
Salmond and his intelligent corps of sappers, the instruments being
erected on the Monday under cover of the tents.

[46] Esparto is a kind of grass now much used in the manufacture of
paper.

Close to the railway station runs a new loopholed wall of defence,
through which the highway passes into the open country. Standing on the
highway, and looking southwards, about twenty yards to the right is a
small bastionet, intended to carry a gun or two. Its roof I thought
would form an admirable basis for my telescope, while the view of the
surrounding country was unimpeded in all directions. The authorities
kindly allowed me the use of this bastionet. Two men, one a blue-jacket
named Elliot, and the other a marine named Hill, were placed at my
disposal by Lieutenant Walton; and thus aided, on Monday morning I
mounted my telescope. The instrument was new to me, and I wished to
master all the details of its manipulation.

After some hours of discipline, and as the day was sobering towards
twilight, the telescope was dismounted and put under cover. Mr.
Huggins joined me, and we visited together the Arab quarter of Oran.
The flat-roofed houses appeared very clean and white. The street was
filled with loiterers, and the thresholds were occupied by picturesque
groups. Some of the men are very fine; we saw many straight, manly
fellows who must have been six foot four in height. They passed us
with perfect indifference, evincing no anger, suspicion, or curiosity,
hardly caring in fact to glance at us as we passed. In one instance
only during my stay at Oran was I spoken to by an Arab. He was a tall,
good-humoured fellow, who came smiling up to me, and muttered something
about ‘les Anglais.’ The mixed population of Oran is picturesque in
the highest degree: the Jews, rich and poor, varying in their costumes
as their wealth varies--the Arabs more picturesque still, and of all
shades of complexion--the negroes, the Spaniards, the French, all
grouped together, and each preserving their own individuality, formed a
picture intensely interesting me.

On Tuesday, the 20th, I was early at the bastionet, with the view of
schooling both myself and my men. The night had been very squally. The
sergeant of the sappers took charge of our key, and on Tuesday morning
Elliot went for it. He brought back the intelligence that the tents
had been blown down, and the instruments overturned. Among these was a
large and valuable equatorial from the Royal Observatory, Greenwich.
It seemed hardly possible that this instrument, with its wheels and
verniers and delicate adjustments, could have escaped uninjured from
such a fall. This, however, was the case; and during the day all the
overturned instruments were restored to their places, and found to be
in practical working order. This and the following day were devoted
to incessant schooling. I had come out as a general star-gazer, and
not with the intention of devoting myself to the observation of any
particular phenomenon. I wished to see the whole--the first contact,
the advance of the moon, and the successive swallowing up of the solar
spots, the breaking of the last line of crescent by the lunar mountains
into Bailey’s beads, the advance of the shadow through the air, the
appearance of the corona and prominences at the moment of totality, the
radiant streamers of the corona, the internal structure of the flames,
a glance through a polariscope, a sweep round the landscape with the
naked eye, the reappearance of the solar limb through Bailey’s beads,
and, finally, the retreat of the lunar shadow through the air.

For these observations I was provided with a telescope of admirable
definition, mounted, adjusted, packed, and most liberally placed at my
disposal by Mr. Warren De la Rue. The telescope grasped the whole of
the sun, and a considerable portion of the space surrounding it. But it
would not take in the probable extreme limits of the corona. For this
the ‘finder’ was suitable; but, instead of it, I had lashed on to the
large telescope a light but powerful instrument, constructed by Ross,
and lent to me by Mr. Huggins. I was also furnished with an excellent
binocular by Mr. Dallmeyer. In fact, no man could have been more
efficiently supported than I was. It required a strict parcelling out
of the two minutes and some seconds of totality to embrace in them the
entire series of observations. These, while the sun remained visible,
were to be made with an unsilvered diagonal eyepiece, which reflected
but a small fraction of the sun’s light, this fraction being still
further toned down by a dark glass. At the moment of totality the dark
glass was to be removed, and a silver reflector pushed in, so as to
get the maximum of light from the corona and prominences. The time of
totality was distributed as follows:

  1. Observe approach of shadow through the air: totality.
  2. Telescope                    30 seconds.
  3. Finder                       30 seconds.
  4. Double image prism           15 seconds.
  5. Naked eye                    10 seconds.
  6. Finder or binocular          20 seconds.
  7. Telescope                    20 seconds.
  8. Observe retreat of shadow.

It was proposed to begin and end with the telescope, so that any change
in the field of view occurring during the totality might be noticed.
Elliot stood beside me, watch in hand, and furnished with a lantern.
He called out at the end of each interval, and I moved from telescope
to finder, from finder to polariscope, from polariscope to naked eye,
from naked eye back to finder, from finder to telescope, abandoning the
instrument finally to observe the retreating shadow. All this we went
over twenty times, while looking at the actual sun, and keeping him in
the middle of the field. It was my object to render the repetition of
the lesson so mechanical as to leave no room for flurry, forgetfulness,
or excitement. Volition was not to be called upon, nor judgment
exercised, but a well-beaten path of routine was to be followed.
Had the opportunity occurred, I think the programme would have been
strictly carried out.

But the opportunity did not occur. For several days the weather had
been ill-natured. We had wind so strong as to render the hawsers at
the stern of the ‘Urgent’ as rigid as iron, and, therefore, to destroy
the navigating lieutenant’s sleep. We had clouds, a thunder-storm,
and some rain. Still the hope was held out that the atmosphere would
cleanse itself, and if it did we were promised an air of extraordinary
limpidity. Early on the 22nd we were all at our posts. Spaces of blue
in the early morning gave us some encouragement, but all depended on
the relation of these spaces to the surrounding clouds. Which of them
were to grow as the day advanced? The wind was high, and to secure the
steadiness of my instrument I was forced to retreat behind a projection
of the bastionet, place stones upon its stand, and, further, to avail
myself of the shelter of a sail. My practised men fastened the sail
at the top, and loaded it with boulders at the bottom. It was tried
severely, but it stood firm.

The clouds and blue spaces fought for a time with varying success.
The sun was hidden and revealed at intervals, hope oscillating in
synchronism with the changes of the sky. At the moment of first contact
a dense cloud intervened, but a minute or two afterwards the cloud had
passed, and the encroachment of the black body of the moon was evident
upon the solar disc. The moon marched onward, and I saw it at frequent
intervals; a large group of spots were approached and swallowed up.
Subsequently I caught sight of the lunar limb as it cut through the
middle of a large spot. The spot was not to be distinguished from the
moon, but rose like a mountain above it. The clouds, when thin, could
be seen as grey scud drifting across the black surface of the moon;
but they thickened more and more, and made the intervals of clearness
scantier. During these moments I watched with an interest bordering
upon fascination the march of the silver sickle of the sun across the
field of the telescope. It was so sharp and so beautiful. No trace
of the lunar limb could be observed beyond the sun’s boundary. Here,
indeed, it could only be relieved by the corona, which was utterly cut
off by the dark glass. The blackness of the moon beyond the sun was, in
fact, confounded with the blackness of space.

Beside me was Elliot with the watch and lantern, while Lieutenant
Archer, of the Royal Engineers, had the kindness to take charge of
my note-book. I mentioned, and he wrote rapidly down, such things as
seemed worthy of remembrance. Thus my hands and mind were entirely
free; but it was all to no purpose. A patch of sunlight fell and rested
upon the landscape some miles away. It was the only illuminated spot
within view. But to the north-west there was still a space of blue
which might reach us in time. Within seven minutes of totality another
small space towards the zenith became very dark. The atmosphere was,
as it were, on the brink of a precipice; it was charged with humidity,
which required but a slight chill to bring it down in clouds. This was
furnished by the withdrawal of the solar beams; the clouds did come
down, covering up the space of blue on which our hopes had so long
rested. I abandoned the telescope and walked to and fro, like a leopard
in its cage. As the moment of totality approached, the descent towards
darkness was as obvious as a falling stone. I looked towards a distant
ridge, where I knew the darkness would first appear. At the moment a
fan of beams, issuing from the hidden sun, was spread out over the
southern heavens. These beams are bars of alternate light and shade,
produced in illuminated haze by the shadows of floating cloudlets of
varying density. The beams are really parallel, but by an effect of
perspective they appear divergent, like a fan, having the sun, in fact,
for their point of intersection. The darkness took possession of the
ridge to which I have referred, lowered upon M. Janssen’s observatory,
passed over the southern heavens, blotting out the beams as if a
sponge had been drawn across them. It then took successive possession
of three spaces of blue sky in the south-eastern atmosphere. I again
looked towards the ridge. A glimmer as of day-dawn was behind it, and
immediately afterwards the fan of beams which had been for more than
two minutes absent revived. The eclipse of 1870 had ended, and, as far
as the corona was concerned, we had been defeated.

Even in the heart of the eclipse the darkness was by no means perfect.
Small print could be read. In fact, the clouds which rendered the
day a dark one, by scattering light into the shadow, rendered it
less intense than it would have been had the atmosphere been without
cloud. In the more open spaces I sought for stars, but could find
none. There was a lull in the wind before and after totality, but
during the totality the wind was strong. I waited for some time on the
bastionet, hoping to get a glimpse of the moon on the opposite border
of the sun, but in vain. The clouds continued, and some rain fell.
The day brightened somewhat afterwards, and, having packed all up, in
the sober twilight Mr. Crookes and myself climbed the heights above
the fort of Vera Cruz. From this eminence we had a very noble view
over the Mediterranean and the flanking African hills. The sunset was
remarkable, and the whole outlook exceedingly fine.

The able and well-instructed medical officer of the ‘Urgent,’ Mr.
Goodman, observed the following temperatures during the progress of the
eclipse:

  Hour      Deg.
  11.45     56
  11.55     55
  12.10     54
  12.37     53
  12.39     52
  12.43     51
   1.5      52
   1.27     53
   1.44     56
   2.10     57

The minimum temperature occurred some minutes after totality, when a
slight rain fell.

The wind was so strong on the 23rd that Captain Henderson would not
venture out. Guided by Mr. Goodman, I visited a cave scooped into a
remarkable stratum of shell-breccia, and, thanks to my guide, secured
specimens. Mr. Busk informs me that a precisely similar breccia
is found at Gibraltar at approximately the same level. During the
afternoon Admiral Ommaney and myself drove to the fort of Marsa el
Kibir. The fortification is of ancient origin, the Moorish arches being
still there in decay, but the fort is now very strong. About four or
five hundred dragoons, fine-looking men, were looking after their
horses, waiting for a lull to enable them to embark for France. One of
their officers was wandering in a very solitary fashion over the fort.
We had some conversation with him. He had been at Sedan, had been taken
prisoner, but had effected his escape. He shook his head when we spoke
of the termination of the war, and predicted its long continuance.
There was bitterness in his tone as he spoke of the charges of treason
which had been so lightly levelled against French commanders. The green
waves raved round the promontory on which the fort stands, smiting the
rocks, breaking into snow, and jumping, after impact, to a height of
a hundred feet and more into the air. On our return our vehicle broke
down through the loss of a wheel. The Admiral went on board, while I
hung long over the agitated sea. The little horses of Oran well merit a
passing word. Their speed and endurance, which are both heavily drawn
upon by their drivers, are extraordinary.

The wind sinking, we lifted anchor on the 24th. For some hours we went
pleasantly along; but during the afternoon the storm revived, and it
blew heavily against us all the night. When we came opposite the Bay
of Almeria, on the 25th, the captain turned the ship, and steered
into the bay, where, under the shadow of the Sierra Nevada, we passed
Christmas night in peace. Next morning ‘a rose of dawn’ rested on the
snows of the adjacent mountains, while a purple haze was spread over
the lower hills. I had no notion that Spain possessed so fine a range
of mountains as the Sierra Nevada. The height is considerable, but the
form also is such as to get the maximum of grandeur out of the height.
We got away at eight A.M., passing for a time through shoal water, the
bottom of which had been evidently stirred up. The adjacent land seemed
eroded in a remarkable manner. Doubtless it has its times of flood,
which excavate these valleys and ravines, and leave those singular
ridges behind. Towards evening I climbed the mainmast, and, standing
on the crosstrees, saw the sun set amid a blaze of fiery clouds. The
wind was strong and bitterly cold, and I was glad to return to the deck
along a rope which stretched from the mast-head to the ship’s side.
That night we cast anchor beside the Mole of Gibraltar.

On the morning of the 27th, in company with two friends, I drove to
the Spanish lines, with the view of seeing the rock from that side. It
is an exceedingly noble mass. The Peninsular and Oriental mail-boat
had been signalled and had come. Heavy duties called me homeward, and
by transferring myself from the ‘Urgent’ to the mail-steamer I should
gain three days. I hired a boat, rowed to the steamer, learned that
she was to start at one, and returned with all speed to the ‘Urgent.’
Making known to Captain Henderson my wish to get away, he expressed
doubts as to the possibility of reaching the mail-steamer in time. With
his accustomed kindness, he, however, placed a boat at my disposal.
Four hardy fellows and one of the ship’s officers jumped into it; my
luggage, hastily thrown together, was tumbled in afterwards, and we
were immediately on our way. We had nearly four miles to row in about
twenty minutes; but we hoped the mail-boat might not be punctual. For a
time we watched her anxiously; there was no motion; we came nearer, but
the flags were not yet hauled in. The men put forth all their strength,
animated by the exhortations of the officer at the helm. The roughness
of the sea rendered their efforts to some extent nugatory: still we
were rapidly approaching the steamer. At length she moved, punctually
almost to the minute, at first slowly, but soon with quickened pace. We
turned to the left, so as to cut across her bows. Five minutes’ pull
would have brought us up to her. The officer waved his cap and I my
hat. ‘If they could only see us, they might back to us in a moment.’
But they did not see us, or if they did, they paid no attention to
us. I returned to the ‘Urgent,’ discomfited, but grateful to the fine
fellows who had wrought so hard to carry out my wishes.

Glad of the quiet, in the sober afternoon I took a walk towards Europa
Point. The sky darkened, and heavy squalls passed at intervals. Rain
began to fall, and I returned home. Private theatricals were at the
Convent, and the kind and courteous Governor had sent cards to the
eclipse party. I failed in my duty in not going. I had heard of St.
Michael’s Cave as rivalling, if not outrivalling, the Mammoth Cave of
Kentucky. On the 28th Messrs. Crookes, Carpenter, and myself, guided
by a military policeman who understood his work, explored the cavern.
The mouth is about 1,100 feet above the sea. We zigzagged up to it,
and first were led into an aperture in the rock some height above the
true entrance of the cave. In this upper cavern we saw some tall and
beautiful stalactite pillars.

The water drips from the roof charged with bicarbonate of lime.
Exposed to the air, the carbonic acid partially escapes, and the
simple carbonate of lime, which is hardly at all soluble in water,
deposits itself as a solid, forming stalactites and stalagmites. Even
the exposure of chalk or limestone water to the open air partially
softens it. A specimen of the Redbourne water exposed by Messrs.
Graham, Miller, and Hofmann in a shallow basin, fell from eighteen
degrees to nine degrees of hardness. The softening process of Clark is
virtually a hastening of the natural process. Here, however, instead of
being permitted to evaporate, half the carbonic acid is appropriated
by lime, the half thus taken up, as well as the remaining half, being
precipitated. The solid precipitate is permitted to sink, and the clear
supernatant liquid is limpid soft water.

We returned to the real mouth of St. Michael’s Cave, which is entered
by a wicket. The floor was somewhat muddy, and the roof and walls were
wet. Our guide took off his coat, but we did not follow his example. We
were soon in the midst of a natural temple, where tall columns sprang
complete from floor to roof, while incipient columns were growing
to meet each other, upwards and downwards. The water which trickles
from the stalactite, after having in part yielded up its carbonate of
lime, falls upon the floor vertically underneath, and there builds
the stalagmite. Consequently, the pillars grow from above and below
simultaneously along the same vertical. It is easy to distinguish the
stalagmitic from the stalactitic portion of the pillars. The former
is always divided into short segments by protuberant rings, as if
deposited periodically, while the latter presents a uniform surface.
In some cases the points of inverted cones of stalactite rested on the
centres of pillars of stalagmite. The process of solidification and the
architecture were alike beautiful.

We followed our guide through various branches and arms of the cave,
climbed and descended steps, halted at the edges of dark shafts and
apertures, squeezed ourselves through narrow passages, where the sober
grey of my coat suffered less than the black of my companions’. From
time to time we halted, while Mr. Crookes illuminated with ignited
magnesium wire the roof, columns, dependent spears, and graceful
drapery of the stalactite. Once, coming to a magnificent cluster of
icicle-like spears, we helped ourselves to specimens. There was some
difficulty in detaching the more delicate ones, their fragility was so
great. A consciousness of vandalism which smote me at the time haunts
me still; for, though our requisitions were moderate, this beauty ought
not to be at all invaded. Pendent from the roof in their natural
habitat, nothing can exceed their delicate beauty; they _live_, as it
were, surrounded by organic connections. In London they are curious,
but not beautiful. Of gathered shells Emerson writes:

    I wiped away the weeds and foam,
    And brought my sea-born treasures home:
    But the poor, unsightly, noisome things
    Had left their beauty on the shore,
    With the sun, and the sand, and the wild uproar.

The promontory of Gibraltar is so burrowed with caverns that it has
been called the Hill of Caves. They are apparently related to the
geologic disturbances which the rock has undergone. The earliest
of these is the tilting of the once horizontal strata. Suppose a
force acting upon the promontory at its southern extremity, near
Europa Point, tending to twist the strata in a direction opposed
to that of the hands of a watch, and suppose the rock to be of a
partially yielding character, such a force would turn the strata into
screw-surfaces, the greatest amount of twisting being endured near the
point of application of the force. Such a twisting the rock appears to
have suffered; but instead of the twist fading gradually and uniformly
off in passing from south to north, the want of uniformity in the
material has produced lines of dislocation where there are abrupt
changes in the amount of twist. Thus, at the northern end of the rock
the dip to the west is nineteen degrees; in the middle hill it is
thirty-eight degrees; in the centre of the south hill, or Sugar Loaf,
it is fifty-seven degrees. At the southern extremity of the Sugar Loaf
the strata are vertical, while further to the south they actually turn
over and dip to the east.

The rock is thus divided into three sections, separated from each other
by surfaces of dislocation, where the rock is much wrenched and broken.
These places of dislocation are called the Northern and Southern
Quebrada, from the Spanish ‘Tierra Quebrada,’ or broken ground; and
it is at these places that the inland caves of Gibraltar are almost
exclusively found. Based on the observations of Dr. Falconer and
himself, an excellent and most interesting account of these caves, and
of the human remains and works of art which they contain, was given
by Mr. Busk at the meeting of the Congress of Prehistoric Archæology
at Norwich, and afterwards printed in the ‘Transactions’ of the
Congress.[47] Long subsequently to the operation of the twisting force
just referred to, the promontory underwent various changes of level.
There are sea-terraces and layers of shell-breccia along its flanks,
and numerous caves which, unlike the inland one, are the product of
marine erosion. The Apes’ Hill, on the African side of the strait, Mr.
Busk informs me has undergone similar disturbances.[48]

[47] In this essay Mr. Busk refers to the previous labours of Mr.
Smith, of Jordan Hill, to whom we owe most of our knowledge of the
geology of the rock.

[48] No one can rise from the perusal of Mr. Busk’s paper without a
feeling of admiration for the principal discoverer and indefatigable
explorer of the Gibraltar caves, the late Captain Frederick Brome.

In the harbour of Gibraltar, on the morning of our departure, I resumed
a series of observations on the colour of the sea. On my way out I had
collected a number of specimens, with a view to subsequent examination.
But the bottles were claret bottles, and I could by no means feel sure
of their purity. At Gibraltar, therefore, I purchased fifteen white
glass bottles, with ground glass stoppers, and at Cadiz, thanks to
the friendly guidance of Mr. Cameron, I secured a dozen more. These
seven-and-twenty bottles were filled with water, taken at different
places between Oran and Spithead.

And here let me express my warmest acknowledgments to Captain
Henderson, the commander of H.M.S. ‘Urgent,’ who aided me in my
observations in every possible way. Indeed, my best thanks are due to
all the officers for their unfailing courtesy and help. The captain
placed at my disposal his own coxswain, an intelligent fellow named
Thorogood, who skilfully attached a cord to each bottle, weighted it
with lead, cast it into the sea, and, after three successive rinsings,
filled it under my own eyes. The contact of jugs, buckets, or other
vessels was thus avoided, and even the necessity of pouring the water
out afterwards through the dirty London air.

The mode of examination applied to these bottles after my return to
London is in some sense complementary to that of the microscope, and
may I think materially aid enquiries conducted with that instrument. In
microscopic examination attention is directed to a small portion of the
liquid, the aim being to detect the individual suspended particles. In
my case, a large portion of the liquid is illuminated by a powerfully
condensed beam, its general condition being revealed through the light
scattered by suspended particles. Care is taken to defend the eye from
the access of all other light, and, thus defended, it becomes an organ
of inconceivable delicacy. Were water of uniform density perfectly free
from suspended matter, it would, in my opinion, scatter no light at
all. The track of a luminous beam could not, I think, be seen in such
water. But an amount of impurity so infinitesimal as to be scarcely
expressible in numbers, and the individual particles of which are so
small as wholly to elude the microscope, may, when examined by the
method alluded to, produce not only sensible, but striking, effects
upon the eye.

The results of the examination of nineteen bottles, filled at various
places between Gibraltar and Spithead, are here tabulated:

 No.|   Locality              |Colour of Sea|Appearance in Electric Beam
 ---+-------------------------+-------------+------------------------------
  1 |Gibraltar Harbour        |Green        |Thick with fine particles
  2 |Two miles from Gibraltar |Clearer green|Thick with very fine particles
  3 |Off Cabreta Point        |Bright green |Still thick, but less so
  4 |Off Cabreta Point        |Black-indigo |Much less thick, very pure
  5 |Off Tarifa               |Undecided    |Thicker than No. 4
  6 |Beyond Tarifa            |Cobalt-blue  |Much purer than No. 5
  7 |Twelve miles from Cadiz  |Yellow-green |Very thick
  8 |Cadiz Harbour            |Yellow-green |Exceedingly thick
  9 |Fourteen miles from Cadiz|Yellow-green |Thick, but less so
 10 |Fourteen miles from Cadiz|Bright green |Much less thick
 11 |Between Capes St. Mary   |             |
    |   and Vincent           |Deep indigo  | Very little matter, very pure
 12 |Off the Burlings         |Strong green |Thick with fine matter
 13 |Beyond the Burlings      |Indigo       |Very little matter, pure
 14 |Off Cape Finisterre      |Undecided    |Less pure
 15 |Bay of Biscay            |Black-indigo |Very little matter, very pure
 16 |Bay of Biscay            |Indigo       |Very fine matter, Iridescent
 17 |Off Ushant               |Dark green   |A good deal of matter
 18 |Off St. Catherine’s      |Yellow green |Exceedingly thick
 19 |Spithead                 |Green        |Exceedingly thick

Here, in the first instance, we have three specimens of water,
described as green, a clearer green, and bright green, taken in
Gibraltar Harbour, at a point two miles from the harbour, and off
Cabreta Point. The home examination showed that the first was thick
with suspended matter, the second less thick, and the third still less
thick. Thus the green brightened as the suspended matter became less.

Previous to the fourth observation our excellent navigating lieutenant,
Mr. Brown, steered along the coast, thus avoiding the adverse current
which sets in through the Strait of Gibraltar from the Atlantic to
the Mediterranean. He was at length forced to cross the boundary of
the Atlantic current, which was defined with extraordinary sharpness.
On the one side of it the water was a vivid green, on the other a deep
blue. Standing at the bow of the ship, a bottle could be filled with
blue water, while at the same moment a bottle cast from the stern could
be filled with bright green water. Two bottles were secured, one on
each side of this remarkable boundary. In the distance the Atlantic
had the hue called ultramarine; but looked fairly down upon, it was of
almost inky blackness--black qualified by a trace of indigo.

What change does the home examination here reveal? In passing to
indigo, the water becomes suddenly augmented in purity, the suspended
matter has become suddenly less. Off Tarifa, the deep indigo
disappears, and the sea is undecided in colour. Accompanying this
change, we have a rise in the quantity of suspended matter. Beyond
Tarifa, we change to cobalt-blue, the suspended matter falling at
the same time in quantity. This water is distinctly purer than the
green. We approach Cadiz, and at twelve miles from the city get into
yellow-green water; this the London examination shows to be thick with
suspended matter. The same is true of Cadiz Harbour, and also of a
point fourteen miles from Cadiz in the homeward direction. Here there
is a sudden change from yellow-green to a bright emerald-green, and
accompanying the change a sudden fall in the quantity of suspended
matter. Between Cape St. Mary and Cape St. Vincent the water changes to
the deepest indigo. In point of purity, this indigo water is shown by
the home examination to transcend the emerald-green water.

We now reach the remarkable group of rocks called the Burlings, and
find the water between the shore and the rocks a strong green; the
home examination shows it to be thick with fine matter. Fifteen or
twenty miles beyond the Burlings we come again into indigo water, from
which the suspended matter has in great part disappeared. Off Cape
Finisterre, about the place where the ‘Captain’ went down, the water
becomes green, and the home examination pronounces it to be thicker.
Then we enter the Bay of Biscay, where the indigo resumes its power,
and where the home examination shows the greatly augmented purity of
the water. A second specimen of water taken from the Bay of Biscay
held in suspension fine particles of a peculiar kind; the size of them
was such as to render the water richly iridescent. It showed itself
green, blue, or salmon colour, according to the direction of the line
of vision. Finally, we come to our last two bottles, the one taken
opposite St. Catherine’s lighthouse, in the Isle of Wight, the other at
Spithead. The sea at both these places was green, and both specimens,
as might be expected, were pronounced by the home examination to be
thick with suspended matter.

Two distinct series of observations are here referred to--the one
consisting of direct observations of the colour of the sea, conducted
during the voyage from Gibraltar to Portsmouth; the other conducted
in the laboratory of the Royal Institution. And here it is to be
noted that in the home examination I never knew what water I had in
my hands. The labels, which had written upon them the names of the
localities, had been tied up, all information regarding the source of
the water being thus precluded. The bottles were simply numbered, and
not till all the waters had been examined were the labels opened, and
the locality and sea-colour corresponding to the various specimens
ascertained. I must, therefore, have been perfectly unbiassed in my
home observations, and they, I think, clearly establish the association
of the green colour of sea-water with fine suspended matter, and the
association of the ultramarine colour, and more especially of the
black-indigo hue of sea-water, with the comparative absence of such
matter.

What, in the first place, is the cause of the dark hue of the deep
ocean?[49] A preliminary remark or two will clear our way towards an
explanation. Colour resides in white light, appearing generally when
any constituent of the white light is withdrawn. The hue of a purple
liquid, for example, is immediately accounted for by its action on a
spectrum. It cuts out the yellow and green, and allows the red and
blue to pass through. The blending of these two colours produces the
purple. But while the liquid attacks with special energy the yellow and
green colours, it enfeebles the whole spectrum; and by increasing the
thickness of the stratum we absorb the whole of the light. The colour
of a blue liquid is similarly accounted for. It first extinguishes the
red; then, as the thickness augments, it attacks the orange, yellow,
and green in succession; the blue alone finally remaining. But even it
might be extinguished by a sufficient depth of liquid.

[49] A note, written to me on October 22, by my friend Canon Kingsley,
contains the following reference to this point: ‘I have never seen the
Lake of Geneva, but I thought of the brilliant dazzling dark blue of
the mid-Atlantic under the sunlight, and its black-blue under cloud,
both so solid that one might leap off the sponson on to it without
fear; this was to me the most wonderful thing which I saw on my voyages
to and from the West Indies.’

And now we are prepared for a brief, but tolerably complete, statement
of the action of sea-water upon light, to which it owes its darkness.
The spectrum embraces three classes of rays--the thermal, the visual,
and the chemical. These divisions overlap each other; the thermal
rays are in part visual, the visual rays in part chemical, and
_vice versâ_. The vast body of thermal rays is beyond the red, being
invisible. These rays are attacked with exceeding energy by water.
They are absorbed close to the surface of the sea, and are the great
agents in evaporation. At the same time the whole spectrum suffers
enfeeblement; water attacks all its rays, but with different degrees
of energy. Of the visual rays, the red are attacked first, and first
extinguished. While the red is disappearing the remaining colours
are enfeebled. As the solar beam plunges deeper into the sea, orange
follows red, yellow follows orange, green follows yellow, and the
various shades of blue, where the water is deep enough, follow green.
Absolute extinction of the solar beam would be the consequence if the
water were deep and uniform; and if it contained no suspended matter,
such water would be as black as ink. A reflected glimmer of ordinary
light would reach us from its surface, as it would from the surface of
actual ink; but no light, hence no colour, would reach us from the body
of the water.

In very clear and very deep sea-water this condition is approximately
fulfilled, and hence the extraordinary darkness of such water. The
indigo, to which I have already referred, is, I believe, to be ascribed
in part to the suspended matter, which is never absent, even in the
purest natural water, and in part to the slight reflection of the
light from the limiting surfaces of strata of different densities.
A modicum of light is thus thrown back to the eye before the depth
necessary to absolute extinction has been attained. An effect precisely
similar occurs under the moraines of the Swiss glaciers. The ice here
is exceptionally compact, and, owing to the absence of the internal
scattering common in bubbled ice, the light plunges into the mass, is
extinguished, and the perfectly clear ice presents an appearance of
pitchy blackness.[50]

[50] I learn from a correspondent that certain Welsh tarns, which are
reputed bottomless, have this inky hue.

The green colour of the sea when it contains matter in a state of
mechanical suspension has now to be accounted for, and here, again,
let us fall back upon the sure basis of experiment. A strong white
dinner-plate was surrounded securely by cord, and had a lead weight
fastened to it. Fifty or sixty yards of strong hempen line were
attached to the plate. With it in his hand, my assistant, Thorogood,
occupied a boat fastened as usual to the davits of the ‘Urgent,’ while
I occupied a second boat nearer to the stern of the ship. He cast the
plate as a mariner heaves the lead, and by the time it had reached me
it had sunk a considerable depth in the water. In all cases the hue of
this plate was green: even when the sea was of the darkest indigo, the
green was vivid and pronounced. I could notice the gradual deepening of
the colour as the plate sank, but at its greatest depth in indigo water
the colour was still a blue-green.[51]

[51] In no case, of course, is the green pure, but a mixture of green
and blue.

Other observations confirmed this one. The ‘Urgent’ is a screw steamer,
and right over the blades of the screw was an orifice called the
screw-well, through which one could look from the poop down upon the
screw. The surface glimmer which so pesters the eye was here in a great
measure removed. Midway down a plank crossed the screw-well from side
to side, and on this I used to place myself to observe the action of
the screw underneath. The eye was rendered sensitive by the moderation
of the light, and, still further to remove all disturbing causes,
Lieutenant Walton had a sail and tarpaulin thrown over the mouth of
the well. Underneath this I perched myself and watched the screw. In
an indigo sea the play of colour was indescribably beautiful, and the
contrast between the water which had the screw-blades for a background,
and that which had the bottom of the ocean as a background, was
extraordinary. The one was of the most brilliant green, the other of
the deepest ultramarine. The surface of the water above the screw-blade
was always ruffled. Liquid lenses were thus formed, by which the
coloured light was withdrawn from some places and concentrated upon
others, the colour being thus caused to flash with metallic lustre. The
screw-blades in this case played the part of the plate in the former
case, and there were other instances of a similar kind. The white
bellies of the porpoises showed the green hue, varying in intensity
as the creatures swung to and fro between the surface and the deeper
water. Foam, at a certain depth below the surface, is also green. In a
rough sea the light which has penetrated the summit of a wave sometimes
reaches the eye, a beautiful green cap being thus placed upon the wave
even in indigo water.

But how is this colour to be connected philosophically with the
suspended particles? Take the dinner-plate which showed so brilliant
a green when thrown into indigo water. Suppose it to diminish in size
until it reaches an almost microscopic magnitude. It would still behave
substantially as the larger plate, sending to the eye its modicum of
green light. If the plate, instead of being a large coherent mass, were
ground to a powder sufficiently fine, and in this condition diffused
through the clear sea-water, it would send green light to the eye. In
fact, the suspended particles which the home examination reveals act in
all essential particulars like the plate, or like the screw-blades, or
like the foam, or like the bellies of the porpoises. Thus I think the
greenness of the sea is physically connected with the matter which it
holds in suspension.

We reached Portsmouth on the 5th of January 1871. There ended a voyage
which, though its main object was not realised, has left behind it
pleasant memories, both of the aspects of nature and the genial
kindliness of men.




Transcriber's Note


Images have been moved next to the text which they illustrate.


The following apparent errors have been corrected:

p. 34 (note) "gehen is" changed to "gehen’ is"

p. 47 "probablity" changed to "probability"

p. 64 "corespondingly" changed to "correspondingly"

p. 65 "WATER" changed to "WATER."

p. 83 "layers" changed to "layers."

p. 115 "maximun" changed to "maximum"

p. 122 "Brueil" changed to "Breuil"

p. 141 "Shreckhorn" changed to "Schreckhorn"

p. 150 "ceased Bennen" changed to "ceased. Bennen"

p. 151 "Lys We" changed to "Lys. We"

p. 156 "aproached" changed to "approached"

p. 206 "XIX" changed to "XIX."

p. 209 (note) "p. 82" changed to "p. 82."

p. 217 "ever since" changed to "ever since."

p. 226 "Finisteraarschlucht" changed to "Finsteraarschlucht"

p. 255 "nobleness" changed to "nobleness."

p. 262 "Maggiore" changed to "Maggiore."

p. 264 "Miracles." changed to "Miracles.’"

p. 267 "Bauman" changed to "Baumann"

p. 278 "did them" changed to "did then"

p. 283 "barometic" changed to "barometric"

p. 283 "and myself" changed to "and myself."

p. 291 "equilibruim" changed to "equilibrium"

p. 300 "morning" changed to "morning."

p. 326 "uppose" changed to "suppose"

p. 327 (note) "suprised" changed to "surprised"

p. 335 "crevasess" changed to "crevasses"

p. 339 "explanation" changed to "explanation."

p. 345 "truth" changed to "truth."

p. 388 "ice," changed to "ice,’"

p. 389 "liquefied" changed to "liquefied."

p. 394 "0°C" changed to "0° C"

p. 398 "unclouded ice" changed to "unclouded ice."

p. 403 "filled" changed to "filled."

p. 406 "vapour" changed to "vapour."

p. 415 "domes" changed to "domes."

p. 422 "late snow" changed to "late snow."

p. 426 "the wind" changed to "the wind."

p. 443 "wierd" changed to "weird"

p. 450 "enchroachment" changed to "encroachment"

p. 469 "follow green" changed to "follow green."


The following are used inconsistently in the text:

cowbells and cow-bells

FIG, FIG., and Fig.

frostbitten and frost-bitten

icefall and ice-fall

Lotschsattel and Lötschsattel

Nicol’s prism and Nicol prism

selfsame and self-same

sérac and _sérac_

snowbeds and snow-beds

subglacial and sub-glacial

Theodule and Théodule

thunderstorm and thunder-storm








End of Project Gutenberg's Hours of Exercise in the Alps, by John Tyndall